UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 10-K

 

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2022

OR

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the transition period from ________ to ___________

Commission File Number: 814-01424

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

Delaware

86-1950548

(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

9 West 57th Street

New York, New York

10019

(Address of principal executive offices)

(Zip Code)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (212) 515-3450

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class

Trading symbol(s)

Name of each exchange on which registered

None

None

None

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

Class S Common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01

Class D Common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01

Class I Common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01

 

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit such files). Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer”, “accelerated filer”, “smaller reporting company” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer

Smaller reporting company

Accelerated filer

Emerging growth company

Non-accelerated filer

 

 

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. ☐

If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐

Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes ☐ No ☒

As of December 31, 2022, there was no established public market for the Registrant’s common shares of beneficial interest (“Common Shares”).

The number of shares of the Registrant’s Common Shares, $0.01 par value per share, outstanding as of March 16, 2023 was 948,041 Class S common shares, 10,058 Class D common shares and 3,522,972 Class I common shares. Common shares outstanding exclude March 1, 2023 subscriptions since the issuance price is not yet finalized at this time.

 


 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

Table of Contents

 

 

Page

PART I

Item 1.

Business

1

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

18

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

53

Item 2.

Properties

53

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

53

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosures

53

PART II

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

54

Item 6.

Reserved

56

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

57

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

71

Item 8.

Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

72

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

128

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

128

Item 9B.

Other Information

128

PART III

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

129

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

129

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

129

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

129

Item 14.

Principal Accounting Fees and Services

129

PART IV

Item 15.

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

130

 

 

 


 

Risk Factor Summary

 

The following is only a summary of the principal risks that may materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. The following should be read in conjunction with the more complete discussion of the risk factors we face, which are set forth in the section titled “Item 1A. Risk Factors” in this report.

 

Risks Related to Our Business and Structure

We are a relatively new company and have a limited operating history.
Our Board of Trustees (“Board”) may in certain circumstances change our operating policies and strategies or amend our Declaration of Trust without prior notice or shareholder approval.
Price declines in the medium and large-sized U.S. corporate debt market may adversely affect the fair value of our portfolio.
We may face increasing competition for investment opportunities, have difficulty sourcing investment opportunities and experience fluctuations in our quarterly results.
As required by the 1940 Act, a significant portion of our investment portfolio is and will be recorded at fair value as determined in good faith and, as a result, there is and will be uncertainty as to the value of our portfolio investments.
There is a risk that investors in our shares may not receive distributions or that our distributions may decrease over time.
Although we have commenced a share repurchase program, we have discretion to repurchase shares at a disadvantageous time to our shareholders, not repurchase such shares or to suspend any share repurchase program.
Efforts to comply with regulations applicable to a public company will involve significant expenditures, and noncompliance with such regulations may adversely affect us.
General economic conditions could adversely affect the performance of our investments.
Certain of our portfolio companies’ businesses could be adversely affected by the effects of health pandemics or epidemics, including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic, which has had, and may continue to have, a negative impact on our and our portfolio companies’ businesses and operations.
Capital markets may experience periods of disruption and instability. Such market conditions may materially and adversely affect debt and equity capital markets in the United States and abroad, which may have a negative impact on our business and operations.
The war in Ukraine and Russia may continue to have a material adverse impact on us and our portfolio companies.
Inflation has adversely affected and may continue to adversely affect the business, results of operations and financial condition of our portfolio companies.
Disruptions to the global supply chain may have an adverse impact on our portfolio companies and, in turn, harm us.

 

Risks Related to Our Investments

We generally will not control our portfolio companies and our investments in portfolio companies are risky.
Our portfolio companies may be highly leveraged, incur debt that ranks equally with, or senior to, our investments in such companies and breach covenants or default on such debt.
We are exposed to risks associated with changes in interest rates, including the current rising interest rate environment.
Second priority liens on collateral securing debt investments that we make to our portfolio companies may be subject to control by senior creditors with first priority liens.
Economic recessions or downturns could impair our portfolio companies and adversely affect our operating results.

 

Risks Related to the Adviser and Its Affiliates; Conflicts of Interest

The Adviser and its affiliates, including our officers and some of our Trustees, face conflicts of interest caused by compensation arrangements with us and our affiliates, which could result in actions that are not in the best interests of our shareholders.
We may be obligated to pay the Adviser incentive compensation even if we incur a net loss due to a decline in the value of our portfolio.
The Adviser relies on key personnel, the loss of any of whom could impair its ability to successfully manage us.

 

Risks Related to Business Development Companies

The requirement that we invest a sufficient portion of our assets in Qualifying Assets could preclude us from investing in accordance with our current business strategy; conversely, the failure to invest a sufficient portion of our assets in Qualifying Assets could result in our failure to maintain our status as a BDC.
Regulations governing our operation as a BDC and RIC will affect our ability to raise, and the way in which we raise, additional capital or borrow for investment purposes.

 

 


 

Risks Related to Debt Financing

When we borrow money, the potential for loss on amounts invested in us will be magnified and may increase the risk of investing in us.
Provisions in a credit facility may limit our investment discretion and we may default under our credit facilities.

 

Federal Income Tax Risks

We will be subject to corporate-level income tax if we are unable to qualify as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code or to satisfy RIC distribution requirements.
Our portfolio investments may present special tax issues.
Legislative or regulatory tax changes could adversely affect investors.

 

Risks Related to an Investment in the Shares

An investment in our shares involves a high degree of risk and is highly speculative, our NAV may fluctuate significantly, and our shares will have limited liquidity.
Shareholders may experience dilution.

 

 


Table of Contents

 

PART I

Item 1. Business

Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “Company,” “we”, “us”, or “our”) is a Delaware statutory trust formed on December 4, 2020. The Company was formed primarily to invest in private credit opportunities in directly originated assets, including loans and other debt securities, made to or issued by large private U.S. borrowers, with a strong emphasis on senior secured lending. The Company is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company that has elected to be regulated as a business development company under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”). The Company is externally managed by Apollo Credit Management, LLC. The Adviser is an affiliate of Apollo Global Management, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries (“AGM”, or “Apollo”). The Company has elected to be treated for federal income tax purposes, and intends to qualify annually thereafter, as a regulated investment company (“RIC”) as defined under Subchapter M of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”).

Our investment objectives are to generate current income and, to a lesser extent, long-term capital appreciation. The Company invests primarily in private credit opportunities in directly originated assets, including loans and other debt securities, made to or issued by large private U.S. borrowers, which we generally define as companies with more than $75 million in EBITDA, as may be adjusted for market disruptions, mergers and acquisitions-related charges and synergies, and other items. While most of our investments will be in private U.S. companies (subject to compliance with BDC regulatory requirement to invest at least 70% of its assets in private U.S. companies), we also expect to invest from time to time in European and other non-U.S. companies. Our portfolio may also include equity interests such as common stock, preferred stock, warrants or options, which generally would be obtained as part of providing a broader financing solution. Under normal circumstances, we will invest directly or indirectly at least 80% of our total assets (net assets plus borrowings for investment purposes) in debt instruments of varying maturities. Subject to the limitations of the 1940 Act, we may invest in loans or other securities, the proceeds of which may refinance or otherwise repay debt or securities of companies whose debt is owned by other Apollo funds. From time to time, we may co-invest with other Apollo funds.

Most of the debt instruments we invest in are unrated or rated below investment grade, which is often an indication of size, credit worthiness and speculative nature relative to the capacity of the borrower to pay interest and principal. Generally, if our unrated investments were rated, they would be rated below investment grade. These securities, which are often referred to as “junk” or “high yield”, have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. They may also be difficult to value and are illiquid.

We may, but are not required to, enter into interest rate, foreign exchange or other derivative agreements to hedge interest rate, currency, credit or other risks, but we do not generally intend to enter into any such derivative agreements for speculative purposes. Any derivative agreements entered into for speculative purposes are not expected to be material to the Company’s business or results of operations. These hedging activities, which will be in compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements, may include the use of futures, options and forward contracts. We will bear the costs incurred in connection with entering into, administering and settling any such derivative contracts. There can be no assurance any hedging strategy we employ will be successful.

We use and continue to expect to use leverage as market conditions permit and at the discretion of the Adviser, but in no event will leverage employed exceed the limitations set forth in the 1940 Act; which currently allows us to borrow up to a 2:1 debt to equity ratio. We use and continue to expect to use leverage in the form of borrowings, including loans from certain financial institutions and the issuance of debt securities. We may also use leverage in the form of the issuance of preferred shares, but do not currently intend to do so. In determining whether to borrow money, we will analyze the maturity, covenant package and rate structure of the proposed borrowings as well as the risks of such borrowings compared to our investment outlook. Any such leverage, if incurred, would be expected to increase the total capital available for investment by the Company.

Our investment strategy is expected to capitalize on Apollo’s scale and reputation in the market as an attractive financing partner to acquire our target investments at attractive pricing. We also expect to benefit from Apollo’s reputation and ability to transact in scale with speed and certainty, and its long-standing and extensive relationships with private equity firms that require financing for their transactions.

As a BDC, at least 70% of our assets must be the type of “qualifying” assets listed in Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act, as described herein, which are generally privately-offered securities issued by U.S. private or thinly-traded companies. We may also invest up to 30% of our portfolio opportunistically in “non-qualifying” portfolio investments, such as investments in non-U.S. companies.

The loans in which we invest will generally pay floating interest rates based on a variable base rate. The senior secured loans, unitranche loans and senior secured bonds in which we will invest generally have stated terms of five to eight years, and the mezzanine, unsecured or subordinated debt investments that we may make will generally have stated terms of up to ten years, but the expected average life of such securities is generally between three and five years. However, there is no limit on the maturity or duration of any security we may hold in our portfolio. Loans and securities purchased in the secondary market will generally have shorter remaining terms to maturity than newly issued investments. We expect most of our debt investments will be unrated. Our debt investments may also be rated by a nationally recognized statistical rating organization, and, in such case, generally will carry a rating below investment grade (rated lower than “Baa3” by Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. or lower than “BBB-” by Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services). We expect that our unrated debt investments will generally have credit quality consistent with below investment grade securities. In addition, we may invest in collateralized loan obligations (“CLOs”) and will generally have the right to receive payments only from the CLOs, and will generally not have direct rights against the underlying borrowers or entities that sponsored the CLOs.

We are currently offering on a continuous basis up to $5.0 billion of common shares of beneficial interest pursuant to an offering registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission. The Company expects to offer to sell any combination of three classes of common shares, Class S shares, Class D shares and Class I shares, with a dollar value up to the maximum offering amount. The share classes have different ongoing shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees. The per share purchase price for common shares in the primary offering was $25.00 per share. Thereafter, the purchase price per share for each class of common shares will equal the net asset value (“NAV”) per share, as of the effective date of the monthly share purchase date.

1


Table of Contents

 

Apollo Global Securities, LLC (the “Intermediary Manager”) will use its best efforts to sell shares, but is not obligated to purchase or sell any specific amount of shares in the offering.

On January 7, 2022, the Company commenced operations and accepted $657 million of subscriptions.

The Adviser and the Administrator

The Company’s investment activities are managed by Apollo Credit Management, LLC, an investment adviser registered with the SEC under the Advisers Act. Our Adviser is responsible for originating prospective investments, conducting research and due diligence investigations on potential investments, analyzing investment opportunities, negotiating and structuring our investments and monitoring our investments and portfolio companies on an ongoing basis.

Apollo Credit Management, LLC, as our Administrator, provides, or oversees the performance of, administrative and compliance services, including, but not limited to, maintaining financial records, overseeing the calculation of NAV, compliance monitoring (including diligence and oversight of our other service providers), preparing reports to shareholders and reports filed with the SEC, preparing materials and coordinating meetings of our Board of Trustees, managing the payment of expenses and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered by others and providing office space, equipment and office services.

The Adviser is an affiliate of Apollo and is led by substantially the same investment personnel as Apollo. As such, our Adviser has access to the broader resources of Apollo, subject to Apollo’s policies and procedures regarding the management of conflicts of interest.

Apollo is a longstanding and leading global alternative asset manager with approximately $548 billion of AUM as of December 31, 2022. Apollo operates its three primary business segments, private equity, credit and real assets, in a fully integrated manner, which Apollo believes is distinct from other comparable alternative investment managers. By collaborating across disciplines, with each business unit contributing to, and drawing from, Apollo’s shared information and experience, Apollo believes the Company is well-positioned to invest across asset classes. Apollo has developed what it believes to be a differentiated approach to credit investing that allows it to adapt to changing market environments and to source what it believes to be attractive risk-adjusted investment opportunities in both expansionary and recessionary environments. Apollo’s differentiated investment strategy requires a willingness and strength of conviction to go “against the grain” of what other investors may be doing, and a desire and ability to tackle transaction complexity in a variety of forms. Apollo believes that its experience has shown that complexity, whether in the form of business, regulatory or legal complexity, can obscure a company or an investment’s inherent value. By pursuing what Apollo believes to be complex transactions that other investors either are not willing to undertake or do not possess the skill set to understand, Apollo believes it has been able to find opportunities where competition is limited, in turn, generating attractive risk-adjusted returns. The Adviser draws upon Apollo’s more than 30 year history and benefits from the broader firm’s significant capital markets, trading and research expertise developed through investments in many core sectors since inception.

Our objective is to bring Apollo’s leading credit investment platform to the non-exchange traded BDC industry.

Market Opportunity

Apollo believes that there are and will continue to be opportunities to lend to large private U.S. borrowers who cannot or do not want to access the broadly syndicated loan market or are too big for the private middle market. Apollo believes that a confluence of secular and cyclical changes is giving rise to unmet demand for scaled direct origination solutions among large corporate borrowers. The robust growth in private credit following the 2008 Global Financial Crisis ("GFC") has given rise to the formation of hundreds of private lenders and origination platforms, primarily focused on the competitive middle market, sponsor-backed channel. Apollo believes the conditions that sustained the rapid growth in private credit are still at play today and are migrating toward larger corporate issuers. Banks’ regulations and reduced risk appetite continue to restrict access to efficient financing solutions. Moreover, private equity continues to grow unabated as scaled alternative funding solutions enable companies to stay private longer, a dynamic that is beginning to take hold in credit markets.

In addition to investing in senior secured loans generally, we believe that the Company’s investment strategy represents a differentiated approach to private credit investing and seeks to provide investors with attractive, downside-protected returns. More specifically, Apollo believes that the following characteristics distinguish the Company as a compelling investment opportunity.

Significant Current Market Opportunity:

The global leveraged finance market is roughly $4.7 trillion in size as of September 2022, of which private credit has become an increasingly significant part. As of mid-2022, the direct lending market had grown to $580 billion in assets under management (“AUM”) to meet the needs of middle market borrowers post the GFC. However, Apollo believes there is a dearth of available alternative financing solutions for large corporate issuers outside of the broadly syndicated and high yield markets, despite a growing demand for flexible solutions. Large companies historically utilized banks to tap the public high yield and leveraged loan markets in order to meet their financing needs. Before the GFC, banks typically held these bonds and loans on their own balance sheets, but over the last 15 years moved to an originate-to-distribute model because of increased regulatory burdens and capital charges. Today, banks generally arrange the financing for a company for a fee and syndicate the debt out to institutional investors. This mechanism for raising capital became increasingly stressed over the past few years as unstable market conditions and the uncertain economic backdrop caused investors and arranging banks to retrench from the market. Primary public debt markets for sub-investment grade companies are sensitive to market conditions and bank appetite to provide funding to many large issuers falters in volatile markets, like we experienced during COVID-19 and across 2022. For example, in 2022, volatile market conditions led to sharp year-over-year declines in both leveraged loan and high yield primary issuance, leaving the private market as the only viable financing option for a swath of large borrowers. Apollo believes these dynamics will enable the Company to secure favorable pricing and more rigorous structural protections and driving value for the benefit of the Company. Apollo believes that this opportunity is

2


Table of Contents

 

only accessible to scaled alternative asset managers with significant relationships and cycle-tested investing expertise, and that the Company is therefore well-positioned to capitalize on the growing opportunity set.

Proprietary Sourcing Engine Provides a Significant Barrier to Entry. Across its global platform, Apollo has found that deal flow is often driven by relationships, and that having a strong reputation and an established network can ultimately lead to exclusive investment opportunities. Apollo believes that the Company will benefit from the expansive networks that have been cultivated by both Apollo’s Private Equity and Credit businesses over the past 30 years. Apollo’s leading private equity franchise has a deep bench of investment professionals and operating executives who have established strong and long-lasting relationships with industry executives and leading management teams. Through Apollo private equity funds’ ownership of over 190 portfolio companies since inception, Apollo has established deep understanding across a variety of businesses, which we believe will enable us to uncover idiosyncratic opportunities, including in out-of-favor industries. At the same time, the scale and breadth of the Apollo Credit platform is expected to be the primary sourcing engine for the Company. Apollo Global Corporate Credit (“GCC”) are current lenders to approximately 3000 companies worldwide. As a result, members of the GCC team are in frequent dialogue with management teams and intermediaries, enabling visibility into a given company’s financing needs as well as opportunities to organically grow existing lending relationships. Apollo believes that its ability to leverage its incumbency to source deals directly with large corporate borrowers creates a meaningful barrier to entry, especially given that we believe direct lending managers primarily rely on the sponsor-backed channel to source opportunities. We believe our deep relationships across both corporate and sponsors will allow us to create a differentiated portfolio. Today, Apollo funds own approximately $25 billion in loans to portfolio companies of Apollo’s top 30 sponsors as of December 31, 2022. Additionally, Apollo-managed CLOs and CLOs managed by Redding Ridge Asset Management LLC and its affiliates, a CLO manager established by Apollo, have over $25 billion in outstanding CLOs to 2,750 issuers as of December 31, 2022, further broadening Apollo’s global lending footprint. Importantly, Apollo’s credit business is one of the largest lending counterparties to Wall Street, having traded approximately $64 billion in 2022 alone. This level of trading volume often results in Apollo being provided with an early or first look from the dealer community, which Apollo believes will put the Company in a position to access challenged syndications at attractive terms during periods of volatility. Through these various touchpoints, Apollo has established a combination of robust networks and proprietary relationships that it believes will enable the Company to source highly attractive opportunities, often on a proprietary basis.

Apollo’s Status as a Preferred Lending Counterparty. Apollo has developed a reputation as a differentiated lending partner due to its scale and ability to design creative capital solutions across capital structures, particularly in complex situations. Apollo believes that the Company will be able to underwrite and commit to large transactions, streamlining the execution process for borrowers and enabling them to only interface with a single counterparty, due to the breadth and scale of Apollo’s capital base, which for this purpose includes numerous long-standing co-investment relationships and syndication capabilities with credit market investors. Apollo’s scale is augmented by Apollo Global Securities, LLC (“AGS” or the “Intermediary Manager”), Apollo’s affiliated broker-dealer and our intermediary manager, which, leveraging its targeted approach and close relationships with large institutional investors, has syndicated approximately $40 billion of debt across 70+ transactions since 2016. Being the sole or primary lender in size also facilitates alignment and a partnership mentality that is differentiated from traditional lending relationships. Additionally, our underwriting and structuring ability coupled with company and sector-specific insights across the Apollo platform is expected to enable Apollo to embrace complexity and provide bespoke capital solutions tailored to borrowers’ unique financing needs, including greater certainty of funding at specified terms or within compressed timetables. Apollo believes that the Company augments Apollo’s ability to leverage its reputation as a preferred lending partner to selectively source proprietary opportunities in large corporate direct lending. Based on our experience in the large corporate direct lending market, we believe that the Company has an advantage in its ability to provide capital in scale with greater certainty of closing as well as to deliver strategic partner-like benefits.

Focus on Downside Protection. Consistent with Apollo’s value-orientation, the Company intends to take a conservative investment approach, employing a rigorous, bottom-up, private equity-style underwriting, coupled with detailed transaction structuring to mitigate risk. Apollo has significant structuring experience and believes the Company will be able to leverage the Apollo Credit platform’s incumbency and status as a preferred lending partner to bilaterally negotiate highly structured, senior secured loans that are tailored to address the unique risks of a given corporate borrower. The Company intends to invest primarily in senior term loans that, coupled with robust covenant packages restricting incremental debt incurrence and restricted payments, are intended to provide downside protection in the form of a priority, undiluted claim on underlying collateral. Apollo believes that due to the Apollo’s experience with its managed funds investing across the capital structure, the Company will be able to consider investment structures that are different, and oftentimes more complex, than other investors.

High Degree of Credit Selectivity. Apollo believes that credit selectivity in every market environment is a critical driver of performance. By virtue of our value-driven investment approach emphasizing downside protection, Apollo’s GCC business has experienced a 0.1% annual average default rate, as compared to a 2.6% annual average default rate within the broader leveraged loan market. Even in an event of default, Apollo’s GCC business has seen substantially higher recovery rates as compared to the broader market, experiencing a 68% recovery rate as compared to 60% for the broader leveraged loan market. Given the size of the market opportunity in large corporate direct lending, Apollo believes that the Company is well-positioned to exercise quality credit selection in any market environment.

Strong Alignment with Apollo-affiliated Capital. Apollo has structured the Company such that the Company and Apollo-affiliated capital will generally be aligned, leveraging the same monitoring and risk management capabilities within Apollo’s credit business and, except as described below, owning the same loans at the same price. Apollo-affiliated capital includes Apollo-managed funds and accounts, Apollo employee commitments and commitments from Apollo.

Strong Apollo Sponsorship and Integrated Business Model. Apollo operates its global franchise as an integrated investment platform with each of private equity, credit and real assets contributing to and drawing from Apollo’s information and experience, thereby providing investment opportunities and intellectual capital to all of its businesses. In the process of screening, executing and monitoring investments across businesses, Apollo has developed valuable relationships with well-regarded sponsors, leading management teams, consultants and other intermediaries, which further drives high-quality deals and thoughtful insights during the investment process. Apollo believes the Company will benefit from the wealth of knowledge, experience and capabilities across asset classes, industries and geographies at Apollo, which will widen the Company’s lens and enable the Company team to more successfully source, diligence and manage opportunities across market cycles.

3


Table of Contents

 

The Board of Trustees

Overall responsibility for the Company’s oversight rests with the Board of Trustees. We have entered into the Advisory Agreement with the Adviser, pursuant to which the Adviser will manage the Company on a day-to-day basis. The Board of Trustees is responsible for overseeing the Adviser and other service providers in our operations in accordance with the provisions of the 1940 Act, the Company’s bylaws and applicable provisions of state and other laws. The Adviser will keep the Board of Trustees well informed as to the Adviser’s activities on our behalf and our investment operations and provide the Board of Trustees information with additional information as the Board of Trustees may, from time to time, request. The Board of Trustees is currently composed of five members, four of whom are Trustees who are not “interested persons” of the Company or the Adviser as defined in the 1940 Act.

Investment Selection

The Company employs a sophisticated and disciplined approach with respect to sourcing, evaluating and executing prospective investments, consistent with how Apollo manages its funds’ investments across the firm. Our process is defined by an emphasis on meaningful downside protection and the preservation of capital, which we will seek to achieve through extensive private equity-style due diligence, asset-level and market environment analysis, a systematic approach to identifying risk and structuring and a hands-on approach to driving value and managing investments throughout the ownership period. In this process, the Company will leverage the collective knowledge and resources of Apollo’s GCC team as well as Apollo’s integrated platform more broadly.

Idea Generation and Sourcing. Across its global platform, Apollo has found that deal flow is often driven by relationships and that having a strong reputation and an established network can ultimately lead to exclusive investment opportunities. The Company expects to benefit from the expansive networks that have been cultivated by both Apollo’s private equity and credit businesses over the past 30 years. Apollo’s leading private equity franchise has a deep bench of investment professionals and operating executives who have established strong relationships with industry executives and leading management teams. Through Apollo private equity funds’ ownership of over 190 portfolio companies since inception, Apollo has established deep sector experience in nine core industries, which we believe will enable the Company to uncover idiosyncratic opportunities in out-of-favor industries. At the same time, the scale and breadth of the Apollo credit platform will be the primary sourcing engine for the Company. The Company will be led by a team of experienced investment professionals (i) within the Apollo Credit Platform (the “Fund Investment Team”) and (ii) who are designated as employees or registered representatives of AGS and/or Apollo Global Funding, LLC (“AGF”) (the “Fund Syndication Team", and together with the Fund Investment Team, the “Credit Team”). The Fund Investment Team has deep industry knowledge and extensive experience in deal structuring, and the separate debt advisory, capital markets, structuring, syndication and similar services provided by the Fund Syndication Team are expected to complement and be “additive” to the customary investment management services provided by the Fund Investment Team.

With an extensive team of experienced investment professionals, including seasoned portfolio managers, industry teams comprised of specialists within their respective sectors, product analysts with particular experience in private lending and workouts and investment professionals solely focused on sourcing and maintaining relationships within the capital markets community, Apollo has a combination of robust networks and strategic relationships that we believe will enable the Company to source highly attractive opportunities, often on a proprietary basis.

We believe Apollo’s credit business is also one of the largest lending counterparties to Wall Street, having traded approximately $64 billion for the last twelve months ended December 31, 2022. This level of trading volume often results in Apollo being provided with an early or first look from the dealer community, which we believe puts Apollo in a position to be a price setter of risk during periods of volatility and further affords Apollo differentiated insights and valuable access during periods of forced market selling. The credit team also has a sophisticated perspective on broader market dynamics, which often leads to the identification of attractive market opportunities on which its managed funds can capitalize. The Company will also leverage its relationships and incumbency in capital structures to proactively propose differentiated origination solutions for sponsors and issuers alike. As mentioned, the Company’s intention to source opportunities directly from corporate borrowers represents what we believe is one of the strategy’s key competitive advantages and barriers to entry. Apollo’s managed funds and accounts are among the largest owners of corporate credit, currently holding $392 billion in total credit assets as of December 31, 2022. We believe this broad-based ownership provides an advantage as incumbency creates organic growth opportunities through follow-on investments. Further, the GCC team covers approximately 3,000 securities. In the process of screening, executing and monitoring investments within this coverage universe, Apollo has a privileged view of issuers’ strategic priorities and lending needs and has developed valuable relationships with leading management teams, consultants and other intermediaries. Apollo believes its active participation within targeted sectors allows Apollo and its managed funds to benefit from high-quality, proprietary deal flow, access to extensive executive-level contacts and a reputation as a preferred provider of capital.

Screening and Due Diligence. The Company has established strict criteria to evaluate an investment’s suitability for the Company as well as a recurring review to screen potential opportunities in order to quickly ascertain which prospective investments we believe worthy of additional resources and due diligence. Given what we expect will be a robust pipeline for the Company opportunities, this review process is intended to allow the Fund Investment Team to have an open dialogue and to ensure appropriate prioritization of opportunities to pursue. After this initial screen, investment ideas will be presented to the Fund Investment and Execution Committees with the discussion led by the applicable investment analyst. In such circumstances, the analyst will offer a summary of the business, the perceived merits and risks associated with the prospective investment and (with input from the Fund Syndication Team) preliminary thoughts on structuring and terms. Should the investment be deemed worthwhile to pursue, the Fund Investment Team will employ a more rigorous, private equity-style analysis to assess the applicable company’s cash flow generation and enterprise value. Analysts will seek to identify investments in companies with strong market share, sufficient pricing power, commitment to de-leveraging, strong management teams and sufficient equity support from sponsors and management. Analysts gather relevant information regarding the company, its customers, suppliers and competitors, using a combination of legal, regulatory, accounting and industry reports, alongside the many resources of Apollo’s platform. In addition, the analyst and applicable investment team generally identify and hold discussions with relevant professionals from Apollo’s private equity business who may provide differentiated insight into a particular company, sector or situation.

4


Table of Contents

 

Institutionalized Monitoring and Risk Management Capabilities. Across its platform, Apollo employs a disciplined and rigorous approach to ongoing monitoring. Because the Company is expected to initially be the sole or largest lender to a borrower, the Company expects to benefit from having driven the diligence process and structuring of covenants and loan documents. Importantly, members of the Fund Investment Team who performed the initial underwrite will be responsible for providing ongoing oversight of the investment. The continuity of personnel between those who perform the detailed due diligence and those who monitor and remain involved after origination is important, as it means new developments, risks and opportunities for value creation, can be monitored by those who are most knowledgeable about the business. Further, the Company expects to benefit from increased transparency, communication and coordination with its borrowers. The Fund Investment Team will seek to maintain active dialogue with the management team and/or sponsor throughout the life of the investment, reviewing financial information and other data in depth. As part of this active monitoring, the Fund Investment Team expects to be poised to identify any material downturn versus the lending case identified during the underwrite and can be in a position to recognize any failure to achieve a milestone that may be critical to the investment case. Should such a deteriorating situation arise, the investment would be put on a watchlist and would undergo enhanced monitoring and an independent review. If the situation were to progress to a full workout, Apollo has an in-house distressed credit team that can assist in seeking to stabilize the situation. Additionally, Apollo’s experience across nine core industries in private equity generates valuable insight in terms of strategic and operational initiatives that may be implemented to create value in a way that regular-way direct lending managers may not be able to.

The Company will manage the risks associated with Company investments through portfolio construction, continued monitoring and evaluation. The Firm has devoted significant resources in the development of a sophisticated, integrated infrastructure designed to support the investment and risk management process. This includes proprietary systems for the monitoring, accounting and compliance aspects of the Firm’s portfolios, along with trading, clearing and settlement of assets.

Valuation Process. Each quarter, we will value investments in our portfolio, and such values will be disclosed each quarter in reports filed with the SEC. The Board of Trustees has designated the Adviser as its "valuation designee" pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the 1940 Act, and in that role the Adviser is responsible for performing fair value determinations relating to all of the Company's investments, including periodically assessing and managing any material valuation risks and establishing and applying fair value methodologies, in accordance with valuation policies and procedures that have been approved by the Company's Board of Trustees. Even though the Company's Board of Trustees designated the Company's Adviser as "valuation designee," the Company's Board of Trustees continues to be responsible for overseeing the processes for determining fair valuation. Investments for which market quotations are readily available are recorded at such market quotations. With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available, the Adviser typically utilizes independent third party valuation firms to assist us in determining fair value of such investments in good faith, based on procedures adopted by and subject to the supervision of the Board of Trustees. As of December 31, 2022, independent third party valuation firms performed their procedures over most of our investments for which market quotations are not readily available.

We will also determine our NAV as of the last day of a month that is not also the last day of a calendar quarter and we intend to update the value of securities with reliable market quotations to the most recent market quotation. For securities without reliable market quotations, the Adviser’s valuation team will generally value such assets at the most recent quarterly valuation unless the Adviser determines that a significant observable change has occurred since the most recent quarter end with respect to the investment (which determination may be as a result of a material event at a portfolio company, material change in market spreads, secondary market transaction in the securities of an investment or otherwise). Investments for which market quotations are readily available are recorded at such market quotations.

Managerial Assistance. As a BDC, we must offer, and provide upon request, significant managerial assistance to certain of our portfolio companies except where the Company purchases securities of an issuer in conjunction with one or more other persons acting together, one of the other persons in the group makes available such managerial assistance. This assistance could involve, among other things, monitoring the operations of our portfolio companies, participating in board and management meetings, consulting with and advising officers of portfolio companies and providing other organizational and financial guidance, including through the Apollo Advantage program. The Administrator will provide such managerial assistance on our behalf to portfolio companies that request this assistance. To the extent fees are paid for these services, we, rather than the Adviser, will retain any fees paid for such assistance.

Warehousing Transactions

The Company entered into a warehousing transaction whereby the Company agreed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase certain assets from parties unaffiliated with the Adviser. The warehousing transaction was designed to assist the Company in deploying capital upon receipt of subscription proceeds.

Facility Agreement

On February 22, 2021, the Company entered into a Facility Agreement (“Facility Agreement”), which was subsequently amended on August 17, 2021, with Goldman Sachs Bank USA (the “Financing Provider”). The Facility Agreement creates a forward obligation of the Financing Provider to sell, and a forward obligation of the Company, or its designee, to purchase certain investments (the “Portfolio Investments”) owned and held by the Financing Provider at the Company’s request. Pursuant to the Facility Agreement, the Company may request the Financing Provider to acquire Portfolio Investments as it designates from time to time, which the Financing Provider can approve or reject in its sole and absolute discretion. Prior to any sale to the Company, the Portfolio Investments will be owned and held solely for the account of the Financing Provider. ADS will have no obligation to purchase the Portfolio Investments under the Facility Agreement until such time the Company has received subscriptions for its shares of at least $600 million (the “Capital Condition”). After the Company has met the Capital Condition, it will be obligated to purchase the Portfolio Investments from the Financing Provider on or before February 22, 2022 (the “Facility End Date”). ADS may elect, but is not obligated to, purchase Portfolio Investments prior to the Facility End Date or prior to or without meeting the Capital Condition. In consideration for the forward arrangement provided by the Financing Provider (the amount of the arrangement will not exceed $250 million before May 22, 2021 and $500 million between such date and the Facility End Date (the “Financing Amount”), the Company has agreed to pay certain fees and expenses to the Financing Provider, including

5


Table of Contents

 

(i) a facility fee at an annual rate of LIBOR plus 1.77% multiplied by the cash amount paid by the Financing Provider (subject to adjustment for, among other things, cash amounts received by the Financing Provider) for such Portfolio Investment (the “Funded Amount”) while it is being held by the Financing Provider,

(ii) an unused fee at an annual rate of 0.50% of the unused Financing Amount minus the greater of (A) the Minimum Utilization Amount and (B) the Funded Amount, and

(iii) a minimum utilization fee at an annual rate of 1.77% of (the “Minimum Utilization Amount”) (A) prior to May 22, 2021, 50% of the Financing Amount at such time and (B) on or after May 22, 2021, and prior to the Facility End Date, 75% of the Financing Amount at such time.

As a general matter, the price the Company would pay to purchase any Portfolio Investment from the Financing Provider equals the cash amount paid by the Financing Provider subject to adjustment for, among other things, principal repayments and interest amounts earned by the Financing Provider. Accordingly, shareholders will benefit from any interest paid or accrued on any Portfolio Investment purchased by the Company.

Effective January 7, 2022, the Company had a contractual obligation to acquire all assets under the Facility Agreement through forward purchase agreement on or before September 30, 2022. The mark-to-market gain/loss of all investments held by the Financing Provider, in addition to other economic rights and obligations held by the Company, are recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. These gains (losses) are realized at the time the Company settles on the purchases of each underlying asset from the Financing Provider.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company purchased debt investments from the Financing Provider with an aggregate principal amount of $436 million (excluding unfunded revolvers and delayed draw positions of $0.2 million), at a purchase price of $412 million, resulting in an unrealized gain of approximately $3 million.

Allocation of Investment Opportunities

General

Apollo, including the Adviser, provides investment management services to other BDCs, registered investment companies, investment funds, client accounts and proprietary accounts that Apollo may establish.

The Adviser and its affiliates will share any investment and sale opportunities with its other clients and the Company in accordance with the Advisers Act and firm-wide allocation policies, which generally provide for sharing pro rata based on targeted acquisition size or targeted sale size. Subject to the Advisers Act and as further set forth in this prospectus, certain other clients may receive certain priority or other allocation rights with respect to certain investments, subject to various conditions set forth in such other clients’ respective governing agreements.

In addition, as a BDC regulated under the 1940 Act, the Company is subject to certain limitations relating to co-investments and joint transactions with affiliates, which likely in certain circumstances limit the Company’s ability to make investments or enter into other transactions alongside other clients.

Co-Investment Relief

An affiliate of the Adviser has received an exemptive order from the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) on March 29, 2016 (the "Prior Order"), which was amended on January 10, 2023 (the "Order"), that permits us, among other things, to co-invest with certain other persons, including certain affiliates of the Adviser and certain funds managed and controlled by the Adviser and its affiliates, subject to certain terms and conditions. Pursuant to such order, the Company’s Board of Trustees (the “Board of Trustees” and each member of the Board of Trustees, a “Trustee”) may establish objective criteria (“Board Criteria”) clearly defining co-investment opportunities in which the Company will have the opportunity to participate with one or more listed or private Apollo-managed BDCs, including us (the “Apollo BDCs”), and other public or private Apollo funds that target similar assets. If an investment falls within the Board Criteria, Apollo must offer an opportunity for the Apollo BDCs to participate. The Apollo BDCs may determine to participate or not to participate, depending on whether Apollo determines that the investment is appropriate for the Apollo BDCs (e.g., based on investment strategy). The co-investment would generally be allocated to us, any other Apollo BDCs (including Apollo Investment Corporation) and the other Apollo funds that target similar assets pro rata based on available capital in the applicable asset class. If the Adviser determines that such investment is not appropriate for us, the investment will not be allocated to us, but the Adviser will be required to report such investment and the rationale for its determination for us to not participate in the investment to the Board of Trustees at the next quarterly board meeting.

6


Table of Contents

 

Competition

We compete for investments with other BDCs and investment funds (including private equity funds, mezzanine funds, performing and other credit funds, and funds that invest in CLOs, structured notes, derivatives and other types of collateralized securities and structured products), as well as traditional financial services companies such as commercial banks and other sources of funding. These other BDCs and investment funds might be reasonable investment alternatives to us and may be less costly or complex with fewer and/or different risks than we have. Moreover, alternative investment vehicles, such as hedge funds, have begun to invest in areas in which they have not traditionally invested, including making investments in large private U.S. borrowers. As a result of these new entrants, competition for investment opportunities in large private U.S. borrowers may intensify. Many of our competitors are substantially larger and have considerably greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. For example, some competitors may have a lower cost of capital and access to funding sources that are not available to us. In addition, some of our competitors may have higher risk tolerances or different risk assessments than we have. These characteristics could allow our competitors to consider a wider variety of investments, establish more relationships and offer better pricing and more flexible structuring than we are able to do. We may lose investment opportunities if we do not match our competitors’ pricing, terms or structure. If we are forced to match our competitors’ pricing, terms or structure, we may not be able to achieve acceptable returns on our investments or may bear substantial risk of capital loss. A significant part of our competitive advantage stems from the fact that the market for investments in large private U.S. borrowers is underserved by traditional commercial banks and other financial sources. A significant increase in the number and/or the size of our competitors in this target market could force us to accept less attractive investment terms. Furthermore, many of our competitors have greater experience operating under, or are not subject to, the regulatory restrictions that the 1940 Act imposes on us as a BDC.

Non-Exchange Traded, Perpetual-Life BDC

The Company is a non-exchange traded BDC, meaning its shares are not listed for trading on a stock exchange or other securities market and a perpetual-life BDC, meaning it is an investment vehicle of indefinite duration, whose common shares are intended to be sold by the BDC monthly on a continuous basis at a price generally equal to the BDC’s monthly NAV per share. In our perpetual-life structure, we may offer investors an opportunity to repurchase their shares on a quarterly basis, but we are not obligated to offer to repurchase any in any particular quarter in our discretion. We believe that our perpetual nature enables us to execute a patient strategy and be able to invest across different market environments. This may reduce the risk of the Company being a forced seller of assets in market downturns compared to non-perpetual funds. While we may consider a liquidity event at any time in the future, we currently do not intend to undertake a liquidity event, and we are not obligated by our charter or otherwise to effect a liquidity event at any time.

Emerging Growth Company

We are an “emerging growth company,” as defined by the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the “JOBS Act.” As an emerging growth company, we are eligible to take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting and disclosure requirements that are applicable to public companies that are not emerging growth companies. For so long as we remain an emerging growth company, we will not be required to:

have an auditor attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act;
submit certain executive compensation matters to shareholder advisory votes pursuant to the “say on frequency” and “say on pay” provisions (requiring a non-binding shareholder vote to approve compensation of certain executive officers) and the “say on golden parachute” provisions (requiring a non-binding shareholder vote to approve golden parachute arrangements for certain executive officers in connection with mergers and certain other business combinations) of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010; or
disclose certain executive compensation related items, such as the correlation between executive compensation and performance and comparisons of the chief executive officer’s compensation to median employee compensation.

In addition, the JOBS Act provides that an emerging growth company may take advantage of an extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards that have different effective dates for public and private companies. This means that an emerging growth company can delay adopting certain accounting standards until such standards are otherwise applicable to private companies.

We will remain an emerging growth company for up to five years, or until the earliest of: (1) the last date of the fiscal year during which we had total annual gross revenues of $1 billion or more; (2) the date on which we have, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1 billion in non-convertible debt; or (3) the date on which we are deemed to be a “large accelerated filer” as defined under Rule 12b-2 under the Exchange Act.

We do not believe that being an emerging growth company will have a significant impact on our business or this offering. As stated above, we have elected to opt in to the extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards available to emerging growth companies. Also, because we are not a large accelerated filer or an accelerated filer under Section 12b-2 of the Exchange Act, and will not be for so long as our Common Shares are not traded on a securities exchange, we will not be subject to auditor attestation requirements of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act even once we are no longer an emerging growth company. In addition, so long as we are externally managed by the Adviser and we do not directly compensate our executive officers, or reimburse the Adviser or its affiliates for the salaries, bonuses, benefits and severance payments for persons who also serve as one of our executive officers or as an executive officer of the Adviser, we do not expect to include disclosures relating to executive compensation in our periodic reports or proxy statements and, as a result, do not expect to be required to seek shareholder approval of executive compensation and golden parachute compensation arrangements pursuant to Section 14A(a) and (b) of the Exchange Act.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

Employees

We do not currently have any employees and do not expect to have any employees. Services necessary for our business are provided by individuals who are employees of the Adviser or its affiliates pursuant to the terms of the Advisory Agreement and the Administrator or its affiliates pursuant to the Administration Agreement. Each of our executive officers is employed by the Adviser or its affiliates. Our day-to-day investment operations will be managed by the Adviser. The services necessary for the sourcing and administration of our investment portfolio will be provided by investment professionals employed by the Adviser or its affiliates. The Investment Team will focus on origination, non-originated investments and transaction development and the ongoing monitoring of our investments. In addition, we will reimburse the Administrator for its costs, expenses and allocable portion of overhead, including compensation paid by the Administrator (or its affiliates) to the Company’s chief compliance officer and chief financial officer and their respective staffs as well as other administrative personnel (based on the percentage of time such individuals devote, on an estimated basis, to the business and affairs of the Company).

Regulation as a BDC

The following discussion is a general summary of the material prohibitions and descriptions governing BDCs generally. It does not purport to be a complete description of all of the laws and regulations affecting BDCs.

Qualifying Assets. Under the 1940 Act, a BDC may not acquire any asset other than Qualifying Assets, unless, at the time the acquisition is made, Qualifying Assets represent at least 70% of the company’s total assets. The principal categories of Qualifying Assets relevant to our business are any of the following:

(1)
Securities purchased in transactions not involving any public offering from the issuer of such securities, which issuer (subject to certain limited exceptions) is an Eligible Portfolio Company (as defined below), or from any person who is, or has been during the preceding 13 months, an affiliated person of an Eligible Portfolio Company, or from any other person, subject to such rules as may be prescribed by the SEC. An “Eligible Portfolio Company” is defined in the 1940 Act as any issuer which:
a.
is organized under the laws of, and has its principal place of business in, the United States;
b.
is not an investment company (other than a small business investment company wholly owned by the BDC) or a company that would be an investment company but for certain exclusions under the 1940 Act; and
c.
satisfies any of the following:
i.
does not have any class of securities that is traded on a national securities exchange;
ii.
has a class of securities listed on a national securities exchange, but has an aggregate market value of outstanding voting and non-voting common equity of less than $250 million;
iii.
is controlled by a BDC or a group of companies, including a BDC and the BDC has an affiliated person who is a director of the Eligible Portfolio Company; or
iv.
is a small and solvent company having total assets of not more than $4 million and capital and surplus of not less than $2 million.
(2)
Securities of any Eligible Portfolio Company controlled by the Company.
(3)
Securities purchased in a private transaction from a U.S. issuer that is not an investment company or from an affiliated person of the issuer, or in transactions incident thereto, if the issuer is in bankruptcy and subject to reorganization or if the issuer, immediately prior to the purchase of its securities was unable to meet its obligations as they came due without material assistance other than conventional lending or financing arrangements.
(4)
Securities of an Eligible Portfolio Company purchased from any person in a private transaction if there is no ready market for such securities and the Company already owns 60% of the outstanding equity of the Eligible Portfolio Company.
(5)
Securities received in exchange for or distributed on or with respect to securities described in (1) through (4) above, or pursuant to the exercise of warrants or rights relating to such securities.
(6)
Cash, cash equivalents, U.S. government securities or high-quality debt securities maturing in one year or less from the time of investment.

In addition, a BDC must be operated for the purpose of making investments in the types of securities described in (1), (2) or (3) above.

Significant Managerial Assistance. A BDC must have been organized and have its principal place of business in the United States and must be operated for the purpose of making investments in the types of securities described above. However, in order to count portfolio securities as Qualifying Assets for the purpose of the 70% test, the BDC must either control the issuer of the securities or must offer to make available to the issuer of the securities (other than small and solvent companies described above) significant managerial assistance; except that, where the BDC purchases such securities in conjunction with one or more other persons acting together, one of the other persons in the group makes available such managerial assistance. Making available significant managerial assistance means, among other things, any arrangement whereby the BDC, through its directors, officers or employees, offers to provide and, if accepted, does so provide, significant guidance and counsel concerning the management, operations or business objectives and policies of a portfolio company through monitoring of portfolio company operations, selective participation in board and management meetings, consulting with and advising a portfolio company’s officers or other organizational or financial guidance.

8


Table of Contents

 

Temporary Investments. Pending investment in other types of Qualifying Assets, as described above, our investments can consist of cash, cash equivalents, U.S. government securities or high-quality debt securities maturing in one year or less from the time of investment, which are referred to herein, collectively, as temporary investments, so that 70% of our assets would be Qualifying Assets.

Warrants. Under the 1940 Act, a BDC is subject to restrictions on the issuance, terms and amount of warrants, options or rights to purchase shares that it may have outstanding at any time. In particular, the amount of shares that would result from the conversion or exercise of all outstanding warrants, options or rights to purchase shares cannot exceed 25% of the BDC’s total outstanding shares.

Leverage and Senior Securities; Coverage Ratio. We are permitted, under specified conditions, to issue multiple classes of indebtedness and one class of shares senior to our Common Shares if our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, would at least equal 150% immediately after each such issuance. On July 22, 2021, our sole shareholder approved the adoption of this 150% threshold pursuant to Section 61(a)(2) of the 1940 Act and such election became effective the following day. In addition, while any senior securities remain outstanding, we are required to make provisions to prohibit any dividend distribution to our shareholders or the repurchase of such securities or shares unless we meet the applicable asset coverage ratios at the time of the dividend distribution or repurchase. We are also be permitted to borrow amounts up to 5% of the value of our total assets for temporary or emergency purposes, which borrowings would not be considered senior securities.

We have established one or more credit facilities or enter into other financing arrangements to facilitate investments and the timely payment of our expenses. It is anticipated that any such credit facilities will bear interest at floating rates at to-be-determined spreads over LIBOR or an alternative reference rate. We cannot assure shareholders that we will be able to enter into a credit facility. Shareholders will indirectly bear the costs associated with any borrowings under a credit facility or otherwise. In connection with a credit facility or other borrowings, lenders may require us to pledge assets, commitments and/or drawdowns (and the ability to enforce the payment thereof) and may ask to comply with positive or negative covenants that could have an effect on our operations. In addition, from time to time, our losses on leveraged investments may result in the liquidation of other investments held by us and may result in additional drawdowns to repay such amounts.

We may enter into a total return swap (“TRS”) agreement. A TRS is a contract in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in the market value of the assets underlying the TRS, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during a specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate. A TRS effectively adds leverage to a portfolio by providing investment exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Because of the unique structure of a TRS, a TRS often offers lower financing costs than are offered through more traditional borrowing arrangements. The Company would typically have to post collateral to cover this potential obligation. To the extent the Company complies with the applicable requirements of Rule 18f-4, the leverage incurred through TRS will not be considered a borrowing for purposes of the Company’s overall leverage limitation.

We may also create leverage by securitizing our assets (including in CLOs) and retaining the equity portion of the securitized vehicle. See “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Debt Financing—We may form one or more CLOs, which may subject us to certain structured financing risks.” We may also from time to time make secured loans of our marginable securities to brokers, dealers and other financial institutions.

Code of Ethics. We and the Adviser have adopted a code of ethics pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act and Rule 204A-1 under the Advisers Act, respectively, that establishes procedures for personal investments and restricts certain personal securities transactions. Personnel subject to the code are permitted to invest in securities for their personal investment accounts, including securities that may be purchased or held by us, so long as such investments are made in accordance with the code’s requirements. You may read and copy this code of ethics at the SEC’s Public Reference Room in Washington, D.C. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at (202) 551-8090. You may also obtain copies of the codes of ethics, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at the following email address: publicinfo@sec.gov, or by writing the SEC’s Public Reference Section, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549.

Affiliated Transactions. We may be prohibited under the 1940 Act from conducting certain transactions with our affiliates without the prior approval of our Trustees who are not interested persons and, in some cases, the prior approval of the SEC. We have received an exemptive order from the SEC that permits us, among other things, to co-invest with certain other persons, including certain affiliates of the Adviser and certain funds managed and controlled by the Adviser and its affiliates, subject to certain terms and conditions.

Other. We will be periodically examined by the SEC for compliance with the 1940 Act, and be subject to the periodic reporting and related requirements of the 1934 Act.

We are also required to provide and maintain a bond issued by a reputable fidelity insurance company to protect against larceny and embezzlement. Furthermore, as a BDC, we are prohibited from protecting any Trustee or officer against any liability to our shareholders arising from willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of such person’s office.

We are also required to designate a chief compliance officer and to adopt and implement written policies and procedures reasonably designed to prevent violation of the federal securities laws and to review these policies and procedures annually for their adequacy and the effectiveness of their implementation.

We are not permitted to change the nature of our business so as to cease to be, or to withdraw our election as, a BDC unless approved by a majority of our outstanding voting securities. A majority of the outstanding voting securities of a company is defined under the 1940 Act as the lesser of: (i) 67% or more of such company’s shares present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding shares of such company are present or represented by proxy, or (ii) more than 50% of the outstanding shares of such company.

Financial Condition, Liquidity and Capital Resources

We expect to generate cash primarily from (i) the net proceeds of our public and private offerings of our shares, (ii) cash flows from our operations, (iii) any financing arrangements we may enter into in the future and (iv) any future offerings of our equity or debt securities.

9


Table of Contents

 

Our primary uses of cash will be for (i) investments in portfolio companies and other investments, (ii) the cost of operations (including paying the Adviser and the Administrator), (iii) cost of any borrowings or other financing arrangements and (iv) cash distributions to the holders of our shares.

Investment Advisory Agreement

The Adviser will provide management services to us pursuant to the Advisory Agreement. Under the terms of the Advisory Agreement, the Adviser is responsible for the following:

determining the composition of our portfolio, the nature and timing of the changes to our portfolio and the manner of implementing such changes in accordance with our investment objective, policies and restrictions;
identifying investment opportunities and making investment decisions for us, including negotiating the terms of investments in, and dispositions of, portfolio securities and other instruments on our behalf;
monitoring our investments;
performing due diligence on prospective portfolio companies;
exercising voting rights in respect of portfolio securities and other investments for us;
serving on, and exercising observer rights for, boards of directors and similar committees of our portfolio companies;
negotiating, obtaining and managing financing facilities and other forms of leverage; and
providing us with such other investment advisory and related services as we may, from time to time, reasonably require for the investment of capital.

The Adviser’s services under the Advisory Agreement are not exclusive, and it is free to furnish similar services to other entities, and it intends to do so, so long as its services to us are not impaired.

Compensation of Adviser

We will pay the Adviser a fee for its services under the Advisory Agreement consisting of two components: a management fee and an incentive fee. The cost of both the management fee and the incentive fee will ultimately be borne by the shareholders.

Base Management Fee

The Base Management Fee is payable monthly in arrears at an annual rate of 1.25% of the value of our net assets as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the applicable month. For purposes of the Advisory Agreement, net assets means our total assets less liabilities determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles ("GAAP"). For the first calendar month in which the Company had operations, net assets was measured as the beginning net assets as of the date on which the Company broke escrow for the initial offering. The Adviser agreed to waive the management fee and incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022.

Incentive Fee

The incentive fee will consist of two components that are independent of each other, with the result that one component may be payable even if the other is not. A portion of the incentive fee is based on a percentage of our income and a portion is based on a percentage of our capital gains, each as described below.

Incentive Fee Based on Income

The portion based on our income is based on Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns. “Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns” means, as the context requires, either the dollar value of, or percentage rate of return on the value of our net assets at the end of the immediate preceding quarter from, interest income, dividend income and any other income (including any other fees (other than fees for providing managerial assistance), such as commitment, origination, structuring, diligence and consulting fees or other fees that we receive from portfolio companies) accrued during the calendar quarter, minus our operating expenses accrued for the quarter (including the management fee, expenses payable under the Administration Agreement entered into between us and the Administrator, and any interest expense or fees on any credit facilities or outstanding debt and dividends paid on any issued and outstanding preferred shares, but excluding the incentive fee and any distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees).

Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns include, in the case of investments with a deferred interest feature (such as original issue discount, debt instruments with PIK interest and zero coupon securities), accrued income that we have not yet received in cash. Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns do not include any realized capital gains, realized capital losses or unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation. The impact of expense support payments and recoupments are also excluded from Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns.

Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, expressed as a rate of return on the value of our net assets at the end of the immediate preceding quarter, is compared to a “hurdle rate” of return of 1.25% per quarter (5.0% annualized).

10


Table of Contents

 

We will pay the Adviser an incentive fee quarterly in arrears with respect to our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns in each calendar quarter as follows:

No incentive fee based on Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns in any calendar quarter in which our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns do not exceed the hurdle rate of 1.25% per quarter (5.0% annualized);
100% of the dollar amount of our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns with respect to that portion of such Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, if any, that exceeds the hurdle rate but is less than a rate of return of 1.43% (5.72% annualized). We refer to this portion of our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns (which exceeds the hurdle rate but is less than 1.43%) as the “catch-up.” The “catch-up” is meant to provide the Adviser with approximately 12.5% of our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns as if a hurdle rate did not apply if this net investment income exceeds 1.43% in any calendar quarter; and
o
12.5% of the dollar amount of our Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, if any, that exceed a rate of return of 1.43% (5.72% annualized). This reflects that once the hurdle rate is reached and the catch-up is achieved, 12.5% of all Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns thereafter are allocated to the Adviser.

img132933421_0.jpg 

These calculations are pro-rated for any period of less than three months and adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the relevant quarter. You should be aware that a rise in the general level of interest rates can be expected to lead to higher interest rates applicable to our debt investments. Accordingly, an increase in interest rates would make it easier for us to meet or exceed the incentive fee hurdle rate and may result in a substantial increase of the amount of incentive fees payable to the Adviser with respect to Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns. Because of the structure of the incentive fee, it is possible that we may pay an incentive fee in a calendar quarter in which we incur an overall loss taking into account capital account losses. For example, if we receive Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns in excess of the quarterly hurdle rate, we will pay the applicable incentive fee even if we have incurred a loss in that calendar quarter due to realized and unrealized capital losses.

These calculations are pro-rated for any period of less than three months and adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the relevant quarter. The Adviser agreed to waive the incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022.

Incentive Fee Based on Capital Gains

The second component of the incentive fee, the capital gains incentive fee, is payable at the end of each calendar year in arrears. The amount payable equals:

12.5% of cumulative realized capital gains from inception through the end of such calendar, computed net of all realized capital losses and unrealized capital depreciation on a cumulative basis, less the aggregate amount of any previously paid incentive fee on capital gains as calculated in accordance with GAAP.

Each year, the fee paid for the capital gains incentive fee is net of the aggregate amount of any previously paid capital gains incentive fee for all prior periods. We will accrue, but will not pay, a capital gains incentive fee with respect to unrealized appreciation because a capital gains incentive fee would be owed to the Adviser if we were to sell the relevant investment and realize a capital gain. In no event will the capital gains incentive fee payable pursuant to the Advisory Agreement be in excess of the amount permitted by the Advisers Act, including Section 205 thereof.

The fees that are payable under the Advisory Agreement for any partial period will be appropriately prorated.

Administration Agreement

Under the terms of the Administration Agreement, the Administrator will provide, or oversee the performance of, administrative and compliance services, including, but not limited to, maintaining financial records, overseeing the calculation of NAV, compliance monitoring (including diligence and oversight of our other service providers), preparing reports to shareholders and reports filed with the SEC and other regulators, preparing materials and coordinating meetings of our Board of Trustees, managing the payment of expenses, the payment and receipt of funds for investments and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered by others and providing office space, equipment and office services. We will reimburse the Administrator for the costs and expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its obligations under the Administration Agreement. Such reimbursement will include the Company’s allocable portion of compensation, overhead (including rent, office equipment and utilities) and other expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its administrative obligations under the Administration Agreement, including but not limited to: (i) the Company’s chief compliance officer, chief financial officer and their respective staffs; (ii) investor relations, legal, operations and other non-investment professionals at the Administrator that perform duties for the Company; and (iii) any internal audit group personnel of Apollo or any of its affiliates, subject to the limitations described in Advisory and Administration Agreements. In addition, pursuant to the terms of the Administration Agreement, the Administrator may delegate its obligations under the Administration Agreement to an affiliate or to a third party and we will reimburse

11


Table of Contents

 

the Administrator for any services performed for us by such affiliate or third party. The Administrator hired a sub-administrator to assist in the provision of administrative services. The sub-administrator will receive compensation for its sub-administrative services under a sub-administration agreement.

The amount of the reimbursement payable to the Administrator will be the lesser of (1) the Administrator’s actual costs incurred in providing such services and (2) the amount that we estimate we would be required to pay alternative service providers for comparable services in the same geographic location. The Administrator will be required to allocate the cost of such services to us based on factors such as assets, revenues, time allocations and/or other reasonable metrics. We will not reimburse the Administrator for any services for which it receives a separate fee, or for rent, depreciation, utilities, capital equipment or other administrative items allocated to a controlling person of the Administrator.

Certain Terms of the Advisory Agreement and Administration Agreement

Each of the Advisory Agreement and the Administration Agreement has been approved by the Board of Trustees. Unless earlier terminated as described below, each of the Advisory Agreement and the Administration Agreement will remain in effect for a period of two years from the date it first becomes effective and will remain in effect from year-to-year thereafter if approved annually by a majority of the Board of Trustees or by the holders of a majority of our outstanding voting securities and, in each case, a majority of the independent Trustees. We may terminate the Advisory Agreement or the Administration Agreement, without payment of any penalty, upon 60 days’ written notice. The decision to terminate either agreement may be made by a majority of the Board of Trustees or the shareholders holding a majority of our outstanding voting securities, which means the lesser of (1) 67% or more of the voting securities present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities are present or represented by proxy, or (2) more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities. In addition, without payment of any penalty, the Adviser may terminate the Advisory Agreement upon 120 days’ written notice and the Administrator may terminate the Administration Agreement upon 60 days’ written notice. The Advisory Agreement will automatically terminate within the meaning of the 1940 Act and related SEC guidance and interpretations in the event of its assignment.

The Adviser and the Administrator shall not be liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any act or omission or any loss suffered by the Company in connection with the matters to which the Advisory Agreement and Administration Agreement, respectively, relate, provided that the Adviser and the Administrator shall not be protected against any liability to the Company or its shareholders to which the Adviser or Administrator would otherwise be subject by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence on its part in the performance of its duties or by reason of the reckless disregard of its duties and obligations (“disabling conduct”). Each of the Advisory Agreement and the Administration Agreement provide that, absent disabling conduct, each of our Adviser and our Administrator, as applicable, and its officers, managers, partners, agents, employees, controlling persons, members and any other person or entity affiliated with it (collectively, the “Indemnified Parties”) will be entitled to indemnification from us for any damages, liabilities, costs and expenses (including reasonable attorneys’ fees and amounts reasonably paid in settlement) arising from the rendering of our Adviser’s services under the Advisory Agreement and our Administrator’s services under the Administration Agreement or otherwise as adviser or administrator for us. The Adviser and the Administrator shall not be liable under their respective agreements with us or otherwise for any loss due to the mistake, action, inaction, negligence, dishonesty, fraud or bad faith of any broker or other agent; provided, that such broker or other agent shall have been selected, engaged or retained and monitored by the Adviser or the Administrator in good faith, unless such action or inaction was made by reason of disabling conduct, or in the case of a criminal action or proceeding, where the Adviser or Administrator had reasonable cause to believe its conduct was unlawful. In addition, we will not provide for indemnification of an Indemnified Party for any liability or loss suffered by such Indemnified Party, nor will we provide that an Indemnified Party be held harmless for any loss or liability suffered by us, unless:

(1) we have determined, in good faith, that the course of conduct that caused the loss or liability was in our best interest;

(2) the Indemnified Party was acting on our behalf or performing services for us;

(3) such liability or loss was not the result of negligence or misconduct, in the case that the Indemnified Party is the Adviser or Administrator, as applicable, an affiliate of the Adviser or Administrator or one of our officers; and

(4) the indemnification or agreement to hold harmless is recoverable only out of our net assets and not from our shareholders.

Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement

We have entered into an Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement (the “Expense Support Agreement”) with the Adviser. The Adviser may elect to pay certain of our expenses on our behalf (each, an “Expense Payment”), provided that no portion of the payment will be used to pay any interest expense or distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees of the Company. Any Expense Payment that the Adviser has committed to pay must be paid by the Adviser to us in any combination of cash or other immediately available funds no later than forty-five days after such commitment was made in writing, and/or offset against amounts due from us to the Adviser or its affiliates.

Following any calendar month in which Available Operating Funds (as defined below) exceed the cumulative distributions accrued to the Company’s shareholders based on distributions declared with respect to record dates occurring in such calendar month (the amount of such excess being hereinafter referred to as “Excess Operating Funds”), we shall pay such Excess Operating Funds, or a portion thereof, to the Adviser until such time as all Expense Payments made by the Adviser to the Company within three years prior to the last business day of such calendar month have been reimbursed. Any payments required to be made by the Company shall be referred to herein as a “Reimbursement Payment.” Available Operating Funds means the sum of (i) our net investment company taxable income (including net short-term capital gains reduced by net long-term capital losses), (ii) our net capital gains (including the excess of net long-term capital gains over net short-term capital losses) and (iii) dividends and other distributions paid to us on account of investments in portfolio companies (to the extent such amounts listed in clause (iii) are not included under clauses (i) and (ii) above).

No Reimbursement Payment for any month will be made if: (1) the “Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share” (as defined below) declared by the Company at the time of such Reimbursement Payment is less than the Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share at the time the Expense Payment was

12


Table of Contents

 

made to which such Reimbursement Payment relates, or (2) our “Operating Expense Ratio” (as defined below) at the time of such Reimbursement Payment is greater than the Operating Expense Ratio at the time the Expense Payment was made to which such Reimbursement Payment relates. Pursuant to the Expense Support Agreement, “Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share” means the annualized rate (based on a 365 day year) of regular cash distributions per share exclusive of returns of capital, distribution rate reductions due to distribution and shareholder fees, and declared special dividends or special distributions, if any. The “Operating Expense Ratio” is calculated by dividing Operating Expenses, less organizational and offering expenses, base management and incentive fees owed to Adviser, and interest expense, by our net assets.

The Company’s obligation to make a Reimbursement Payment shall automatically become a liability of the Company on the last business day of the applicable calendar month, except to the extent the Adviser has waived its right to receive such payment for the applicable month.

Distributions

We have declared distributions each month beginning in January 2022 through the date of this report and expect to continue to pay regular monthly distributions. Any distributions we make will be at the discretion of our Board, considering factors such as our earnings, cash flow, capital needs and general financial condition and the requirements of Delaware law. As a result, our distribution rates and payment frequency may vary from time to time.

Our Board of Trustees’ discretion as to the payment of distributions will be directed, in substantial part, by its determination to cause us to comply with the RIC requirements. To maintain our treatment as a RIC, we generally are required to make aggregate annual distributions to our shareholders of at least 90% of our net investment income. See “Description of our Shares” and “Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.”

The per share amount of distributions on Class S, Class D and Class I shares generally differ because of different class-specific shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees that are deducted from the gross distributions for each share class. Specifically, distributions on Class S shares will be lower than Class D shares, and Class D shares will be lower than Class I shares because we are required to pay higher ongoing shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees with respect to the Class S shares (compared to Class D shares and Class I shares) and we are required to pay higher ongoing shareholder servicing fees with respect to Class D shares (compared to Class I shares).

Distribution and Servicing Plan

The Board approved a distribution and servicing plan (the “Distribution and Servicing Plan”). On November 14, 2022, the Board approved amending the Distribution and Servicing Plan to update the effective date to October 29, 2021, the Registration Statement effective date. The following table shows the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees the Company will pay the Intermediary Manager with respect to the Class S, Class D and Class I on an annualized basis as a percentage of the Company’s NAV for such class. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees will be paid monthly in arrears, calculated using the NAV of the applicable class as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month.

 

Classes of Beneficial Interests

 

Shareholder
Servicing and/or
Distribution Fee

 

Class S

 

 

0.85

%

Class D

 

 

0.25

%

Class I

 

N/A

 

 

Subject to FINRA and other limitations on underwriting compensation, the Company will pay a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.85% per annum of the aggregate NAV for the Class S shares and a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.25% per annum of the aggregate NAV for the Class D shares, in each case, payable monthly.

The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees will be paid monthly in arrears. The Intermediary Manager will reallow (pay) all or a portion of the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to participating brokers and servicing brokers for ongoing shareholder services performed by such brokers, and will waive shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to the extent a broker is not eligible to receive it for failure to provide such services. Because the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees with respect to Class S shares and Class D shares are calculated based on the aggregate NAV for all of the outstanding shares of each such class, it reduces the NAV with respect to all shares of each such class, including shares issued under the Company’s distribution reinvestment plan.

Eligibility to receive the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee is conditioned on a broker providing the following ongoing services with respect to the Class S or Class D shares: assistance with recordkeeping, answering investor inquiries regarding us, including regarding distribution payments and reinvestments, helping investors understand their investments upon their request, and provide these services, the Intermediary Manager will waive the shareholder servicing fee and/or distribution that broker would have otherwise been eligible to receive. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees are ongoing fees that are not paid at the time of purchase.

13


Table of Contents

 

Dividend Reinvestment Plan

We have adopted a distribution reinvestment plan, pursuant to which we will reinvest all cash dividends declared by the Board of Trustees on behalf of our shareholders who do not elect to receive their dividends in cash as provided below. As a result, if the Board of Trustees authorizes, and we declare, a cash dividend or other distribution, then our shareholders who have not opted out of our distribution reinvestment plan will have their cash distributions automatically reinvested in additional shares as described below, rather than receiving the cash dividend or other distribution. Distributions on fractional shares will be credited to each participating shareholder’s account to three decimal places.

No action is required on the part of a registered shareholder to have his, her or its cash dividend or other distribution reinvested in our shares, except shareholders in certain states. Shareholders can elect to “opt out” of the Fund’s distribution reinvestment plan in their subscription agreements (other than Alabama, Arkansas, Idaho, Kansas, Kentucky, Maine, Maryland, Massachusetts, Nebraska, New Jersey, Ohio, Oklahoma, Oregon, Texas, Vermont and Washington investors and clients of certain participating brokers that do not permit automatic enrollment in our distribution reinvestment plan and must affirmatively opt in to participate in the plan). Alabama, Arkansas, Idaho, Kansas, Kentucky, Maine, Maryland, Massachusetts, Nebraska, New Jersey, Oklahoma, Oregon, Texas, Vermont and Washington investors and clients of certain participating brokers that do not permit automatic enrollment in our distribution reinvestment plan will automatically receive their distributions in cash unless they elect to have their cash distributions reinvested in additional Common Shares. Ohio residents that own Class S or Class D Shares are not eligible to participate in our distribution reinvestment plan.

If any shareholder initially elects not to participate, they may later become a participant by subsequently completing and executing an enrollment form or any distribution authorization form as may be available from the Fund or the DST Systems Inc. (the “Plan Administrator”). Participation in the distribution reinvestment plan will begin immediately after acceptance of a participant’s subscription, enrollment or authorization. Shares will be purchased under the distribution reinvestment plan as of the first calendar day of the month following the record date of the distribution.

Share Repurchase Program

At the discretion of the Board, we have commenced a share repurchase program in which the Company intends to repurchase, in each quarter, up to 5% of the NAV of our common shares outstanding (either by number of shares or aggregate NAV) as of the close of the previous calendar quarter. The Board may amend or terminate the share repurchase program at any time if in its reasonable judgment it deems such action to be in the best interest of shareholders, such as when a repurchase offer would place an undue burden on the Company’s liquidity, adversely affect the Company’s operations or risk having an adverse impact on the Company that would outweigh the benefit of the repurchase offer. As a result, share repurchases may not be available each quarter. We intend to conduct such repurchase offers in accordance with the requirements of Rule 13e-4 promulgated under the 1934 Act and the 1940 Act. All shares purchased pursuant to the terms of each tender offer will be retired and thereafter will be authorized and unissued shares.

Under the share repurchase plan, to the extent we offer to repurchase shares in any particular quarter, it is expected to repurchase shares pursuant to tender offers on or around the last business day of that quarter using a purchase price equal to the NAV per share as of the last calendar day of the applicable quarter, except that shares that have not been outstanding for at least one year will be repurchased at 98% of such NAV (an “Early Repurchase Deduction”). The one-year holding period is measured as of the subscription closing date immediately following the prospective repurchase date. The Early Repurchase Deduction may be waived in the case of repurchase requests arising from the death, divorce or qualified disability of the holder. The Early Repurchase Deduction will be retained by us for the benefit of remaining shareholders.

 

Valuation Procedures

 

The Board of Trustees has designated the Adviser as its "valuation designee" pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the 1940 Act, and in that role the Adviser is responsible for performing fair value determinations relating to all of the Company's investments, including periodically assessing and managing any material valuation risks and establishing and applying fair value methodologies, in accordance with valuation policies and procedures that have been approved by the Company's Board of Trustees. Even though the Company's Board of Trustees designated the Company's Adviser as "valuation designee," the Company's Board of Trustees continues to be responsible for overseeing the processes for determining fair valuation.

 

In calculating the value of our total assets, we value investments for which market quotations are readily available at such market quotations if they are deemed to represent fair value. Debt and equity securities that are not publicly traded or whose market price is not readily available or whose market quotations are not deemed to represent fair value are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by or under the direction of the Adviser. Market quotations may be deemed not to represent fair value in certain circumstances where the Adviser reasonably believes that facts and circumstances applicable to an issuer, a seller or purchaser or the market for a particular security causes current market quotes not to reflect the fair value of the security. Examples of these events could include cases in which material events are announced after the close of the market on which a security is primarily traded, when a security trades infrequently causing a quoted purchase or sale price to become stale or in the event of a “fire sale” by a distressed seller.

 

If and when market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, we typically utilize independent third party valuation firms to assist us in determining fair value. Accordingly, such investments go through our multi-step valuation process as described below. The Adviser engages multiple independent valuation firms based on a review of each firm’s expertise and relevant experience in valuing certain securities. In each case, our independent valuation firms consider observable market inputs together with significant unobservable inputs in arriving at their valuation recommendations for such Level 3 categorized assets.

 

14


Table of Contents

 

With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available or when such market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, our Adviser undertakes a multi-step valuation process each quarter, as described below:

(1)
Independent valuation firms engaged conduct independent appraisals and assessments for all the investments they have been engaged to review. If an independent valuation firm is not engaged during a particular quarter, the valuation may be conducted by the Adviser;
(2)
At least each quarter, the valuation will be reassessed and updated by the Adviser or an independent valuation firm to reflect company specific events and latest market data;
(3)
Preliminary valuation conclusions are then documented and discussed with senior management of our Adviser;
(4)
The Adviser discusses valuations and determines in good faith the fair value of each investment in our portfolio based on the input of the applicable independent valuation firm; and
(5)
For Level 3 investments entered into within the current quarter, the cost (purchase price adjusted for accreted original issue discount/amortized premium) or any recent comparable trade activity on the security investment shall be considered to reasonably approximate the fair value of the investment, provided that no material change has since occurred in the issuer’s business, significant inputs or the relevant environment.

 

Investments are valued utilizing a market approach, an income approach, or both approaches, as appropriate. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities (including a business). The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts (for example, cash flows or earnings) to a single present amount (discounted). The measurement is based on the value indicated by current market expectations about those future amounts. During the year ended December 31, 2022, there were no significant changes to the Company’s valuation techniques and related inputs considered in the valuation process. In following these approaches, the types of factors that we may take into account in fair value pricing our investments include, as relevant:

available current market data, including relevant and applicable market trading and transaction comparables,
applicable market yields and multiples,
security covenants,
seniority of investments in the investee company’s capital structure,
call protection provisions,
information rights,
the nature and realizable value of any collateral,
the portfolio company’s ability to make payments,
earnings and discounted cash flows,
the markets in which the portfolio company does business,
comparisons of financial ratios of peer companies that are public,
M&A comparables,
our principal market (as the reporting entity) and
enterprise values, among other factors.

 

Investments determined by these valuation procedures which have a fair value of less than $1 million during the prior fiscal quarter may be valued based on inputs identified by the Adviser without the necessity of obtaining valuation from an independent valuation firm, if once annually an independent valuation firm using the procedures described herein provides valuation analysis.

 

Determination of fair values involves subjective judgments and estimates not susceptible to substantiation by auditing procedures. Accordingly, under current auditing standards, the notes to our consolidated financial statements, refer to the uncertainty with respect to the possible effect of such valuations, and any change in such valuations, on our consolidated financial statements.

 

Our Board of Trustees reviews the accuracy of the valuations of our portfolio investments quarterly and, no less frequently than annually, the adequacy of our policies and procedures regarding valuations and the effectiveness of their implementation.

 

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

We have delegated our proxy voting responsibility to the Adviser. The Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures of the Adviser are set forth below. The guidelines will be reviewed periodically by the Adviser, and, accordingly, are subject to change.

15


Table of Contents

 

As an investment adviser registered under the Advisers Act, has a duty to monitor corporate events and to vote proxies, as well as a duty to cast votes in the best interest of clients and not subrogate client interests to its own interests. Rule 206(4)-6 under the Advisers Act places specific requirements on registered investment advisers with proxy voting authority.

Proxy Policies

The Adviser’s policies and procedures are reasonably designed to ensure that the Adviser votes proxies in the best interest of the Company and addresses how it will resolve any conflict of interest that may arise when voting proxies and, in so doing, to maximize the value of the investments made by the Company, taking into consideration the Company’s investment horizons and other relevant factors. It will review on a case-by-case basis each proposal submitted for a shareholder vote to determine its impact on the portfolio securities held by its clients. Although the Adviser will generally vote against proposals that may have a negative impact on its clients’ portfolio securities, it may vote for such a proposal if there exists compelling long-term reasons to do so.

Decisions on how to vote a proxy generally are made by the Adviser. The Investment Committee and the members of the Investment Team covering the applicable security often have the most intimate knowledge of both a company’s operations and the potential impact of a proxy vote’s outcome. Decisions are based on a number of factors which may vary depending on a proxy’s subject matter, but are guided by the general policies described in the proxy policy. In addition, the Adviser may determine not to vote a proxy after consideration of the vote’s expected benefit to clients and the cost of voting the proxy. To ensure that its vote is not the product of a conflict of interest, the Adviser will require the members of the Investment Committee to disclose any personal conflicts of interest they may have with respect to overseeing a Company’s investment in a particular company.

Proxy Voting Records

You may obtain information, without charge, regarding how we voted proxies with respect to our portfolio securities by making a written request for proxy voting information to: Chief Compliance Officer, 9 West 57th Street, New York, NY.

Reporting Obligations and Available Information

Shareholders may obtain copies of our filings with the SEC, free of charge from the website maintained by the SEC at www.sec.gov. Our Internet address is https://gwms.apollo.com/debtsolutionsbdc. We make available free of charge on our website our Annual Report on Form 10-K, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the SEC. Information contained on our website is not incorporated by reference into this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and you should not consider information contained on our website to be part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consideration

The following discussion is a general summary of certain U.S. federal income tax considerations applicable to us and the purchase, ownership and disposition of our shares. This discussion does not purport to be complete or to deal with all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation that may be relevant to shareholders in light of their particular circumstances. Unless otherwise noted, this discussion applies only to U.S. shareholders that hold our shares as capital assets. A U.S. shareholder is an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States, a U.S. corporation, a trust if it (a) is subject to the primary supervision of a court in the United States and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (b) has made a valid election to be treated as a U.S. person, or any estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source. This discussion is based upon present provisions of the Code, the regulations promulgated thereunder, and judicial and administrative ruling authorities, all of which are subject to change, or differing interpretations (possibly with retroactive effect). This discussion does not represent a detailed description of the U.S. federal income tax consequences relevant to special classes of taxpayers including, without limitation, financial institutions, insurance companies, investors in pass-through entities, U.S. shareholders whose “functional currency” is not the U.S. dollar, tax-exempt organizations, dealers in securities or currencies, traders in securities or commodities that elect mark to market treatment, or persons that will hold our shares as a position in a “straddle,” “hedge” or as part of a “constructive sale” for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In addition, this discussion does not address the application of the Medicare tax on net investment income or the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax, or any tax consequences attributable to persons being required to accelerate the recognition of any item of gross income with respect to our shares as a result of such income being recognized on an applicable financial statements. Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors with regard to the U.S. federal tax consequences of the purchase, ownership, or disposition of our shares, as well as the tax consequences arising under the laws of any state, foreign country or other taxing jurisdiction.

Taxation as a Regulated Investment Company

The Company has elected to be treated, and intends to qualify each taxable year thereafter, as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code.

To qualify for the favorable tax treatment accorded to RICs under Subchapter M of the Code, the Company must, among other things:

(1) have an election in effect to be treated as a BDC under the 1940 Act at all times during each taxable year;

(2) have filed with its return for the taxable year an election to be a RIC or have made such election for a previous taxable year;

(3) derive in each taxable year at least 90% of its gross income from (a) dividends, interest, payments with respect to certain securities loans, and gains from the sale or other disposition of stock or securities or foreign currencies, or other income (including but not limited to gains from options, futures or forward contracts) derived with respect to its business of investing in such stock, securities, or currencies; and (b) net income

16


Table of Contents

 

derived from an interest in certain publicly-traded partnerships that are treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes and that derive less than 90% of their gross income from the items described in (a) above (each, a “Qualified Publicly-Traded Partnership”); and

(4) diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of each taxable year of the Company (a) at least 50% of the value of the Company’s total assets is represented by cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities and securities of other RICs, and other securities for purposes of this calculation limited, in respect of any one issuer to an amount not greater in value than 5% of the value of the Company’s total assets, and to not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (b) not more than 25% of the value of the Company’s total assets is invested in the securities (other than U.S. government securities or securities of other RICs) of (I) any one issuer, (II) any two or more issuers which the Company controls and which are determined to be engaged in the same or similar trades or businesses or related trades or businesses or (III) any one or more Qualified Publicly-Traded Partnerships (described in 3(b) above).

As a RIC, the Company generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on its investment company taxable income (as that term is defined in the Code, but determined without regard to the deduction for dividends paid) and net capital gain (the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss), if any, that it distributes in each taxable year to its shareholders, provided that it distributes at least 90% of the sum of its investment company taxable income and its net tax-exempt income for such taxable year. Generally, the Company intends to distribute to its shareholders, at least annually, substantially all of its investment company taxable income and net capital gains, if any.

Amounts not distributed on a timely basis in accordance with a calendar year distribution requirement are subject to a nondeductible 4% U.S. federal excise tax. To prevent imposition of the excise tax, the Company must distribute during each calendar year an amount at least equal to the sum of (i) 98% of its ordinary income for the calendar year, (ii) 98.2% of its capital gains in excess of its capital losses (adjusted for certain ordinary losses) for the one-year period ending October 31 of the calendar year and (iii) any ordinary income and capital gains for previous years that were not distributed during those years. For these purposes, the Company will be deemed to have distributed any income or gains on which it paid U.S. federal income tax.

A distribution will be treated as paid on December 31 of any calendar year if it is declared by the Company in October, November or December with a record date in such a month and paid by the Company during January of the following calendar year. Such distributions will be taxable to shareholders in the calendar year in which the distributions are declared, rather than the calendar year in which the distributions are received.

If the Company failed to qualify as a RIC or failed to satisfy the 90% distribution requirement in any taxable year, the Company would be subject to U.S. federal income tax at regular corporate rates on its taxable income (including distributions of net capital gain), even if such income were distributed to its shareholders, and all distributions out of earnings and profits would be taxed to shareholders as ordinary dividend income. Such distributions generally would be eligible (i) to be treated as “qualified dividend income” in the case of individual and other non-corporate shareholders and (ii) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders. In addition, the Company could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay taxes and make distributions (which could be subject to interest charges) before requalifying for taxation as a RIC.

While the Company generally intends to qualify as a RIC for each taxable year, it is possible that as we ramp up our portfolio we may not satisfy the diversification requirements described above, and thus may not qualify as a RIC, for the short taxable year from the date on which we break escrow for our offering. In such case, however, we anticipate that the associated tax liability would not be material, and that such non-compliance would not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations, although there can be no assurance in this regard. The remainder of this discussion assumes that the Company qualifies as a RIC for each taxable year.

17


Table of Contents

 

Item 1A. Risk Factors

Investing in the Company involves a number of significant risks relating to the current environment, our business and structure, our investments, issuance of our preferred stock, and an investment in our common shares. As a result, there can be no assurance that we will achieve our investment objective. You should carefully consider the risks described below, together with all of the other information included in this report, before you decide whether to invest in the Company. The risks set forth below are not the only risks we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial also may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and/or operating results.

Risks Related to Our Business and Structure

We are a relatively new company and have a limited operating history.

The Company is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company that has elected to be regulated as a BDC with a limited operating history. As a result, prospective investors have a limited track record or history on which to base their investment decision. We are subject to the business risks and uncertainties associated with recently formed businesses, including the risk that we will not achieve our investment objective and the value of a shareholder’s investment could decline substantially or become worthless. Further, the Adviser has not previously offered a non-traded business development company. While we believe that the past professional experiences of the Adviser’s investment team, including investment and financial experience of the Adviser’s senior management, will increase the likelihood that the Adviser will be able to manage the Company successfully, there can be no assurance that this will be the case.

Our Board of Trustees may change our operating policies and strategies without prior notice or shareholder approval, the effects of which may be adverse to our results of operations and financial condition.

Our Board of Trustees has the authority to modify or waive our current operating policies, investment criteria and strategies without prior notice and without shareholder approval. We cannot predict the effect any changes to our current operating policies, investment criteria and strategies would have on our business, NAV, operating results and value of our shares. However, the effects might be adverse, which could negatively impact our ability to pay you distributions and cause you to lose all or part of your investment. Moreover, we have significant flexibility in investing the net proceeds from our continuous offering and may use the net proceeds from our continuous offering in ways with which investors may not agree or for purposes other than those contemplated in this Annual Report.

Our Board of Trustees may amend our Declaration of Trust without prior shareholder approval.

Our Board of Trustees may, without shareholder vote, subject to certain exceptions, amend or otherwise supplement the Declaration of Trust by making an amendment, a Declaration of Trust supplemental thereto or an amended and restated Declaration of Trust, including without limitation to classify the Board of Trustees, to impose advance notice bylaw provisions for Trustee nominations or for shareholder proposals, to require super-majority approval of transactions with significant shareholders or other provisions that may be characterized as anti-takeover in nature.

Price declines in the medium- and large-sized U.S. corporate debt market may adversely affect the fair value of our portfolio, reducing our NAV through increased net unrealized depreciation.

Conditions in the medium- and large-sized U.S. corporate debt market may deteriorate, as seen during the recent financial crisis related to COVID-19, which may cause pricing levels to similarly decline or be volatile. As a result, our NAV could decline through an increase in unrealized depreciation and incurrence of realized losses in connection with the sale of our investments, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our ability to achieve our investment objective depends on the ability of the Adviser to manage and support our investment process. If the Adviser or Apollo were to lose any members of their respective senior management teams, our ability to achieve our investment objective could be significantly harmed.

Since we have no employees, we depend on the investment expertise, skill and network of business contacts of the broader networks of the Adviser and its affiliates. The Adviser evaluates, negotiates, structures, executes, monitors and services our investments. Our future success depends to a significant extent on the continued service and coordination of Apollo and its senior management team. The departure of any members of Apollo’s senior management team could have a material adverse effect on our ability to achieve our investment objective.

Our ability to achieve our investment objective depends on the Adviser’s ability to identify and analyze, and to invest in, finance and monitor companies that meet our investment criteria. The Adviser’s capabilities in structuring the investment process, providing competent, attentive and efficient services to us, and facilitating access to financing on acceptable terms depend on the employment of investment professionals in an adequate number and of adequate sophistication to match the corresponding flow of transactions. To achieve our investment objective, the Adviser may need to hire, train, supervise and manage new investment professionals to participate in our investment selection and monitoring process. The Adviser may not be able to find investment professionals in a timely manner or at all. Failure to support our investment process could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The Advisory Agreement has been approved pursuant to Section 15 of the 1940 Act. In addition, the Advisory Agreement has termination provisions that allow the parties to terminate the agreement. The Advisory Agreement may be terminated at any time, without penalty, by us upon 60 days’ written notice or by the Adviser upon 120 days’ written notice. If the Advisory Agreement is terminated, it may adversely affect the quality of our investment opportunities. In addition, in the event the Advisory Agreement is terminated, it may be difficult for us to replace the Adviser.

18


Table of Contents

 

Our financial condition, business and results of operations, as well as our ability to meet our payment obligations under future indebtedness, if any, and pay distributions, are likely to be adversely affected, and the value of our Common Shares may decline.

Because our business model depends to a significant extent upon relationships with private equity sponsors, investment banks and commercial banks, the inability of the Adviser to maintain or develop these relationships, or the failure of these relationships to generate investment opportunities, could adversely affect our business.

The Adviser depends on the broader Apollo relationships with private equity sponsors, investment banks and commercial banks, and we rely to a significant extent upon these relationships to provide us with potential investment opportunities. If the Adviser or its organizations fail to maintain their existing relationships or develop new relationships with other sponsors or sources of investment opportunities, we may not be able to grow our investment portfolio. In addition, individuals with whom the Adviser or its broader organizations have relationships are not obligated to provide us with investment opportunities, and, therefore, there is no assurance that such relationships will generate investment opportunities for us.

The failure of major financial institutions, namely banks, or sustained financial market illiquidity, could adversely affect our and/or our portfolio companies’ businesses and results of operations.

The failure of certain financial institutions, namely banks, may increase the possibility of a sustained deterioration of financial market liquidity, or illiquidity at clearing, cash management and/or custodial financial institutions. The failure of a bank (or banks) with which we and/or our portfolio companies have a commercial relationship could adversely affect, among other things, our and/or our portfolio companies’ ability to pursue key strategic initiatives, including by affecting our ability to borrow from financial institutions on favorable terms. Our direct origination platform generally focuses on mature companies backed by well-funded large sponsors (e.g., private equity firms), typically with significant equity capital invested. In the event a portfolio company, or potential portfolio company, has a commercial relationship with a bank that has failed or is otherwise distressed, such portfolio company may experience delays or other issues in meeting certain obligations or consummating transactions. Additionally, if a portfolio company’s sponsor has a commercial relationship with a bank that has failed or is otherwise distressed, the portfolio company may experience issues receiving financial support from a sponsor to support its operations or consummate transactions, to the detriment of their business, financial condition and/or results of operations. In addition, such bank failure(s) could affect, in certain circumstances, the ability of both affiliated and unaffiliated co-lenders, including syndicate banks or other fund vehicles, to undertake and/or execute co-investment transactions with us, which in turn may result in fewer co-investment opportunities being made available to us or impact our ability to provide additional follow-on support to portfolio companies. Our and our portfolio companies’ ability to spread banking relationships among multiple institutions may be limited by certain contractual arrangements, including liens placed on their respective assets as a result of a bank agreeing to provide financing.

We may face increasing competition for investment opportunities, which could delay deployment of our capital, reduce returns and result in losses.

We compete for investments with other BDCs and investment funds (including private equity funds, mezzanine funds, performing and other credit funds, and funds that invest in CLOs, structured notes, derivatives and other types of collateralized securities and structured products), as well as traditional financial services companies such as commercial banks and other sources of funding. These other BDCs and investment funds might be reasonable investment alternatives to us and may be less costly or complex with fewer and/or different risks than we have. Moreover, alternative investment vehicles, such as hedge funds, have begun to invest in areas in which they have not traditionally invested, including making investments in large private U.S. companies. As a result of these new entrants, competition for investment opportunities in large private U.S. borrowers may intensify. Some of our competitors are substantially larger and have considerably greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. For example, some competitors may have a lower cost of capital and access to funding sources that are not available to us. In addition, some of our competitors may have higher risk tolerances or different risk assessments than we have. These characteristics could allow our competitors to consider a wider variety of investments, establish more relationships and offer better pricing and more flexible structuring than we are able to do. We may lose investment opportunities if we do not match such competitors’ pricing, terms or structure. If we are forced to match such competitors’ pricing, terms or structure, we may not be able to achieve acceptable returns on our investments or may bear substantial risk of capital loss.

As required by the 1940 Act, a significant portion of our investment portfolio is and will be recorded at fair value as determined in good faith and, as a result, there is and will be uncertainty as to the value of our portfolio investments.

Under the 1940 Act, we are required to carry our portfolio investments at market value or, if there is no readily available market value, at fair value as determined pursuant to policies adopted by, and subject to the oversight of, our Board of Trustees. There is not a public market for the securities of the privately-held companies in which we invest. Many of our investments are not publicly-traded or actively traded on a secondary market. As a result, we value these securities quarterly at fair value as determined in good faith as required by the 1940 Act. In connection with striking a NAV as of the last day of a month that is not also the last day of a calendar quarter, the Company will consider whether there has been a material change to such investments as to affect their fair value, but such analysis will be more limited than the quarter end process.

As part of our valuation process, we will take into account relevant factors in determining the fair value of the Company’s investments without market quotations, many of which are loans, including and in combination, as relevant: (i) the estimated enterprise value of a portfolio company, (ii) the nature and realizable value of any collateral, (iii) the portfolio company’s ability to make payments based on its earnings and cash flow, (iv) the markets in which the portfolio company does business, (v) a comparison of the portfolio company’s securities to any similar publicly traded securities, and (vi) overall changes in the interest rate environment and the credit markets that may affect the price at which similar investments may be made in the future. Our determinations of fair value may differ materially from the values that would have been used if a ready market for these non-traded securities existed. Due to this uncertainty, our fair value determinations may cause our NAV on a given date to materially differ from the value that we may ultimately realize upon the sale of one or more of our investments.

19


Table of Contents

 

There is a risk that investors in our shares may not receive distributions or that our distributions may decrease over time.

We may not achieve investment results that will allow us to make a specified or stable level of cash distributions and our distributions may decrease over time. In addition, due to the asset coverage test applicable to us as a BDC, we may be limited in our ability to make distributions.

The amount of any distributions we may make is uncertain. Our distributions may exceed our earnings, particularly during the period before we have substantially invested the net proceeds from our public offering. Therefore, portions of the distributions that we make may represent a return of capital to you that will lower your tax basis in your shares and reduce the amount of funds we have for investment in targeted assets.

We may fund our cash distributions to shareholders from any sources of funds available to us, including borrowings, net investment income from operations, capital gains proceeds from the sale of assets, non-capital gains proceeds from the sale of assets, dividends or other distributions paid to us on account of preferred and common equity investments in portfolio companies and fee and expense reimbursement waivers from the Adviser or the Administrator, if any. Our ability to pay distributions might be adversely affected by, among other things, the impact of one or more of the risk factors described in this Annual Report. In addition, the inability to satisfy the asset coverage test applicable to us as a BDC may limit our ability to pay distributions. All distributions are and will be paid at the discretion of our Board of Trustees and will depend on our earnings, our financial condition, maintenance of our RIC status, compliance with applicable BDC regulations and such other factors as our Board of Trustees may deem relevant from time to time. We cannot assure you that we will continue to pay distributions to our shareholders in the future. In the event that we encounter delays in locating suitable investment opportunities, we may pay all or a substantial portion of our distributions from borrowings or sources other than cash flow from operations in anticipation of future cash flow, which may constitute a return of your capital. A return of capital is a return of your investment, rather than a return of earnings or gains derived from our investment activities.

Although we do not intend to fund distributions from sources other than operating cash flow in the ordinary course, we may fund distributions from other sources, including but not limited to from proceeds of the offering, if, for example, we determine that it would not be in the best interests of shareholders to sell portfolio investments in a market downturn and we are unable to borrow due to 1940 Act asset coverage limitations to fund distributions. As discussed elsewhere in this prospectus, we are generally required to distribute 90% of our ordinary income to ensure RIC tax treatment and we may take such actions to ensure we meet the applicable RIC tax treatment requirements. Please see, “Risk Factors—Federal Income Tax Risks—We may have difficulty paying our required distributions if we recognize income before or without receiving cash representing such income.” To the extent we pay distributions from a source other than net investment income, we are required to notify shareholders of the sources of such distribution pursuant to Section 19 and Rule 19a-1 under the 1940 Act. Any distributions we make will be at the discretion of the Board of Trustees, which has a fiduciary duty to shareholders, taking into account factors such as our disclosure to investors, earnings, cash flow, capital needs and general financial condition and the requirements of Delaware law.

Our distributions to shareholders may be funded from expense reimbursements or waivers of investment advisory fees that are subject to repayment pursuant to our Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement.

Substantial portions of our distributions may be funded through the reimbursement of certain expenses by our Adviser and its affiliates, including through the waiver of certain investment advisory fees by our Adviser. Any such distributions funded through expense reimbursements or waivers of advisory fees will not be based on our investment performance, and can only be sustained if we achieve positive investment performance in future periods and/or our Adviser and its affiliates continue to make such reimbursements or waivers of such fees. Our future repayments of amounts reimbursed or waived by our Adviser or its affiliates will reduce the distributions that shareholders would otherwise receive in the future. There can be no assurance that we will achieve the performance necessary to be able to pay distributions at a specific rate or at all. Our Adviser and its affiliates have no obligation to waive advisory fees or otherwise reimburse expenses in future periods.

We have not established any limit on the amount of funds we may use from available sources, such as borrowings, if any, or proceeds from our offering, to fund distributions (which may reduce the amount of capital we ultimately invest in assets).

We intend to generally fund distributions from operating cash flow in the ordinary course. However, shareholders should understand that we may make distributions from sources other than cash flow from operations or relying on fee or expense reimbursement waivers, if any, from the Adviser or the Administrator and that such distributions are not based on our investment performance, and can only be sustained if we achieve positive investment performance in future period and/or the Adviser or the Administrator continues to makes such expense reimbursements, if any. The extent to which we pay distributions from sources other than cash flow from operations will depend on various factors, including the level of participation in our distribution reinvestment plan, how quickly we invest the proceeds from this and any future offering and the performance of our investments. To the extent that we borrow to fund distributions, the payment of interest on such borrowings will decrease the Company’s NAV, which would also cause the price per share in our offering to decrease. Shareholders should also understand that any amounts we use to pay distributions to shareholders from sources other than cash flow from operations may be required to be repaid in the future and that our future repayments of such amounts to the Adviser or any lender will reduce the amount of the future distributions. Further, the per share amount of distributions on Class S, Class D and Class I shares may differ because of different allocations of class-specific expenses. For example, distributions on Class S and Class D shares will be lower than on Class I shares because Class S and Class D shares are subject to different shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees. There can be no assurance that we will achieve such performance in order to sustain these distributions, or be able to pay distributions at all. The Adviser and the Administrator have no obligation to waive fees or receipt of expense reimbursements, if any.

 

20


Table of Contents

 

Although we have commenced a share repurchase program, we have discretion to not repurchase your shares or to suspend the program.

Our Board of Trustees may amend or suspend the share repurchase program at any time in its discretion. For example, in accordance with our Board of Trustees’ fiduciary duty to the Company and shareholders, it may amend or suspend the share repurchase program during periods of market dislocation where selling assets to fund a repurchase could have a materially negative impact on remaining shareholders. You may not be able to sell your shares on a timely basis in the event our Board of Trustees amends or suspends the share repurchase program, absent a liquidity event, and we currently do not intend to undertake a liquidity event, and we are not obligated by our charter or otherwise to effect a liquidity event at any time. Following any such suspension, the Board of Trustees will reinstate the share repurchase program when appropriate and subject to its fiduciary duty to the Company and shareholders. We will notify you of such developments in our quarterly reports or other filings. If less than the full amount of Common Shares requested to be repurchased in any given repurchase offer are repurchased, funds will be allocated pro rata based on the total number of Common Shares being repurchased without regard to class. The share repurchase program has many limitations and should not be considered a guaranteed method to sell shares promptly or at a desired price.

The timing of our repurchase offers pursuant to our share repurchase program may be at a time that is disadvantageous to our shareholders.

In the event a shareholder chooses to participate in our share repurchase program, the shareholder will be required to provide us with notice of intent to participate prior to knowing what the NAV per share of the class of shares being repurchased will be on the Repurchase Date. Although a shareholder will have the ability to withdraw a repurchase request prior to the Repurchase Date, to the extent a shareholder seeks to sell shares to us as part of our periodic share repurchase program, the shareholder will be required to do so without knowledge of what the repurchase price of our shares will be on the Repurchase Date.

As a public company, we are subject to regulations not applicable to private companies, such as provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Efforts to comply with such regulations will involve significant expenditures, and noncompliance with such regulations may adversely affect us.

As a public company, we are subject to the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and the related rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC. Our management is required to report on our internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. We are required to review on an annual basis our internal control over financial reporting, and on a quarterly and annual basis to evaluate and disclose changes in our internal control over financial reporting. As a relatively new company, developing and maintaining an effective system of internal controls may require significant expenditures, which may negatively impact our financial performance and our ability to make distributions. This process also will result in a diversion of our management’s time and attention. We cannot be certain of when our evaluation, testing and remediation actions will be completed or the impact of the same on our operations. In addition, we may be unable to ensure that the process is effective or that our internal controls over financial reporting are or will be effective in a timely manner. In the event that we are unable to develop or maintain an effective system of internal controls and maintain or achieve compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and related rules, we may be adversely affected.

We are not required to comply with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, including the internal control evaluation and certification requirements of Section 404, and will not be required to comply with all of those requirements until we have been subject to the reporting requirements of the 1934 Act for a specified period of time or the date we are no longer an emerging growth company under the JOBS Act. Accordingly, our internal controls over financial reporting do not currently meet all of the standards contemplated by Section 404 that we will eventually be required to meet. We are in the process of addressing our internal controls over financial reporting and are establishing formal procedures, policies, processes and practices related to financial reporting and to the identification of key financial reporting risks, assessment of their potential impact and linkage of those risks to specific areas and activities within the Company.

Our independent registered public accounting firm will not be required to formally attest to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting until there is a public market for our shares, which is not expected to occur.

We may experience fluctuations in our quarterly results.

We could experience fluctuations in our quarterly operating results due to a number of factors, including our ability or inability to make investments in companies that meet our investment criteria, the interest rate payable on the loans or other debt securities we originate or acquire, the level of our expenses (including our borrowing costs), variations in and the timing of the recognition of realized and unrealized gains or losses, the degree to which we encounter competition in our markets and general economic conditions. As a result of these factors, results for any previous period should not be relied upon as being indicative of performance in future periods.

General economic conditions could adversely affect the performance of our investments.

The global growth cycle is in a mature phase and signs of slowdown are evident in certain regions around the world, although most economists continue to expect moderate economic growth in the near term, with limited signals of an imminent recession in the U.S. as consumer and government spending remain healthy. Although the broader outlook remains constructive and progress was made on trade, including a phase one deal with China and the United States-Mexico-Canada Agreement, geopolitical instability continues to pose risk. In particular, the outbreak of COVID-19 in many countries, which is a rapidly evolving situation, has disrupted global travel and supply chains, and has adversely impacted global commercial activity and a number of industries, such as transportation, hospitality and entertainment. The rapid development and fluidity of this situation precludes any prediction as to the ultimate adverse impact of COVID-19, or any future pandemics that may arise, which may have a continued adverse impact on economic and market conditions, and may lead to significant declines in corporate earnings or loan performance, and the ability of corporate borrowers to service their debt, any of which could trigger a period of global economic slowdown, and have an adverse impact on the performance and financial results of the Company, and the value and the liquidity of the shares.

21


Table of Contents

 

Volatility in the global financial markets resulting from relapse of the Eurozone crisis, geopolitical developments in Eastern Europe, turbulence in the Chinese stock markets and global commodity markets, the United Kingdom’s vote to leave the European Union or otherwise could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Volatility in the global financial markets could have an adverse effect on the United States and could result from a number of causes, including a relapse in the Eurozone crisis, geopolitical developments in Eastern Europe, turbulence in the Chinese stock markets and global commodity markets or otherwise. In 2010, a financial crisis emerged in Europe, triggered by high budget deficits and rising direct and contingent sovereign debt in Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain, which created concerns about the ability of these nations to continue to service their sovereign debt obligations. While the financial stability of many of such countries has improved significantly, risks resulting from any future debt crisis in Europe or any similar crisis could have a detrimental impact on the global economic recovery, sovereign and non-sovereign debt in these countries and the financial condition of European financial institutions.

Market and economic disruptions have affected, and may in the future affect, consumer confidence levels and spending, personal bankruptcy rates, levels of incurrence and default on consumer debt and home prices, among other factors. Recently, uncertainty between the United States and other countries with respect to trade policies, treaties and tariffs, among other factors, have caused disruptions in the global markets, including markets in which we participate. We cannot assure you that these market conditions will not continue or worsen in the future. Furthermore, we cannot assure you that market disruptions in Europe, including the increased cost of funding for certain governments and financial institutions, will not impact the global economy, and we cannot assure you that assistance packages will be available, or if available, be sufficient to stabilize countries and markets in Europe or elsewhere affected by a financial crisis. To the extent uncertainty regarding any economic recovery in Europe negatively impacts consumer confidence and consumer credit factors, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be significantly and adversely affected.

In the second quarter of 2015, stock prices in China experienced a significant drop, resulting primarily from continued sell-off of shares trading in Chinese markets. In addition, in August 2015, Chinese authorities sharply devalued China's currency. Since then, the Chinese capital markets have continued to experience periods of instability. These market and economic disruptions have affected, and may in the future affect, the U.S. capital markets, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.

The occurrence of events similar to those in recent years, such as the aftermath of the war in Iraq, instability in Afghanistan, Pakistan, Egypt, Libya, Syria, Russia, Ukraine and the Middle East, ongoing epidemics of infectious diseases in certain parts of the world, such as the previously mentioned COVID-19 outbreak, terrorist attacks in the U.S. and around the world, social and political discord, debt crises (such as the Greek crisis), sovereign debt downgrades, continued tensions between North Korea and the United States and the international community generally, new and continued political unrest in various countries, such as Venezuela, the exit or potential exit of one or more countries from the European Union (the "EU") or the Economic and Monetary Union (the "EMU"), the change in the U.S. president and the new administration, among others, may result in market volatility, may have long term effects on the U.S. and worldwide financial markets, and may cause further economic uncertainties in the U.S. and worldwide.

On January 31, 2020, the United Kingdom (the “UK”) ended its membership in the European Union (“Brexit”). On May 1, 2021, the E.U.-U.K. Trade and Cooperation Agreement, or the TCA, became effective. The TCA provides the United Kingdom and EU members with preferential access to each other’s markets, without tariffs or quotas on imported products between the jurisdictions, provided that certain rules of origin requirements are complied with. However, economic relations between the United Kingdom and the EU will now be on more restricted terms than existed prior to Brexit. The long-term effects of Brexit are expected to depend on, among other things, any agreements the UK has made, or makes to retain access to EU markets. Brexit could adversely affect European or worldwide economic or market conditions and could contribute to instability in global financial and real estate markets. In addition, Brexit could lead to legal uncertainty and potentially divergent national laws and regulations as the UK determines which EU laws to replace or replicate. Any of these effects of Brexit, and others we cannot anticipate, could adversely affect our business, business opportunities, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. Likewise, similar actions taken by other European and other countries in which we operate could have a similar or even more profound impact.

 

22


Table of Contents

 

The occurrence of any of these above event(s) could have a significant adverse impact on the value and risk profile of the Company’s portfolio. The Company does not know how long the securities markets may be affected by similar events and cannot predict the effects of similar events in the future on the U.S. economy and securities markets. Non-investment grade and equity securities tend to be more volatile than investment-grade fixed income securities; therefore, these events and other market disruptions may have a greater impact on the prices and volatility of non-investment grade and equity securities than on investment-grade fixed income securities. There can be no assurances that similar events and other market disruptions will not have other material and adverse implications.

Should the U.S economy be adversely impacted by increased volatility in the global financial markets caused by continued contagion from the Eurozone crisis, further turbulence in Chinese stock markets and global commodity markets, Brexit, the war in Ukraine and Russia, health epidemics and pandemics or for any other reason, loan and asset growth and liquidity conditions at U.S. financial institutions, including us, may deteriorate.

The war in Ukraine and Russia may continue to have a material adverse impact on us and our portfolio companies.

On February 24, 2022, the President of Russia, Vladimir Putin, announced a military invasion of Ukraine. In response, countries worldwide, including the United States, have imposed sanctions against Russia on certain businesses and individuals, including, but not limited to, those in the banking, import and export sectors. This invasion has led, is currently leading, and for an unknown period of time will continue to lead to disruptions in local, regional, national, and global markets and economies affected thereby. These disruptions caused by the invasion have included, and may continue to include, political, social, and economic disruptions and uncertainties and material increases in certain commodity prices that may affect our business operations or the business operations of our portfolio companies.

It may be difficult to bring suit or foreclosure in non-U.S. countries.

Because the effectiveness of the judicial systems in the countries in which the Company may invest varies, the Company (or any portfolio company) may have difficulty in foreclosing or successfully pursuing claims in the courts of such countries, as compared to the United States or other countries. Further, to the extent the Company or a portfolio company may obtain a judgment but is required to seek its enforcement in the courts of one of these countries in which the Company invests, there can be no assurance that such courts will enforce such judgment. The laws of other countries often lack the sophistication and consistency found in the United States with respect to foreclosure, bankruptcy, corporate reorganization or creditors’ rights.

The nature of bankruptcy proceedings may impact the value of the Company’s investments.

A portfolio company may become involved in a reorganization, bankruptcy or other proceeding. In any such event, the Company may lose its entire investment, may be required to accept cash or securities or assets with a value less than the Company’s original investment and/or may be required to accept payment over an extended period of time.

In the event of insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of an obligor, holders of debt instruments ranking senior to the Company’s investments would typically be entitled to receive payment in full before the Company receives any distributions in respect of its investments. After repaying the senior creditors, such obligor may not have any remaining assets to repay its obligations to the Company. In the case of debt ranking equally with the loans or debt securities in which the Company invests, the Company would have to share on an equal basis any distributions with other creditors holding such debt in the event of an insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of the relevant investee company. Each jurisdiction in which the Company invests has its own insolvency laws. As a result, investments in similarly situated investee companies in different jurisdictions may well confer different rights in the event of insolvency.

A portfolio company that becomes distressed or any distressed asset received by the Company in a restructuring would require active monitoring. Involvement by the Adviser in a company’s reorganization proceedings could result in the imposition of restrictions limiting the Company’s ability to liquidate its position therein. Bankruptcy proceedings involve a number of significant risks. Many of the events within a bankruptcy litigation are adversarial and often beyond the control of the creditors. While creditors generally are afforded an opportunity to object to significant actions, there can be no assurance that a bankruptcy court would not approve actions which may be contrary to the interests of the Company, particularly in those jurisdictions which give a comparatively high priority to preserving the debtor company as a going concern, or to protecting the interests of either creditors with higher ranking claims in bankruptcy or of other stakeholders, such as employees.

Generally, the duration of a bankruptcy case can only be roughly estimated. The reorganization of a company usually involves the development and negotiation of a plan of reorganization, plan approval by creditors and confirmation by the bankruptcy court. This process can involve substantial legal, professional and administrative costs to the company and the Company; it is subject to unpredictable and lengthy delays, particularly in jurisdictions which do not have specialized insolvency courts or judges and/or may have a higher risk of political interference in insolvency proceedings, all of which may have adverse consequences for the Company. During such process, the company’s competitive position may erode, key management may depart and the company may not be able to invest adequately. In some cases, the company may not be able to reorganize and may be required to liquidate assets. Although the Company will invest only in debt, the debt of companies in financial reorganization will, in most cases, not pay current interest, may not accrue interest during reorganization and may be adversely affected by an erosion of the issuer’s fundamental values. Such investments can result in a total loss of principal.

 

23


Table of Contents

 

One of the protections offered in certain jurisdictions in bankruptcy proceedings is a stay on required payments by the borrower on loans or other securities. When a portfolio company or other issuer seeks relief under the bankruptcy laws of a particular jurisdiction (or has a petition filed against it), an automatic stay prevents all entities, including creditors, from foreclosing or taking other actions to enforce claims, perfect liens or reach collateral securing such claims. Creditors who have claims against the issuer prior to the date of the bankruptcy filing must generally petition the court to permit them to take any action to protect or enforce their claims or their rights in any collateral. Such creditors may be prohibited from doing so if the court concludes that the value of the property in which the creditor has an interest will be “adequately protected” during the proceedings. If the bankruptcy court’s assessment of adequate protection is inaccurate, a creditor’s collateral may be wasted without the creditor being afforded the opportunity to preserve it. Thus, even if the Company holds a secured claim, it may be prevented from collecting the liquidation value of the collateral securing its debt, unless relief from the automatic stay is granted by the court. If relief from the stay is not granted, the Company may not realize a distribution on account of its secured claim until a plan of reorganization or liquidation for the debtor is confirmed. Bankruptcy proceedings are inherently litigious, time consuming, highly complex and driven extensively by facts and circumstances, which can result in challenges in predicting outcomes. The equitable power of bankruptcy judges also can result in uncertainty as to the ultimate resolution of claims. A stay on payments to be made on the assets of the Company could adversely affect the value of those assets and the Company itself. Other protections in such proceedings may include forgiveness of debt, the ability to create super-priority liens in favor of certain creditors of the debtor and certain well-defined claims procedures. Additionally, the numerous risks inherent in the insolvency process create a potential risk of loss by the Company of its entire investment in any particular issuer. Insolvency laws may, in certain jurisdictions, result in a restructuring of the debt without the Company’s consent under the “cramdown” provisions of applicable insolvency laws and may also result in a discharge of all or part of the debt without payment to the Company.

Security interests held by creditors are closely scrutinized and frequently challenged in bankruptcy proceedings and may be invalidated for a variety of reasons. For example, security interests may be set aside because, as a technical matter they have not been perfected properly under applicable law. If a security interest is invalidated, the secured creditor loses the value of the collateral and because loss of the secured status causes the claim to be treated as an unsecured claim, the holder of such claim will be more likely to experience a significant loss of its investment. There can be no assurance that the security interests securing the Company’s claims will not be challenged vigorously and found defective in some respect, or that the Company will be able to prevail against the challenge. As such, investments in issuers involved in such proceedings could subject the Company to certain additional potential liabilities that may exceed the value of the Company’s original investment therein.

Moreover, under applicable bankruptcy law, debt may be disallowed or subordinated to the claims of other creditors if the creditor is found guilty of certain inequitable conduct resulting in harm to other parties with respect to the affairs of a company or other issuer filing for protection from creditors. In addition, creditors’ claims may be treated as equity if they are deemed to be contributions to capital, or if a creditor attempts to control the outcome of the business affairs of an issuer prior to its filing under such laws. If a creditor is found to have interfered with an issuer’s affairs to the detriment of other creditors or shareholders, the creditor may be held liable for damages to injured parties. There can be no assurance that claims for equitable subordination or creditor liability will not be asserted with respect to the Company’s portfolio investments.

While the challenges to liens and debt normally occur in a bankruptcy proceeding, the conditions or conduct that would lead to an attack in a bankruptcy proceeding could in certain circumstances result in actions brought by other creditors of the debtor, shareholders of the debtor or even the debtor itself in other U.S. state or U.S. federal proceedings, including pursuant to state fraudulent transfer laws. As is the case in a bankruptcy proceeding, there can be no assurance that such claims will not be asserted or that the Company will be able successfully to defend against them. To the extent that the Company assumes an active role in any legal proceeding involving the debtor, the Company may be prevented from disposing of securities issued by the debtor due to the Company’s possession of material, non-public information concerning the debtor.

U.S. bankruptcy law permits the classification of “substantially similar” claims in determining the classification of claims in a reorganization for purpose of voting on a plan of reorganization. Because the standard for classification is vague, there exists a significant risk that the Company’s influence with respect to a class of claims can be lost by the inflation of the number and the amount of claims in, or other gerrymandering of, the class. In addition, certain administrative costs and claims that have priority by law over the claims of certain creditors (for example, claims for taxes) may be quite high.

 

24


Table of Contents

 

The insolvency of a portfolio company and related proceedings there may be a materially adverse effect on the performance of the Company.

If a court in a lawsuit brought by a creditor or representative of creditors (such as a trustee in bankruptcy) of a portfolio company were to find that:

(a)
the portfolio company did not receive fair consideration or reasonably equivalent value for incurring the indebtedness evidenced by the securities that the company issued to the Company and
(b)
after giving effect to such indebtedness and the use of the proceeds thereof, the portfolio company
a.
was insolvent,
b.
was engaged in a business for which its remaining assets constituted unreasonably small capital or
c.
intended to incur, or believed that it would incur, debts beyond its ability to pay such debts as they mature, such court could
i.
invalidate, in whole or in part, such indebtedness as a fraudulent conveyance,
ii.
subordinate such indebtedness to existing or future creditors of the obligor or
iii.
recover amounts previously paid by the portfolio company to the Company and/or proceeds with respect to such securities previously applied by the Company, in each case, in satisfaction of such indebtedness.

In addition, upon the insolvency of a portfolio company, payments that such portfolio company made to the Company may be subject to avoidance, cancellation and/or clawback as a “preference” if made within a certain period of time (which may be as long as two years) before insolvency. There can be no assurance as to what standard a court would apply in order to determine whether the company was “insolvent” or that, regardless of the method of valuation, a court would not determine that the company was “insolvent,” in each case, after giving effect to the indebtedness evidenced by the securities held by the Company and the use of the proceeds thereof.

In general, if payments are voidable, whether as fraudulent conveyances, extortionate transactions or preferences, such payments may be recaptured either from the initial recipient (such as the Company) or from subsequent transferees of such payments, including the shareholders. To the extent that any such amounts are recaptured from the Company, there may be a materially adverse effect on the performance of the Company.

The above discussion is based upon U.S. federal and state laws. Insofar as investments that are obligations of non-U.S. obligors are concerned, the laws of non-U.S. jurisdictions may provide for avoidance remedies under factual circumstances similar to those described above, with consequences that may or may not be analogous to those described above under U.S. federal and state laws.

The Company may invest in portfolio companies whose capital structures may have significant leverage, which may impair these companies’ ability to finance their future operations and capital needs.

While investments in leveraged companies offer the potential opportunity for capital appreciation, such investments also involve a higher degree of risk as a result of recessions, operating problems and other general business and economic risks that may have a more pronounced effect on the profitability or survival of such companies. Such investments are inherently more sensitive to declines in revenues, competitive pressures and increases in expenses. Moreover, rising interest rates may significantly increase portfolio companies’ interest expense, causing losses and/or the inability to service debt levels. Leverage magnifies gains and losses attributable to other investment policies and practices, such as investing in below investment grade instruments. If a portfolio company cannot generate adequate cash flow to meet debt obligations, the portfolio company may default on its loan agreements or be forced into bankruptcy resulting in a restructuring of the company’s capital structure or liquidation of the company, and the Company may suffer a partial or total loss of capital invested in the portfolio company. Furthermore, to the extent companies in which the Company has invested become insolvent, the Company may determine, in cooperation with other debt holders or on its own, to engage, at the Company’s expense in whole or in part, counsel and other advisors in connection therewith. In addition to leverage in the capital structure of portfolio companies, the Company may incur leverage.

We are an “emerging growth company” under the JOBS Act, and we cannot be certain if the reduced disclosure requirements applicable to emerging growth companies will make our shares less attractive to investors.

We will remain an “emerging growth company” as defined in the JOBS Act until the earlier of:

(a)
the last day of the fiscal year (i) following the fifth anniversary of the completion of our initial public offering, (ii) in which we have total annual gross revenue of at least $1.07 billion, or (iii) in which we are deemed to be a large accelerated filer, which means the market value of our shares that is held by non affiliates exceeds $700 million as of the date of our most recently completed second fiscal quarter, and
(b)
the date on which we have issued more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt during the prior three-year period.

For so long as we remain an “emerging growth company,” we may take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not “emerging growth companies” including, but not limited to, not being required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. We cannot predict if investors will find our shares less attractive because we will rely on some or all of these exemptions. If some investors find our shares less attractive as a result, there may be a less active trading market for our shares and our share price may be more volatile.

 

25


Table of Contents

 

In addition, Section 107 of the JOBS Act also provides that an “emerging growth company” can take advantage of the extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the 1933 Act for complying with new or revised accounting standards. In other words, an “emerging growth company” can delay the adoption of certain accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies. We will take advantage of the extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards, which may make it more difficult for investors and securities analysts to evaluate us since our financial statements may not be comparable to companies that comply with public company effective dates and may result in less investor confidence.

Any unrealized losses we experience on our portfolio may be an indication of future realized losses, which could reduce our income available for distribution.

As a BDC, we are required to carry our investments at market value or, if no market value is ascertainable, at the fair value as determined in good faith by our Board of Trustees. Decreases in the market value or fair value of our investments relative to amortized cost will be recorded as unrealized depreciation. Any unrealized losses in our portfolio could be an indication of a portfolio company’s inability to meet its repayment obligations to us with respect to the affected loans. This could result in realized losses in the future and ultimately in reductions of our income available for distribution in future periods. In addition, decreases in the market value or fair value of our investments will reduce our NAV.

Terrorist attacks, acts of war, global health emergencies or natural disasters may adversely affect our operations.

Terrorist acts, acts of war, global health emergencies or natural disasters may disrupt our operations, as well as the operations of the businesses in which we invest. Such acts have created, and continue to create, economic and political uncertainties and have contributed to recent global economic instability. Future terrorist activities, military or security operations, global health emergencies or natural disasters could further weaken the domestic/ global economies and create additional uncertainties, which may negatively impact the businesses in which we invest directly or indirectly and, in turn, could have a material adverse impact on our business, operating results and financial condition. Losses from terrorist attacks, global health emergencies or natural disasters are generally uninsurable.

Force Majeure events may adversely affect our operations.

The Company may be affected by force majeure events (e.g., acts of God, fire, flood, earthquakes, outbreaks of an infectious disease, pandemic or any other serious public health concern, war, terrorism, nationalization of industry and labor strikes). Force majeure events could adversely affect the ability of the Company or a counterparty to perform its obligations. The liability and cost arising out of a failure to perform obligations as a result of a force majeure event could be considerable and could be borne by the Company. Certain force majeure events, such as war or an outbreak of an infectious disease, could have a broader negative impact on the global or local economy, thereby affecting the Company. Additionally, a major governmental intervention into industry, including the nationalization of an industry or the assertion of control, could result in a loss to the Company if an investment is affected, and any compensation provided by the relevant government may not be adequate.

Certain of our portfolio companies’ businesses could be adversely affected by the effects of health pandemics or epidemics, including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic, which has had, and may continue to have, a negative impact on our and our portfolio companies’ businesses and operations.

Certain of our portfolio companies’ businesses could be adversely affected by the effects of health pandemics or epidemics, including the ongoing COVID-19 global pandemic, the evolution of which continues to be uncertain. Recurring COVID-19 outbreaks around the world have heightened concerns relating to new and potentially more dangerous virus variants, which, if transmitted around the globe could lead to the re-introduction of restrictions that were in place in 2020, 2021, and to a lesser extent in 2022, or even the adoption of other more strict measures to combat outbreaks. Another severe outbreak of COVID-19 or another pandemic can disrupt our and our portfolio companies’ businesses and materially and adversely impact our and/or their financial results.

The COVID-19 pandemic contributed to certain conditions associated with the current macroeconomic environment and caused significant disruptions and instabilities in the global and U.S. financial markets or deteriorations in credit and financing conditions. A resurgence of COVID-19 or another pandemic with effects similar to those of COVID-19 may adversely affect our and our portfolio companies’ liquidity positions.

Capital markets may experience periods of disruption and instability. Such market conditions may materially and adversely affect debt and equity capital markets in the United States and abroad, which may have a negative impact on our business and operations.

From time to time, capital markets may experience periods of disruption and instability, including during portions of the past three fiscal years. For example, between 2007 and 2009, the global capital markets experienced an extended period of disruption as evidenced by a lack of liquidity in the debt capital markets, write-offs in the financial services sector, the re-pricing of credit risk and the failure of certain major financial institutions. At that time, despite actions of the United States, federal government and foreign governments, these events contributed to worsening general economic conditions that materially and adversely impacted the broader financial and credit markets and reduced the availability of debt and equity capital for the market as a whole and financial services firms in particular. While market conditions have largely recovered from the events of 2008 and 2009, there have been continuing periods of volatility, some lasting longer than others. There can be no assurance these market conditions will not continue or worsen in the future, including as a result of inflation and rising interest rates, the war in Ukraine and Russia, and health epidemics and pandemics.

 

26


Table of Contents

 

Given the extreme volatility and dislocation that the capital markets have historically experienced, many BDCs have faced, and may in the future face, a challenging environment in which to raise capital. We may in the future have difficulty accessing debt and equity capital, and a severe disruption in the global financial markets or deterioration in credit and financing conditions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, significant changes in the capital markets, including the extreme volatility and disruption, have had, and may in the future have, a negative effect on the valuations of our investments and on the potential for liquidity events involving our investments. An inability to raise capital, and any required sale of our investments for liquidity purposes, could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations. AIM monitors developments and seeks to manage our investments in a manner consistent with achieving our investment objective, but there can be no assurance that it will be successful in doing so; and AIM may not timely anticipate or manage existing, new or additional risks, contingencies or developments, including regulatory developments in the current or future market environment.

The current period of capital markets disruption and economic uncertainty may make it difficult to obtain indebtedness and any failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Current market conditions may make it difficult to obtain indebtedness and any failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on our business. The debt capital that will be available to us in the future, if at all, may be at a higher cost and on less favorable terms and conditions than what we currently expect to experience, including being at a higher cost in rising rate environments. If we are unable to raise debt, then our equity investors may not benefit from the potential for increased returns on equity resulting from leverage and we may be limited in our ability to make commitments. An inability to obtain indebtedness could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We may face a breach of our cyber security, which could result in adverse consequences to our operations and exposure of confidential information.

Cyber security incidents and cyber-attacks have been occurring globally at a more frequent and severe level and will likely continue to increase in frequency in the future. Apollo and its affiliates and portfolio companies’ and service providers’ information and technology systems may be vulnerable to damage or interruption from cyber security breaches, computer viruses or other malicious code, network failures, computer and telecommunication failures, infiltration by unauthorized persons and other security breaches, or usage errors by their respective professionals or service providers. If unauthorized parties gain access to such information and technology systems, they may be able to steal, publish, delete or modify private and sensitive information, including non-public personal information related to shareholders (and their beneficial owners) and material non-public information. Although Apollo has implemented, and portfolio companies and service providers may implement, various measures to manage risks relating to these types of events, such systems could prove to be inadequate and, if compromised, could become inoperable for extended periods of time, cease to function properly or fail to adequately secure private information. Apollo does not control the cyber security plans and systems put in place by third-party service providers, and such third-party service providers may have limited indemnification obligations to Apollo, its affiliates, the Company, the shareholders and/or a portfolio company, each of which could be negatively impacted as a result. Breaches such as those involving covertly introduced malware, impersonation of authorized users and industrial or other espionage may not be identified even with sophisticated prevention and detection systems, potentially resulting in further harm and preventing them from being addressed appropriately. The failure of these systems and/or of disaster recovery plans for any reason could cause significant interruptions in Apollo’s, its affiliates’, the Company’s and/or a portfolio company’s operations and result in a failure to maintain the security, confidentiality or privacy of sensitive data, including personal information relating to shareholders (and their beneficial owners), material non-public information and the intellectual property and trade secrets and other sensitive information of Apollo and/or portfolio companies. Apollo, the Company and/or a portfolio company could be required to make a significant investment to remedy the effects of any such failures, harm to their reputations, legal claims that they and their respective affiliates may be subjected to, regulatory action or enforcement arising out of applicable privacy and other laws, adverse publicity, and other events that may affect their business and financial performance.

We may not be able to obtain all required state licenses or in any other jurisdiction where they may be required in the future.

We may be required to obtain various state licenses in order to, among other things, originate commercial loans, and may be required to obtain similar licenses from other authorities, including outside of the United States, in the future in connection with one or more investments. Applying for and obtaining required licenses can be costly and take several months. There is no assurance that we will obtain all of the licenses that we need on a timely basis. Furthermore, we will be subject to various information and other requirements in order to obtain and maintain these licenses, and there is no assurance that we will satisfy those requirements. Our failure to obtain or maintain licenses might restrict investment options and have other adverse consequences.

We are subject to risks related to corporate social responsibility.

Our business faces increasing public scrutiny related to environmental, social and governance (“ESG”) activities. We risk damage to our brand and reputation if we fail to act responsibly in a number of areas, such as environmental stewardship, corporate governance and transparency and considering ESG factors in our investment processes. Adverse incidents with respect to ESG activities could impact the value of our brand, the cost of our operations and relationships with investors, all of which could adversely affect our business and results of operations. Additionally, new regulatory initiatives related to ESG could adversely affect our business.

 

27


Table of Contents

 

Compliance with the SEC’s Regulation Best Interest may negatively impact our ability to raise capital in our offering, which would harm our ability to achieve our investment objectives.

As of June 30, 2020, broker-dealers must comply with Regulation Best Interest, which, among other requirements, enhances the existing standard of conduct for broker-dealers and natural persons who are associated persons of a broker dealer when recommending to a retail customer any securities transaction or investment strategy involving securities to a retail customer. The impact of Regulation Best Interest on broker-dealers participating in our offering cannot be determined at this time, but it may negatively impact whether broker-dealers and their associated persons recommend our offering to retail customers. Regulation Best Interest imposes a duty of care for broker-dealers to evaluate reasonable alternatives in the best interests of their clients. Reasonable alternatives to the Company, such as listed entities, exist and may have lower expenses, less complexity and/or lower investment risk than the Company. Certain investments in listed entities may involve lower or no commissions at the time of initial purchase. Under Regulation Best Interest, broker-dealers participating in the offering must consider such alternatives in the best interests of their clients. If Regulation Best Interest reduces our ability to raise capital in our offering, it would harm our ability to create a diversified portfolio of investments, particularly while the Company has only satisfied the minimum offering amount, and achieve our investment objectives and would result in our fixed operating costs representing a larger percentage of our gross income.

Inflation has adversely affected and may continue to adversely affect the business, results of operations and financial condition of our portfolio companies.

Certain of our portfolio companies are in industries that have been impacted by inflation. Recent inflationary pressures have increased the costs of labor, energy and raw materials and have adversely affected consumer spending, economic growth and our portfolio companies’ operations. If such portfolio companies are unable to pass any increases in their costs of operations along to their customers, it could adversely affect their operating results and impact their ability to pay interest and principal on our loans, particularly if interest rates rise in response to inflation. In addition, any projected future decreases in our portfolio companies’ operating results due to inflation could adversely impact the fair value of those investments. Any decreases in the fair value of our investments could result in future realized or unrealized losses and therefore reduce our net assets resulting from operations. Additionally, the Federal Reserve has raised, and has indicated its intent to continue raising, certain benchmark interest rates in an effort to combat inflation. See “We are exposed to risks associated with changes in interest rates, including the current rising interest rate environment.”

Disruptions to the global supply chain may have an adverse impact on our portfolio companies and, in turn, harm us.

Recent supply chain disruptions, including the global microchip shortage, may have an adverse impact on the business of our portfolio companies. Potential adverse impacts to certain of our portfolio companies may include, among others, increased costs, inventory shortages, shipping and project completion delays, and inability to meet customer demand.

Risks Related to Our Investments

Our investments in portfolio companies are risky, and we could lose all or part of our investment.

Our investments may be risky and there is no limit on the amount of any such investments in which we may invest. In addition, investment analyses and decisions by the Company and the Adviser will often be undertaken on an expedited basis in order for the Company to take advantage of investment opportunities. In such cases, the information available to the Company and the Adviser at the time of an investment decision may be limited, and the Company and the Adviser may not have access to the detailed information necessary for a full evaluation of the investment opportunity. In addition, the financial information available to the Company and the Adviser may not be accurate or provided based upon accepted accounting methods. The Company and the Adviser will rely upon independent consultants or advisors in connection with the evaluation of proposed investments. There can be no assurance that these consultants or advisors will accurately evaluate such investments.

Risk Associated with Unspecified Transactions; No Assurance of Investment Return.

Investors will be relying on the ability of the Adviser to source, negotiate, consummate and syndicate Company originated loans (each, a “loan” and, together with other portfolio investments, the “portfolio investments”) using the investments of shareholders, and there is no assurance that the Adviser will find a sufficient number of attractive opportunities to meet the Company’s investment objectives or that the Company will be able to make and realize its investment objective. The realizable value of a highly illiquid investment, at any given time, may be less than its intrinsic value. In addition, certain types of investments held by the Company may require a substantial length of time to liquidate. Furthermore, to the extent the investment strategy of the Company relies upon a certain set of market and economic conditions and such conditions do not materialize for an extended period of time, the Company may not be able to invest a significant portion of the proceeds. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to generate returns for its investors or that the returns will be commensurate with the risks of investing in the type of portfolio investments and transactions described herein.

Any information included in any of the Company’s marketing materials regarding targeted returns for the Company is provided as an indicator as to how the Company will be managed and is not intended to be viewed as an indicator of likely performance returns to investors in the Company. Any targeted return information is based upon projections, estimates and assumptions that a potential investment will yield a return equal to or greater than the target. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that the Company’s projections, estimates or assumptions will be realized or that the Adviser will be successful in finding investment opportunities that meet these anticipated return parameters.

 

28


Table of Contents

 

Debt Instruments Generally. The Company will invest in debt and credit-related instruments. Such debt may be unsecured and structurally or contractually subordinated to substantial amounts of senior indebtedness, all or a significant portion of which may be secured. Moreover, such debt investments may not be protected by financial covenants or limitations upon additional indebtedness and there is no minimum credit rating for such debt investments. Other factors may materially and adversely affect the market price and yield of such debt investments, including investor demand, changes in the financial condition of the applicable issuer, government fiscal policy and domestic or worldwide economic conditions. Certain debt instruments in which the Company may invest may have speculative characteristics.

Generally, speculative investments securities offer a higher return potential than higher-rated securities, but involve greater volatility of price and greater risk of loss of income and principal. The issuers of such instruments (including sovereign issuers) may face significant ongoing uncertainties and exposure to adverse conditions that may undermine the issuer’s ability to make timely payment of interest and principal. Such instruments are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligations and involve major risk exposure to adverse conditions. In addition, an economic recession could severely disrupt the market for most of these instruments and may have an adverse impact on the value of such instruments. It also is likely that any such economic downturn could adversely affect the ability of the issuers of such instruments to repay principal and pay interest thereon and increase the incidence of default for such instruments.

Loans Risk. The loans that the Company may invest in include loans that are first lien, second lien, third lien or that are unsecured. In addition, the loans the Company will invest in will usually be rated below investment grade or may also be unrated. Loans are subject to a number of risks described elsewhere in this prospectus, including credit risk, liquidity risk, below investment grade instruments risk and management risk.

Although certain loans in which the Company may invest will be secured by collateral, there can be no assurance that such collateral could be readily liquidated or that the liquidation of such collateral would satisfy the borrower’s obligation in the event of non-payment of scheduled interest or principal. In the event of the bankruptcy or insolvency of a borrower, the Company could experience delays or limitations with respect to its ability to realize the benefits of the collateral securing a loan. In the event of a decline in the value of the already pledged collateral, if the terms of a loan do not require the borrower to pledge additional collateral, the Company will be exposed to the risk that the value of the collateral will not at all times equal or exceed the amount of the borrower’s obligations under the loans. To the extent that a loan is collateralized by stock in the borrower or its subsidiaries, such stock may lose some or all of its value in the event of the bankruptcy or insolvency of the borrower. Those loans that are under-collateralized involve a greater risk of loss.

Further, there is a risk that any collateral pledged by portfolio companies in which the Company has taken a security interest may decrease in value over time or lose its entire value, may be difficult to sell in a timely manner, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based upon the success of the business and market conditions, including as a result of the inability of the portfolio company to raise additional capital. To the extent the Company’s debt investment is collateralized by the securities of a portfolio company’s subsidiaries, such securities may lose some or all of their value in the event of the bankruptcy or insolvency of the portfolio company. Also, in some circumstances, the Company’s security interest may be contractually or structurally subordinated to claims of other creditors. In addition, deterioration in a portfolio company’s financial condition and prospects, including its inability to raise additional capital, may be accompanied by deterioration in the value of the collateral for the debt. Secured debt that is under-collateralized involves a greater risk of loss. In addition, second lien debt is granted a second priority security interest in collateral, which means that any realization of collateral will generally be applied to pay senior secured debt in full before second lien debt is paid. Consequently, the fact that debt is secured does not guarantee that the Company will receive principal and interest payments according to the debt’s terms, or at all, or that the Company will be able to collect on the debt should it be forced to enforce remedies.

Loans are not registered with the SEC, or any state securities commission, and are not listed on any national securities exchange. There is less readily available or reliable information about most loans than is the case for many other types of securities, including securities issued in transactions registered under the Securities Act or registered under the Exchange Act. No active trading market may exist for some loans, and some loans may be subject to restrictions on resale. A secondary market may be subject to irregular trading activity, wide bid/ask spreads and extended trade settlement periods, which may impair the ability to realize full value and thus cause a material decline in the Company’s NAV. In addition, the Company may not be able to readily dispose of its loans at prices that approximate those at which the Company could sell such loans if they were more widely-traded and, as a result of such illiquidity, the Company may have to sell other investments or engage in borrowing transactions if necessary to raise cash to meet its obligations. During periods of limited supply and liquidity of loans, the Company’s yield may be lower.

Some loans are subject to the risk that a court, pursuant to fraudulent conveyance or other similar laws, could subordinate the loans to presently existing or future indebtedness of the borrower or take other action detrimental to lenders, including the Company. Such court action could under certain circumstances include invalidation of loans.

If legislation of state or federal regulations impose additional requirements or restrictions on the ability of financial institutions to make loans, the availability of loans for investment by the Company may be adversely affected. In addition, such requirements or restrictions could reduce or eliminate sources of financing for certain borrowers. This would increase the risk of default.

If legislation or federal or state regulations require financial institutions to increase their capital requirements this may cause financial institutions to dispose of loans that are considered highly levered transactions. Such sales could result in prices that, in the opinion of the Adviser, do not represent fair value. If the Company attempts to sell a loan at a time when a financial institution is engaging in such a sale, the price the Company could get for the loan may be adversely affected.

The Company may acquire loans through assignments or participations. The Company will typically acquire loans through assignment. The purchaser of an assignment typically succeeds to all the rights and obligations of the assigning institution and becomes a lender under the credit agreement with respect to the debt obligation; however, the purchaser’s rights can be more restricted than those of the assigning institution, and the Company may not be able to unilaterally enforce all rights and remedies under the loan and with regard to any associated collateral.

 

29


Table of Contents

 

A participation typically results in a contractual relationship only with the institution selling the participation interest, not with the borrower. Sellers of participations typically include banks, broker-dealers, other financial institutions and lending institutions. Certain participation agreements also include the option to convert the participation to a full assignment under agreed upon circumstances. The Adviser has adopted best execution procedures and guidelines to mitigate credit and counterparty risk in the atypical situation when the Company must acquire a loan through a participation.

In purchasing participations, the Company generally will have no right to enforce compliance by the borrower with the terms of the loan agreement against the borrower, and the Company may not directly benefit from the collateral supporting the debt obligation in which it has purchased the participation. As a result, the Company will be exposed to the credit risk of both the borrower and the institution selling the participation. Further, in purchasing participations in lending syndicates, the Company will not be able to conduct the due diligence on the borrower or the quality of the loan with respect to which it is buying a participation that the Company would otherwise conduct if it were investing directly in the loan, which may result in the Company being exposed to greater credit or fraud risk with respect to the borrower or the loan than the Company expected when initially purchasing the participation.

The Company also may originate loans or acquire loans by participating in the initial issuance of the loan as part of a syndicate of banks and financial institutions, or receive its interest in a loan directly from the borrower.

The Adviser has established a counterparty and liquidity sub-committee that regularly reviews each broker-dealer counterparty for, among other things, its quality and the quality of its execution. The established procedures and guidelines require trades to be placed for execution only with broker counterparties approved by the counterparty and liquidity sub-committee of the Adviser. The factors considered by the sub-committee when selecting and approving brokers and dealers include, but are not limited to:

i.
quality, accuracy, and timeliness of execution,
ii.
review of the reputation, financial strength and stability of the financial institution,
iii.
willingness and ability of the counterparty to commit capital,
iv.
ongoing reliability and
v.
access to underwritten offerings and secondary markets.

Loan Origination. The Adviser will originate loans on behalf of the Company. The level of analytical sophistication, both financial and legal, necessary for successful financing to companies, particularly companies experiencing significant business and financial difficulties, is high. There can be no assurance that the Adviser and the Company will correctly evaluate the value of the assets collateralizing these loans or the prospects for successful repayment or a successful reorganization or similar action.

In accordance with Apollo’s co-investment order, the Company’s ability to acquire loans could be dependent on the existence and performance of Apollo’s origination platform, which includes other fund’s managed by Apollo and enables Apollo to commit in size to multiple deals. Therefore, a decrease in Apollo’s origination platform or its inability to acquire investments suitable for the Company could reduce or possibly eliminate the ability of the Company to participate in certain loans within the Company’s investment objective and would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s performance. Other Apollo funds could be subject to certain restrictions on the types of investments they can make, and such restrictions may in effect limit the types of investments the Company could make to the extent that the Company is dependent on Apollo’s origination platform.

Loan origination involves a number of particular risks that may not exist in the case of secondary debt purchases. Apollo may have to rely more on its own resources to conduct due diligence of the borrower, and such borrower may in some circumstances present a higher credit risk and/or could not obtain debt financing in the syndicated markets. As a result, the diligence is likely to be more limited than the diligence conducted for a broadly syndicated transaction involving an underwriter. Loan origination may also involve additional regulatory risks given licensing requirements for certain types of lending in some jurisdictions, and the scope of these regulatory requirements (and certain permitted exemptions) may vary from jurisdiction to jurisdiction and may change from time to time. In addition, in originating loans, the Company will compete with a broad spectrum of lenders, some of which may have greater financial resources than the Company, and some of which may be willing to lend money on better terms (from a borrower’s standpoint) than the Company. Increased competition for, or a diminution in the available supply of, qualifying loans may result in lower yields on such loans, which could reduce returns to the Company. The level of analytical sophistication, both financial and legal, necessary for successful financing to companies, particularly companies experiencing significant business and financial difficulties is unusually high. There is no assurance that the Adviser will correctly evaluate the value of the assets collateralizing these loans or the prospects for successful repayment or a successful reorganization or similar action.

 

30


Table of Contents

 

Senior Loans. The investment objective of the Company includes investing in senior secured term loans. As such, the assets of the Company may include first lien senior secured debt and may also include selected second lien senior secured debt, the latter of which involves a higher degree of risk of a loss of capital.

The factors affecting an issuer’s first and second lien loans, and its overall capital structure, are complex. Some first lien loans may not necessarily have priority over all other unsecured debt of an issuer. For example, some first lien loans may permit other secured obligations (such as overdrafts, swaps or other derivatives made available by members of the syndicate to the company), or involve first liens only on specified assets of an issuer (e.g., excluding real estate). Issuers of first lien loans may have multiple tranches of first lien debt outstanding, each with first liens on separate collateral, or may share first liens on the same collateral. Furthermore, liens with respect to primarily U.S. financings generally only cover U.S. assets, and non-U.S. assets are not included (other than, for example, where a borrower pledges a portion of the stock of first-tier non-U.S. subsidiaries). In the event of Chapter 11 filing by an issuer, the U.S. Bankruptcy Code authorizes the issuer to use a creditor’s collateral and to obtain additional credit by grant of a prior lien on its property, senior even to liens that were first in priority prior to the filing, as long as the issuer provides what the presiding bankruptcy judge considers to be “adequate protection,” which may, but need not always, consist of the grant of replacement or additional liens or the making of cash payments to the affected secured creditor. The imposition of prior liens on the Company’s collateral would adversely affect the priority of the liens and claims held by the Company and could adversely affect the Company’s recovery on its leveraged loans.

Any secured debt is secured only to the extent of its lien and only to the extent of the value of underlying assets or incremental proceeds on already secured assets. Moreover, underlying assets are subject to credit, liquidity, and interest rate risk. Although the amount and characteristics of the underlying assets selected as collateral may allow the Company to withstand certain assumed deficiencies in payments occasioned by the borrower’s default, if any deficiencies exceed such assumed levels or if underlying assets are sold, it is possible that the proceeds of such sale or disposition will not be sufficient to satisfy the amount of principal and interest owing to the Company in respect of its investment.

Senior secured credit facilities are generally syndicated to a number of different financial market participants. The documentation governing such facilities typically requires either a majority consent or, in certain cases, unanimous approval for certain actions in respect of the credit, such as waivers, amendments, or the exercise of remedies. In addition, voting to accept or reject the terms of a restructuring of a credit pursuant to a Chapter 11 plan of reorganization is done on a class basis. As a result of these voting regimes, the Company may not have the ability to control any decision in respect of any amendment, waiver, exercise of remedies, restructuring or reorganization of debts owed to the Company.

Senior secured loans are also subject to other risks, including:

i.
the possible invalidation of a debt or lien as a “fraudulent conveyance”;
ii.
the recovery as a “preference” of liens perfected or payments made on account of a debt in the 90 days before a bankruptcy filing;
iii.
equitable subordination claims by other creditors;
iv.
“lender liability” claims by the portfolio company of the obligations; and
v.
environmental and/or other liabilities that may arise with respect to collateral securing the obligations.

Decisions in bankruptcy cases have held that a secondary loan market assignee can be denied a recovery from the debtor in a bankruptcy if a prior holder of the loans either received and does not return a preference or fraudulent conveyance, or if such prior holder engaged in conduct that would qualify for equitable subordination.

The Company’s investments may be subject to early redemption features, refinancing options, pre-payment options or similar provisions that, in each case, could result in the portfolio company repaying the principal on an obligation held by the Company earlier than expected. As a consequence, the Company’s ability to achieve its investment objective may be adversely affected.

Equity Investments. We may make select equity investments. In addition, in connection with our debt investments, we on occasion may receive equity interests such as warrants or options as additional consideration. The equity interests we receive may not appreciate in value and, in fact, may decline in value. Accordingly, we may not be able to realize gains from our equity interests, and any gains that we do realize on the disposition of any equity interests may not be sufficient to offset any other losses we experience.

Preferred Securities. Investments in preferred securities involve certain risks. Certain preferred securities contain provisions that allow an issuer under certain conditions to skip or defer distributions. If the Company owns a preferred security that is deferring its distribution, the Company may be required to include the amount of the deferred distribution in its taxable income for tax purposes although it does not currently receive such amount in cash. In order to receive the special treatment accorded to RICs and their shareholders under the Code and to avoid U.S. federal income and/or excise taxes at the Company level, the Company may be required to distribute this income to shareholders in the tax year in which the income is recognized (without a corresponding receipt of cash). Therefore, the Company may be required to pay out as an income distribution in any such tax year an amount greater than the total amount of cash income the Company actually received, and to sell portfolio securities, including at potentially disadvantageous times or prices, to obtain cash needed for these income distributions. Preferred securities often are subject to legal provisions that allow for redemption in the event of certain tax or legal changes or at the issuer’s call. In the event of redemption, the Company may not be able to reinvest the proceeds at comparable rates of return. Preferred securities are subordinated to bonds and other debt securities in an issuer’s capital structure in terms of priority for corporate income and liquidation payments, and therefore will be subject to greater credit risk than those debt securities. Preferred securities may trade less frequently and in a more limited volume and may be subject to more abrupt or erratic price movements than many other securities, such as common stocks, corporate debt securities and U.S. government securities.

 

31


Table of Contents

 

Non-U.S. Securities. We may invest in non-U.S. securities, which may include securities denominated in U.S. dollars or in non-U.S. currencies, to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act. Because evidence of ownership of such securities usually is held outside the United States, we would be subject to additional risks if we invested in non-U.S. securities, which include possible adverse political and economic developments, seizure or nationalization of foreign deposits and adoption of governmental restrictions, which might adversely affect or restrict the payment of principal and interest on the non-U.S. securities to shareholders located outside the country of the issuer, whether from currency blockage or otherwise. Because non-U.S. securities may be purchased with and payable in foreign currencies, the value of these assets as measured in U.S. dollars may be affected unfavorably by changes in currency rates and exchange control regulations.

Subordinated Debt. Our subordinated debt investments will generally rank junior in priority of payment to senior debt and will generally be unsecured. This may result in a heightened level of risk and volatility or a loss of principal, which could lead to the loss of the entire investment. These investments may involve additional risks that could adversely affect our investment returns. To the extent interest payments associated with such debt are deferred, such debt may be subject to greater fluctuations in valuations, and such debt could subject us and our shareholders to non-cash income. Because we will not receive any principal repayments prior to the maturity of some of our subordinated debt investments, such investments will be of greater risk than amortizing loans.

Below Investment Grade Risk. In addition, we intend to invest in securities that are rated below investment grade by rating agencies or that would be rated below investment grade if they were rated. Below investment grade securities, which are often referred to as “junk,” have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. They may also be difficult to value and illiquid. The major risks of below investment grade securities include:

Below investment grade securities may be issued by less creditworthy issuers. Issuers of below investment grade securities may have a larger amount of outstanding debt relative to their assets than issuers of investment grade securities. In the event of an issuer’s bankruptcy, claims of other creditors may have priority over the claims of holders of below investment grade securities, leaving few or no assets available to repay holders of below investment grade securities.
Prices of below investment grade securities are subject to extreme price fluctuations. Adverse changes in an issuer’s industry and general economic conditions may have a greater impact on the prices of below investment grade securities than on other higher-rated fixed-income securities.
Issuers of below investment grade securities may be unable to meet their interest or principal payment obligations because of an economic downturn, specific issuer developments or the unavailability of additional financing.
Below investment grade securities frequently have redemption features that permit an issuer to repurchase the security from us before it matures. If the issuer redeems below investment grade securities, we may have to invest the proceeds in securities with lower yields and may lose income.
Below investment grade securities may be less liquid than higher-rated fixed-income securities, even under normal economic conditions. There are fewer dealers in the below investment grade securities market, and there may be significant differences in the prices quoted by the dealers. Judgment may play a greater role in valuing these securities and we may be unable to sell these securities at an advantageous time or price.
We may incur expenses to the extent necessary to seek recovery upon default or to negotiate new terms with a defaulting issuer.

The credit rating of a high-yield security does not necessarily address its market value risk. Ratings and market value may change from time to time, positively or negatively, to reflect new developments regarding the issuer.

LIBOR Risk. On July 27, 2017, the U.K Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) announced that it would phase out LIBOR as a benchmark by the end of 2021. As of December 31, 2021, all non-U.S. dollar LIBOR publications have been phased out. The phase out of a majority of the U.S. dollar publications is delayed until June 30, 2023. The Alternative Reference Rates Committee (“ARRC”) of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York previously confirm that this constitutes a “benchmark transition event” and established “benchmark replacement dates” in ARRC standard LIBOR transition provisions that exist in many U.S. law contracts using LIBOR.

The publication of all EUR and CHF LIBOR settings, the Spot Next/Overnight, 1 week, 2 month and 12 month JPY and GBP LIBOR settings, and the 1 week and 2 months USD LIBOR settings has ceased. The publication of the overnight, 1 month, 3 month, 6 month, and 12 months USD LIBOR settings will cease after June 30, 2023. The FCA plans to consult the market on creating “synthetic” 1 month, 3 month and 6 month rates for GBP and JPY LIBOR, to be published for a limited time. The New York State legislation was signed into law to aid “tough legacy” LIBOR contracts. Other legislative solutions are being pursued at the Federal level, in the U.K. and in Europe. The E.U. Benchmarks Regulation imposed conditions under which only compliant benchmarks may be used in new contracts after 2021.

The ARRC has identified the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”) as its preferred alternative rate for LIBOR. SOFR is a measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight, collateralized by the U.S. Treasury securities, and is based on directly observable U.S. Treasury-backed repurchase transactions. However, the COVID-19 pandemic may adversely impact the timing of many firms’ transition planning, and we continue to assess the potential impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on our transition plans. Although SOFR appears to be the preferred replacement rate for U.S. dollar LIBOR, it is not possible at this time to predict the effect of any such changes, any establishment of alternative reference rates, whether the COVID-19 pandemic will have further effect on LIBOR transition timelines or plans, or other reforms to LIBOR that may be enacted in the United States, United Kingdom or elsewhere.

The discontinuation of LIBOR could have a significant impact on our business. We anticipate significant operational challenges for the transition away from LIBOR, including, but not limited to, amending existing loan agreements with borrowers on investments that may have not been modified with fallback language and adding effective fallback language to new agreements in the event that LIBOR is discontinued before maturity. Beyond these

32


Table of Contents

 

challenges, we anticipate there may be additional risks to our current processes and information systems that we will need to identify and evaluate. Due to the uncertainty of the replacement for LIBOR, the potential effect of any such event on our cost of capital and net investment income cannot yet be determined. In addition, any further changes or reforms to the determination or supervision of LIBOR may result in a sudden or prolonged increase or decrease in reported LIBOR, which could have an adverse impact on the market value of any LIBOR-linked securities, loans and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by or due to us and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Junior, Unsecured Securities. Our strategy may entail acquiring securities that are junior or unsecured instruments. While this approach can facilitate obtaining control and then adding value through active management, it also means that certain of the Company’s investments may be unsecured. If a portfolio company becomes financially distressed or insolvent and does not successfully reorganize, we will have no assurance (compared to those distressed securities investors that acquire only fully collateralized positions) that we will recover any of the principal that we have invested. Similarly, investments in “last out” pieces of unitranche loans will be similar to second lien loans in that such investments will be junior in priority to the “first out” piece of the same unitranche loan with respect to payment of principal, interest and other amounts. Consequently, the fact that debt is secured does not guarantee that we will receive principal and interest payments according to the debt’s terms, or at all, or that we will be able to collect on the debt should it be forced to enforce its remedies.

While such junior or unsecured investments may benefit from the same or similar financial and other covenants as those enjoyed by the indebtedness ranking more senior to such investments and may benefit from cross-default provisions and security over the issuer’s assets, some or all of such terms may not be part of particular Investments. Moreover, our ability to influence an issuer’s affairs, especially during periods of financial distress or following insolvency, is likely to be substantially less than that of senior creditors. For example, under typical subordination terms, senior creditors are able to block the acceleration of the junior debt or the exercise by junior debt holders of other rights they may have as creditors. Accordingly, we may not be able to take steps to protect investments in a timely manner or at all, and there can be no assurance that our rate of return objectives or any particular investment will be achieved. In addition, the debt securities in which we will invest may not be protected by financial covenants or limitations upon additional indebtedness, may have limited liquidity and are not expected to be rated by a credit rating agency.

Early repayments of our investments may have a material adverse effect on our investment objectives. In addition, depending on fluctuations of the equity markets and other factors, warrants and other equity investments may become worthless.

There can be no assurance that attempts to provide downside protection through contractual or structural terms with respect to our investments will achieve their desired effect and potential investors should regard an investment in us as being speculative and having a high degree of risk. Furthermore, we have limited flexibility to negotiate terms when purchasing newly issued investments in connection with a syndication of mezzanine or certain other junior or subordinated investments or in the secondary market.

CLO Risk. Our investments in CLOs may be riskier than a direct investment in the debt or other securities of the underlying companies. When investing in CLOs, we may invest in any level of a CLO’s subordination chain, including subordinated (lower-rated) tranches and residual interests (the lowest tranche). CLOs are typically highly levered and therefore, the junior debt and equity tranches that we may invest in are subject to a higher risk of total loss and deferral or nonpayment of interest than the more senior tranches to which they are subordinated. In addition, we will generally have the right to receive payments only from the CLOs, and will generally not have direct rights against the underlying borrowers or entities that sponsored the CLOs. Furthermore, the investments we make in CLOs are at times thinly traded or have only a limited trading market. As a result, investments in such CLOs may be characterized as illiquid securities.

 

33


Table of Contents

 

“Covenant-lite” Obligations. We may invest in, or obtain exposure to, obligations that may be “covenant-lite,” which means such obligations lack certain financial maintenance covenants. While these loans may still contain other collateral protections, a covenant-lite loan may carry more risk than a covenant-heavy loan made by the same borrower, as it does not require the borrower to provide affirmation that certain specific financial tests have been satisfied on a routine basis as is required under a covenant-heavy loan agreement. Should a loan we hold begin to deteriorate in quality, our ability to negotiate with the borrower may be delayed under a covenant-lite loan compared to a loan with full maintenance covenants. This may in turn delay our ability to seek to recover its investment.

Bridge Financings. From time to time, we may lend to portfolio companies on a short-term, unsecured basis or otherwise invest on an interim basis in portfolio companies in anticipation of a future issuance of equity or long-term debt securities or other refinancing or syndication. Such bridge loans would typically be convertible into a more permanent, long-term security; however, for reasons not always in the Company’s control, such long-term securities issuance or other refinancing or syndication may not occur and such bridge loans and interim investments may remain outstanding. In such event, the interest rate on such loans or the terms of such interim investments may not adequately reflect the risk associated with the position taken by the Company.

Distressed Investments; Restructurings. The Company may make investments in companies that subsequently become distressed (e.g., defaulted, out-of-favor or distressed bank loans and debt securities). Certain of the Company’s investments may, therefore, include specific investments in companies that become highly leveraged with significant burdens on cash flow, and, therefore, involve a high degree of financial risk. Portfolio companies may be facing liquidity challenges due to debt maturities, covenant violations, cyclical challenges or imminent bankruptcy, or they need financing in order to exit bankruptcy. The Company’s investments may be considered speculative and subject to a high degree of risk, and the ability of the relevant portfolio companies to pay their debts on schedule could be adversely affected by interest rate movements, changes in the general economic climate or the economic factors affecting a particular industry, or specific developments within such companies. Investments in companies operating in workout or bankruptcy modes also present additional legal risks, including fraudulent conveyance, voidable preference and equitable subordination risks. The level of analytical sophistication, both financial and legal, necessary for successful investment in companies experiencing significant business and financial difficulties is unusually high. There is no assurance that the Adviser will correctly evaluate the value of the assets collateralizing the Company’s loans or the prospects for a successful reorganization or similar action.

Distressed/Defaulted Securities. The Company may invest in the securities of companies that subsequently become involved in bankruptcy proceedings, reorganizations or financial restructurings, and that may face pending covenant violations or significant debt maturities. In such a case, the Company may have a more active participation in the affairs of such portfolio companies than is generally assumed by an investor. Such investments could, in certain circumstances, subject the Company to certain additional potential liabilities, which may exceed the value of the Company’s original investment therein. For example, under certain circumstances, a lender who has inappropriately exercised control over the management and policies of a debtor may have its claims subordinated or disallowed or may be found liable for damages suffered by parties as a result of such actions. Furthermore, such investments could also subject the Company to litigation risks or prevent the Company from disposing of securities. In any reorganization or liquidation proceeding relating to a portfolio company or an investment, the Company may lose its entire investment, may be required to accept cash or securities with a value less than the Company’s original investment and/or may be required to accept payment over an extended period of time. In addition, under certain circumstances, payments to the Company and the related distributions by the Company to the shareholders may be reclaimed if any such payment or distribution is later determined to have been a fraudulent conveyance, preferential payment, or similar transaction under applicable bankruptcy and insolvency laws. As more fully discussed below, in a bankruptcy or other proceeding, the Company as a creditor may be unable to enforce its rights in any collateral or may have its security interest in any collateral challenged or disallowed, and its claims may be subordinated to the claims of other creditors.

The market for distressed securities is expected to be less liquid than the market for securities of companies that are not distressed. A substantial length of time may be required to liquidate investments in securities that become distressed. Furthermore, at times, a major portion of an issue of distressed securities may be held by relatively few investors, and the market may be limited to a narrow range of potential counterparties, such as other financial institutions. Under adverse market or economic conditions or in the event of adverse changes in the financial condition of the portfolio companies, the Company may find it more difficult to sell such securities when the Adviser believes it advisable to do so or may only be able to sell such securities at a loss. The Company may also find it more difficult to determine the fair market value of distressed securities for the purpose of computing the Company’s net asset value. In some cases, the Company may be prohibited by contract from selling investments for a period of time.

Non-Performing Debt. Certain debt instruments that the Company may invest in may be or become nonperforming and possibly in default. The obligor or relevant guarantor may also be in or enter bankruptcy or liquidation. There can be no assurance as to the amount and timing of payments, if any, with respect to any such debt instruments.

Loans may become non-performing for a variety of reasons and borrowers on loans constituting the Company’s assets may seek the protection afforded by bankruptcy, insolvency and other debtor relief laws. Upon a bankruptcy filing in a U.S. Bankruptcy Court by an issuer of debt, the U.S. Bankruptcy Code imposes an automatic stay on payments of such issuer’s pre-petition debt. A stay on payments to be made on the assets of the Company could adversely affect the value of those assets and the Company itself. Other protections in such proceedings may include forgiveness of debt, the ability to create super-priority liens in favor of certain creditors of the debtor and certain well-defined claims procedures. Nonperforming debt obligations may require substantial workout negotiations, restructuring or bankruptcy filings that may entail a substantial reduction in the interest rate, deferral of payments and/or a substantial write-down of the principal of a loan or conversion of some or all of the debt to equity. Insolvency laws may, in certain jurisdictions, result in a restructuring of the debt without the Company’s consent under the “cramdown” provisions of applicable insolvency laws and may also result in a discharge of all or part of the debt without payment to the Company. If a portfolio company were to file for Chapter 11 reorganization, the U.S. Bankruptcy Code authorizes the issuer to restructure the terms of repayment of a class of debt, even if the class fails to accept the restructuring, as long as the restructured terms are “fair and equitable” to the class and certain other conditions are met.

 

34


Table of Contents

 

Such non-performing instruments or loans may also require a substantial amount of workout negotiations or restructuring, which may entail, among other things, a substantial reduction in the interest rate and a substantial writedown of principal. It is possible that the Company may find it necessary or desirable to foreclose on collateral securing one or more loans purchased by the Company. The foreclosure process varies jurisdiction by jurisdiction and can be lengthy and expensive. Borrowers often resist foreclosure actions, which often prolongs and complicates an already difficult and time-consuming process. In some states or other jurisdictions, foreclosure actions can take up to several years or more to conclude. During the foreclosure proceedings, a borrower may have the ability to file for bankruptcy, potentially staying the foreclosure action and further delaying the foreclosure process. Foreclosure litigation tends to create a negative public image of the collateral assets and may result in disrupting ongoing management of the company. There can be no assurance as to the amount and timing of payments, if any, with respect to any such debt instruments.

Nature of Mezzanine Debt and Other Junior Unsecured Securities. The Company’s strategy may include acquiring mezzanine debt, which generally will be unrated or have ratings or implied or imputed ratings below investment grade, as well as loans or securities that are junior, unsecured, equity or quasi-equity instruments. Mezzanine debt or securities are generally unsecured and/or subordinated to other obligations of the portfolio company, and tend to have greater credit and liquidity risk than that typically associated with investment grade corporate obligations. The risks associated with mezzanine debt or equity investments include a greater possibility that adverse changes in the financial condition of the obligor or in general economic conditions may adversely affect the obligor’s ability to pay principal and interest on its debt. Many obligors on mezzanine debt or equity investments are highly leveraged. As such, specific developments affecting such obligors, such as reduced cash flow from operations or the inability to refinance debt at maturity, may also adversely affect such obligors’ ability to meet debt service obligations. Mezzanine debt or equity instruments are often issued in connection with leveraged acquisitions or recapitalizations in which the portfolio companies incur a substantially higher amount of indebtedness than the level at which they had previously operated.

Default rates for mezzanine debt and other junior unsecured securities have historically been higher than such rates for investment grade securities. If the Company makes an investment that is not secured by collateral and if the portfolio company in question does not successfully reorganize, the Company will have no assurance (as compared to those distressed securities investors that acquire only fully collateralized positions) that it will recover any of the principal that it has invested. While junior, unsecured, equity or quasi-equity investments may benefit from the same or similar financial and other covenants as those enjoyed by the indebtedness ranking more senior to such investments and may benefit from cross-default provisions and security over the portfolio company’s assets, some or all of such terms may not be part of the particular investments. Moreover, the ability of the Company to influence a portfolio company’s affairs, especially during periods of financial distress or following insolvency, is likely to be substantially less than that of senior creditors. For example, under typical subordination terms, senior creditors are able to block the acceleration of the junior debt or the exercise by junior debt holders of other rights they may have as creditors. Accordingly, the Company may not be able to take steps to protect its investments in a timely manner or at all and there can be no assurance that the return objectives of the Company or any particular investment will be achieved. In addition, the debt securities in which the Company may invest may not be protected by financial covenants or limitations upon additional indebtedness, may have limited liquidity and are not expected to be rated by a credit rating agency.

Convertible Securities. Convertible securities are bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks or other securities that may be converted into or exchanged for a specified amount of common stock of the same or different portfolio company within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. A convertible security entitles its holder to receive interest that is generally paid or accrued on debt or a dividend that is paid or accrued on preferred stock, in each case, until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted or exchanged. Convertible securities have unique investment characteristics in that they generally (i) have higher yields than common stocks, but lower yields than comparable nonconvertible securities, (ii) are less subject to fluctuation in value than the underlying common stock due to their fixed income characteristics and (iii) provide the potential for capital appreciation if the market price of the underlying common stock increases.

The value of a convertible security is a function of its “investment value” (determined by its yield in comparison with the yields of other securities of comparable maturity and quality that do not have a conversion privilege) and its “conversion value” (the security’s worth, at market value, if converted into the underlying common stock). The investment value of a convertible security is influenced by changes in interest rates, with investment value declining as interest rates increase and increasing as interest rates decline. The credit standing of the portfolio company and other factors may also have an effect on the convertible security’s investment value. The conversion value of a convertible security is determined by the market price of the underlying common stock. If the conversion value is low relative to the investment value, the price of the convertible security is governed principally by its investment value. To the extent the market price of the underlying common stock approaches or exceeds the conversion price, the price of the convertible security will be increasingly influenced by its conversion value. A convertible security generally will sell at a premium over its conversion value by the extent to which investors place value on the right to acquire the underlying common stock while holding a fixed-income security. Generally, the amount of the premium decreases as the convertible security approaches maturity.

A convertible security may be subject to redemption at the option of the portfolio company at a price established in the convertible security’s governing instrument. If a convertible security held by the Company is called for redemption, the Company will be required to permit the portfolio company to redeem the security, convert it into the underlying common stock or sell it to a third party. Any of these actions could have an adverse effect on the Company’s ability to achieve its investment objective.

Investing primarily in large private U.S. borrowers may limit the Company’s ability to achieve high growth rates during times of economic expansion.

Investing primarily in originated assets made to large private U.S. borrowers may result in the Company underperforming other segments of the market, particularly during times of economic expansion, because large private U.S. borrowers may be less responsive to competitive challenges and opportunities in the financial markets. As a result, the Company’s value may not rise at the same rate, if at all, as other funds that invest in smaller market capitalization companies that are more capable of responding to economic and industrial changes.

35


Table of Contents

 

Our portfolio companies may incur debt that ranks equally with, or senior to, our investments in such companies.

Our portfolio companies may have, or may be permitted to incur, other debt that ranks equally with, or senior to, the debt in which we invest. By their terms, such debt instruments may entitle the holders to receive payment of interest or principal on or before the dates on which we are entitled to receive payments with respect to the debt instruments in which we invest. Also, in the event of insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of a portfolio company, holders of debt instruments ranking senior to our investment in that portfolio company would typically be entitled to receive payment in full before we receive any proceeds. After repaying such senior creditors, such portfolio company may not have any remaining assets to use for repaying its obligation to us. In the case of debt ranking equally with debt instruments in which we invest, we would have to share on an equal basis any distributions with other creditors holding such debt in the event of an insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of the relevant portfolio company and our portfolio company may not have sufficient assets to pay all equally ranking credit even if we hold senior, first-lien debt.

There could be circumstances in which the Company may not be able to control the modification, waiver or amendment of the terms and conditions of a loan agreement if a sufficient number of the other lenders act contrary to the Company’s preferences.

The terms and conditions of loan agreements and related assignments may be amended, modified or waived only by the agreement of the lenders. Generally, any such agreement must include a majority or a supermajority (measured by outstanding loans or commitments) or, in certain circumstances, a unanimous vote of the lenders. The Company and the Adviser would be expected to have the authority to negotiate any amendments or modifications to the portfolio investments that are loans, but even where they do not have any such authority, they may have the authority to give or withhold consent to amendments or modifications initiated and negotiated by portfolio companies or other lenders. Consequently, there could be circumstances in which the Company may not be able to control the modification, waiver or amendment of the terms and conditions of a loan agreement if a sufficient number of the other lenders act contrary to the Company’s preferences. If the Company invests or holds an investment through participation interests or derivative securities rather than directly, it is possible that the Company may not be entitled to vote on any such adjustment of terms of such agreements.

The exercise of remedies may also be subject to the vote of a specified percentage of the lenders thereunder. The Company will have the authority to cause the Company to consent to certain amendments, waivers or modifications to the investments requested by obligors or the lead agents for loan syndication agreements. The Company may, in accordance with its investment management standards, cause the Company to extend or defer the maturity, adjust the outstanding balance of any investment, reduce or forgive interest or fees, release material collateral or guarantees, or otherwise amend, modify or waive the terms of any related loan agreement, including the payment terms thereunder. The Company will make such determinations in accordance with its investment management standards. Any amendment, waiver or modification of an investment could adversely impact the Company’s investment returns.

There may be circumstances where our debt investments could be subordinated to claims of other creditors or we could be subject to, among other things, lender liability or fraudulent conveyance claims.

If one of our portfolio companies were to file for bankruptcy, depending on the facts and circumstances, including the extent to which we actually provided managerial assistance to that portfolio company, a bankruptcy court might recharacterize our debt investment and subordinate all or a portion of our claim to that of other creditors. We may also be subject to lender liability claims for actions taken by us with respect to a borrower’s business or instances where we exercise control over the borrower.

In recent years, a number of judicial decisions in the United States have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories (collectively termed “lender liability”). Generally, lender liability is founded upon the premise that an institutional lender has violated a duty (whether implied or contractual) of good faith and fair dealing owed to a borrower or has assumed a degree of control over the borrower resulting in a creation of a fiduciary duty owed to the borrower or its other creditors or shareholders. Because of the nature of certain of the Company’s investments, the Company could be subject to allegations of lender liability.

In addition, under common law principles that in some cases form the basis for lender liability claims, if a lender or bondholder:

i.
intentionally takes an action that results in the undercapitalization of a borrower to the detriment of other creditors of such borrower,
ii.
engages in other inequitable conduct to the detriment of such other creditors,
iii.
engages in fraud with respect to, or makes misrepresentations to, such other creditors, or
iv.
uses its influence as a stockholder to dominate or control a borrower to the detriment of other creditors of such borrower, a court may elect to subordinate the claim of the offending lender or bondholder to the claims of the disadvantaged creditor or creditors, a remedy called “equitable subordination.”

The Company does not intend to engage in conduct that would form the basis for a successful cause of action based upon the equitable subordination doctrine. However, because of the nature of certain of the Company’s investments, the Company may be subject to claims from creditors of an obligor that debt obligations of which are held by the Company should be equitably subordinated.

The preceding discussion regarding lender liability is based upon principles of U.S. federal and state laws. With respect to the Company’s investments outside the United States, the laws of certain non-U.S. jurisdictions may also impose liability upon lenders or bondholders under factual circumstances similar to those described above, with consequences that may or may not be analogous to those described above under U.S. federal and state laws.

36


Table of Contents

 

We generally will not control our portfolio companies and, due to the illiquid nature of our holdings in our portfolio companies, we may not be able to dispose of our interests in our portfolio companies.

We do not expect to control most of our portfolio companies, even though we may have board representation or board observation rights, and our debt agreements with such portfolio companies may contain certain restrictive covenants. As a result, we are subject to the risk that a portfolio company in which we invest may make business decisions with which we disagree and the management of such company, as representatives of the holders of the company’s common equity, may take risks or otherwise act in ways that do not serve our interests as debt investors. Due to the lack of liquidity for our investments in non-traded companies, we may not be able to dispose of our interests in our portfolio companies as readily as we would like or at an appropriate valuation. As a result, a portfolio company may make decisions that could decrease the value of our portfolio holdings.

We are exposed to risks associated with changes in interest rates, including the current rising interest rate environment.

General interest rate fluctuations may have a substantial negative impact on our investments and our investment returns and, accordingly, may have a material adverse effect on our investment objective and our net investment income.

In an effort to combat inflation, the U.S. Federal Reserve has increased the federal funds rate in 2022 and is widely expected to further increase the federal funds rate in 2023. Because we borrow money and may issue debt securities or preferred stock to make investments, our net investment income is dependent upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds or pay interest or dividends on such debt securities or preferred stock and the rate at which we invest these funds. In this period of rising interest rates, our interest income will increase as the majority of our portfolio bears interest at variable rates while our cost of funds will also increase, to a lesser extent, given the majority of our indebtedness bears interest at fixed rates, with the net impact being an increase to our net investment income. Conversely, if interest rates decrease we may earn less interest income from investments and our cost of funds will also decrease, to a lesser extent, resulting in lower net investment income. From time to time, we may also enter into certain hedging transactions to mitigate our exposure to changes in interest rates. In the past, we have entered into certain hedging transactions, such as interest rate swap agreements, to mitigate our exposure to adverse fluctuations in interest rates, and we may do so again in the future. However, we cannot assure you that such transactions will be successful in mitigating our exposure to interest rate risk. There can be no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates will not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income.

Our portfolio primarily consists of fixed and floating rate investments. Market prices tend to fluctuate more for fixed-rate securities that have longer maturities. Although we have no policy governing the maturities of our investments, under current market conditions we expect that we will invest in a portfolio of debt generally having maturities of up to 10 years. Market prices for debt that pays a fixed rate of return tend to decline as interest rates rise. This means that we are subject to greater risk (other things being equal) than a fund invested solely in shorter-term, fixed-rate securities. Market prices for floating rate investments may also fluctuate in rising rate environments with prices tending to decline when credit spreads widen. A decline in the prices of the debt we own could adversely affect our net assets resulting from operations and the market price of our common shares.

Rising interest rates may also increase the cost of debt for our underlying portfolio companies, which could adversely impact their financial performance and ability to meet ongoing obligations to us. Also, an increase in interest rates available to investors could make an investment in our common shares less attractive if we are not able to pay dividends at a level that provides a similar return, which could reduce the value of our common shares.

Any inaccuracy or incompleteness by a portfolio company or breach of covenants may adversely affect the valuation of the collateral underlying the loans or the ability of the lenders to perfect or effectuate a lien on the collateral securing the loan or the Company’s ability to otherwise realize on or avoid losses in respect of the investment.

The Company will seek to make or acquire portfolio investments having structural, covenant and other contractual terms providing adequate downside protection, but there can be no assurance that such attempts to provide downside protection with respect to its investments will achieve their desired effect, and, accordingly, potential investors should regard an investment in the Company as being speculative and having a high degree of risk. Of paramount concern in making or acquiring a portfolio investment is the possibility of material misrepresentation or omission on the part of the portfolio investment seller, the portfolio company or other credit support providers, or breach of covenant by any such parties. Such inaccuracy or incompleteness or breach of covenants may adversely affect the valuation of the collateral underlying the loans or the ability of the lenders to perfect or effectuate a lien on the collateral securing the loan or the Company’s ability to otherwise realize on or avoid losses in respect of the investment. The Company will rely upon the accuracy and completeness of representations made by any such parties to the extent reasonable, but cannot guarantee such accuracy or completeness.

Additionally, of particular concern in portfolio investments in loans or other debt instruments is the possibility of material misrepresentation or omission on the part of the borrower or issuer of such debt instruments. Such inaccuracy or incompleteness may adversely affect the valuation of the collateral underlying the loans, notes or bonds or may adversely affect the ability of the Company to perfect or effectuate a lien on any collateral securing the investment. The Company will rely upon the accuracy and completeness of representations made by borrowers or issuers of securities and their respective agents when it makes its investments, but cannot guarantee such accuracy or completeness. Under certain circumstances, payments to the Company may be reclaimed if any such payment or distribution is later determined to have been a fraudulent conveyance or a preferential payment.

37


Table of Contents

 

Second priority liens on collateral securing debt investments that we make to our portfolio companies may be subject to control by senior creditors with first priority liens. If there is a default, the value of the collateral may not be sufficient to repay in full both the first priority creditors and us.

Certain debt investments that we make to portfolio companies may be secured on a second priority basis by the same collateral securing first priority debt of such companies. The first priority liens on the collateral will secure the portfolio company’s obligations under any outstanding senior debt and may secure certain other future debt that may be permitted to be incurred by the company under the agreements governing the loans. The holders of obligations secured by the first priority liens on the collateral will generally control the liquidation of and be entitled to receive proceeds from any realization of the collateral to repay their obligations in full before us. In addition, the value of the collateral in the event of liquidation will depend on market and economic conditions, the availability of buyers and other factors. There can be no assurance that the proceeds, if any, from the sale or sales of all of the collateral would be sufficient to satisfy the debt obligations secured by the second priority liens after payment in full of all obligations secured by the first priority liens on the collateral. If such proceeds are not sufficient to repay amounts outstanding under the debt obligations secured by the second priority liens, then we, to the extent not repaid from the proceeds of the sale of the collateral, will only have an unsecured claim against the company remaining assets, if any.

We may also make unsecured debt investments in portfolio companies, meaning that such investments will not benefit from any interest in collateral of such companies. Liens on such portfolio companies’ collateral, if any, will secure the portfolio company’s obligations under its outstanding secured debt and may secure certain future debt that is permitted to be incurred by the portfolio company under its secured debt agreements. The holders of obligations secured by such liens will generally control the liquidation of, and be entitled to receive proceeds from, any realization of such collateral to repay their obligations in full before we are so entitled. In addition, the value of such collateral in the event of liquidation will depend on market and economic conditions, the availability of buyers and other factors. There can be no assurance that the proceeds, if any, from sales of such collateral would be sufficient to satisfy its unsecured debt obligations after payment in full of all secured debt obligations. If such proceeds were not sufficient to repay the outstanding secured debt obligations, then its unsecured claims would rank equally with the unpaid portion of such secured creditors’ claims against the portfolio company’s remaining assets, if any.

The rights we may have with respect to the collateral securing the debt investments we make to our portfolio companies with senior debt outstanding may also be limited pursuant to the terms of one or more intercreditor agreements that we enter into with the holders of senior debt. Under such an intercreditor agreement, at any time that obligations that have the benefit of the first priority liens are outstanding, any of the following actions that may be taken in respect of the collateral will be at the direction of the holders of the obligations secured by the first priority liens: the ability to cause the commencement of enforcement proceedings against the collateral; the ability to control the conduct of such proceedings; the approval of amendments to collateral documents; releases of liens on the collateral; and waivers of past defaults under collateral documents. We may not have the ability to control or direct such actions, even if our rights are adversely affected.

The portfolio investments in which the Company invests and Apollo’s portfolio companies will be subject to various laws for the protection of creditors in the jurisdictions of the portfolio companies concerned.

Differences in law may adversely affect the rights of the Company as a lender with respect to other creditors. Additionally, the Company, as a creditor, may experience less favorable treatment under different insolvency regimes than those that apply in the United States, including in cases where the Company seeks to enforce any security it may hold as a creditor.

Limited amortization requirements may extend the expected weighted average life of the investment.

The Company may invest in loans that have limited mandatory amortization requirements. While these loans may obligate a portfolio company to repay the loan out of asset sale proceeds or with annual excess cash flow, repayment requirements may be subject to substantial limitations that would allow a portfolio company to retain such asset sale proceeds or cash flow, thereby extending the expected weighted average life of the investment. In addition, a low level of amortization of any debt over the life of the investment may increase the risk that the portfolio company will not be able to repay or refinance the loans held by the Company when it matures.

Economic recessions or downturns could impair our portfolio companies and adversely affect our operating results.

The current macroeconomic environment is characterized by record-high inflation, supply chain challenges, labor shortages, high interest rates, foreign currency exchange volatility, volatility in global capital markets and growing recession risk. The risks associated with our and our portfolio companies’ businesses are more severe during periods of economic slowdown or recession.

Many of our portfolio companies may be susceptible to economic slowdowns or recessions and may be unable to repay our loans during these periods. See "Certain of our portfolio companies’ businesses could be adversely affected by the effects of health pandemics or epidemics, including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic, which has had, and may continue to have, a negative impact on our and our portfolio companies’ businesses and operations." Therefore, our non-performing assets may increase and the value of our portfolio may decrease during these periods if we are required to write down the values of our investments. Adverse economic conditions also may decrease the value of collateral securing some of our loans and the value of our equity investments. Economic slowdowns or recessions could lead to financial losses in our portfolio and a decrease in revenues, net income and assets. Unfavorable economic conditions also could increase our funding costs, limit our access to the capital markets or result in a decision by lenders not to extend credit to us. These events could prevent us from increasing investments and harm our operating results.

A portfolio company’s failure to satisfy financial or operating covenants imposed by us or other lenders could lead to defaults and, potentially, acceleration of the time when the loans are due and foreclosure on its secured assets, which could trigger cross-defaults under other agreements and jeopardize the portfolio company’s ability to meet its obligations under the debt that we hold. We may incur additional expenses to the extent necessary to seek recovery upon default or to negotiate new terms with a defaulting portfolio company.

38


Table of Contents

 

Implementation of the Company’s strategy is dependent in part on market dislocation impacting the global credit markets.

Implementation of the Company’s investment strategy will depend, in part, on the extent to which the global credit markets continue to experience disruption, liquidity shortages and financial instability. Prolonged disruption may prevent the Company from advantageously realizing on or disposing of its investments. A further economic downturn could adversely affect the financial resources and credit quality of the underlying portfolio companies of any debt instruments in which the Company may invest and result in the inability of such borrowers to make principal and interest payments on, or refinance, outstanding debt when due. In the event of such defaults, the Company may suffer a partial or total loss of capital invested in such companies, which would, in turn, have an adverse effect on the Company’s returns. Any such defaults may have an adverse effect on the Company’s investments. Such marketplace events also may restrict the ability of the Company to sell or liquidate investments at favorable times or for favorable prices (although such marketplace events may not foreclose the Company’s ability to hold such investments until maturity). Further, the Company’s investment strategy may be impacted in part by changes in the conditions in the global financial markets generally and credit markets specifically. In the event of a further market deterioration, the value of the Company’s investments may not appreciate as projected or may suffer a loss.

A covenant breach or other default by our portfolio companies may adversely affect our operating results.

A portfolio company’s failure to satisfy financial or operating covenants imposed by us or other lenders could lead to defaults and, potentially, termination of its loans and foreclosure on its secured assets, which could trigger cross-defaults under other agreements and jeopardize a portfolio company’s ability to meet its obligations under the debt or equity securities that we hold. We may incur expenses to the extent necessary to seek recovery upon default or to negotiate new terms, which may include the waiver of certain financial covenants, with a defaulting portfolio company. In addition, lenders in certain cases can be subject to lender liability claims for actions taken by them when they become too involved in the borrower’s business or exercise control over a borrower. It is possible that we could become subject to a lender’s liability claim, including as a result of actions taken if we render significant managerial assistance to the borrower. Furthermore, if one of our portfolio companies were to file for bankruptcy protection, a bankruptcy court might recharacterize our debt holding and subordinate all or a portion of our claim to claims of other creditors, even though we may have structured our investment as senior secured debt. The likelihood of such a re-characterization would depend on the facts and circumstances, including the extent to which we provided managerial assistance to that portfolio company.

Our portfolio companies may be highly leveraged.

Some of our portfolio companies may be highly leveraged, which may have adverse consequences to these companies and to us as an investor. These companies may be subject to restrictive financial and operating covenants and the leverage may impair these companies’ ability to finance their future operations and capital needs. As a result, these companies’ flexibility to respond to changing business and economic conditions and to take advantage of business opportunities may be limited. Further, a leveraged company’s income and net assets will tend to increase or decrease at a greater rate than if borrowed money were not used.

Loans to private companies involve risks that may not exist in the case of more established and/or publicly traded companies.

These risks include the risk that:

these companies may have limited financial resources and limited access to additional financing, which may increase the risk of their defaulting on their obligations, leaving creditors, such as the Company, dependent on any guarantees or collateral that they may have obtained;
these companies frequently have shorter operating histories, narrower product lines and smaller market shares than larger businesses, which render such companies more vulnerable to competition and market conditions, as well as general economic downturns;
there will not be as much information publicly available about these companies as would be available for public companies and such information may not be of the same quality;
these companies are more likely to depend on the management talents and efforts of a small group of persons; as a result, the death, disability, resignation or termination of one or more of these persons could have a material adverse impact on these companies’ ability to meet their obligations;
these companies generally have less predictable operating results, may from time to time be parties to litigation, may be engaged in rapidly changing businesses with products subject to a substantial risk of obsolescence, and may require substantial additional capital to support their operations, finance their expansion or maintain their competitive position; and
these companies may have difficulty accessing the capital markets to meet future capital needs, which may limit their ability to grow or to repay their outstanding indebtedness upon maturity.

 

39


Table of Contents

 

We may not realize gains from our equity investments.

Certain investments that we may make could include warrants or other equity securities. In addition, we may make direct equity investments in portfolio companies. Our goal is ultimately to realize gains upon our disposition of such equity interests. However, the equity interests we receive may not appreciate in value and, in fact, may decline in value. Accordingly, we may not be able to realize gains from our equity interests, and any gains that we do realize on the disposition of any equity interests may not be sufficient to offset any other losses we experience. We also may be unable to realize any value if a portfolio company does not have a liquidity event, such as a sale of the business, recapitalization or public offering, which would allow us to sell the underlying equity interests. We intend to seek puts or similar rights to give us the right to sell our equity securities back to the portfolio company issuer. We may be unable to exercise these put rights for the consideration provided in our investment documents if the issuer is in financial distress.

An investment strategy focused primarily on privately-held companies presents certain challenges, including, but not limited to, the lack of available information about these companies.

We intend to invest primarily in privately-held companies. Investments in private companies pose significantly greater risks than investments in public companies. First, private companies have reduced access to the capital markets, resulting in diminished capital resources and the ability to withstand financial distress. Second, the depth and breadth of experience of management in private companies tends to be less than that at public companies, which makes such companies more likely to depend on the management talents and efforts of a smaller group of persons and/or persons with less depth and breadth of experience. Therefore, the decisions made by such management teams and/or the death, disability, resignation or termination of one or more of these persons could have a material adverse impact on our investments and, in turn, on us. Third, the investments themselves tend to be less liquid. As such, we may have difficulty exiting an investment promptly or at a desired price prior to maturity or outside of a normal amortization schedule. As a result, the relative lack of liquidity and the potential diminished capital resources of our target portfolio companies may affect our investment returns.

Fourth, little public information generally exists about private companies. Further, these companies may not have third-party debt ratings or audited financial statements. We must therefore rely on the ability of the Adviser to obtain adequate information through due diligence to evaluate the creditworthiness and potential returns from investing in these companies. The Adviser would typically assess an investment in a portfolio company based on the Adviser’s estimate of the portfolio company’s earnings and enterprise value, among other things, and these estimates may be based on limited information and may otherwise be inaccurate, causing the Adviser to make different investment decisions than it may have made with more complete information. These companies and their financial information will generally not be subject to the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and other rules that govern public companies. If we are unable to uncover all material information about these companies, we may not make a fully informed investment decision, and we may lose money on our investments.

Our investments in securities or assets of publicly-traded companies are subject to the risks inherent in investing in public securities.

We may invest a portion of our portfolio in publicly-traded assets. For example, it is not expected that we will be able to negotiate additional financial covenants or other contractual rights, which we might otherwise be able to obtain in making privately negotiated investments. In addition, by investing in publicly-traded securities or assets, we will be subject to U.S. federal and state securities laws, as well as non-U.S. securities laws, that may, among other things, restrict or prohibit our ability to make or sell an investment. Moreover, we may not have the same access to information in connection with investments in public securities, either when investigating a potential investment or after making an investment, as compared to privately negotiated investments. Furthermore, we may be limited in its ability to make investments and to sell existing investments in public securities because the Firm may be deemed to have material, nonpublic information regarding the issuers of those securities or as a result of other internal policies. The inability to sell public securities in these circumstances could materially adversely affect our investment results. In addition, an investment may be sold by us to a public company where the consideration received is a combination of cash and stock of the public company, which may, depending on the securities laws of the relevant jurisdiction, be subject to lock-up periods.

A lack of liquidity in certain of our investments may adversely affect our business.

We intend to invest in certain companies whose securities are not publicly-traded or actively traded on the secondary market, and whose securities are subject to legal and other restrictions on resale or will otherwise be less liquid than publicly-traded securities. The illiquidity of certain of our investments may make it difficult for us to sell these investments when desired. In addition, if we are required to liquidate all or a portion of our portfolio quickly, we may realize significantly less than the value at which we had previously recorded these investments. The reduced liquidity of our investments may make it difficult for us to dispose of them at a favorable price, and, as a result, we may suffer losses. Moreover, investments purchased by us that are liquid at the time of purchase may subsequently become illiquid due to events relating to the issuer, market events, economic conditions or investor perceptions.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

Our investments may include original issue discount and payment-in-kind instruments.

To the extent that we invest in original issue discount or payment-in-kind (“PIK”) instruments and the accretion of original issue discount or PIK interest income constitutes a portion of our income, we will be exposed to risks associated with the requirement to include such non-cash income in taxable and accounting income prior to receipt of cash, including the following:

the higher interest rates on PIK instruments reflect the payment deferral and increased credit risk associated with these instruments, and PIK instruments generally represent a significantly higher credit risk than coupon loans;
original issue discount and PIK instruments may have unreliable valuations because the accruals require judgments about collectability of the deferred payments and the value of any associated collateral;
an election to defer PIK interest payments by adding them to the principal on such instruments increases our future investment income which increases our net assets and, as such, increases the Adviser’s future base management fees which, thus, increases the Adviser’s future income incentive fees at a compounding rate;
market prices of PIK instruments and other zero coupon instruments are affected to a greater extent by interest rate changes, and may be more volatile than instruments that pay interest periodically in cash. While PIK instruments are usually less volatile than zero coupon debt instruments, PIK instruments are generally more volatile than cash pay securities;
the deferral of PIK interest on an instrument increases the loan-to-value ratio, which is a measure of the riskiness of a loan, with respect to such instrument;
even if the conditions for income accrual under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”) are satisfied, a borrower could still default when actual payment is due upon the maturity of such loan;
the required recognition of original issue discount or PIK interest for U.S. federal income tax purposes may have a negative impact on liquidity, as it represents a non-cash component of our investment company taxable income that may require cash distributions to shareholders in order to maintain our ability to be subject to tax as a RIC; and
original issue discount may create a risk of non-refundable cash payments to the Adviser based on noncash accruals that may never be realized.

The prices of the debt instruments and other securities in which we invest may decline substantially.

For reasons not necessarily attributable to any of the risks set forth herein (for example, supply/demand imbalances or other market forces), the prices of the debt instruments and other securities may decline substantially. In particular, purchasing debt instruments or other assets at what may appear to be “undervalued” or “discounted” levels is no guarantee that these assets will not be trading at even lower levels at a time of valuation or at the time of sale, if applicable. It may not be possible to predict, or to hedge against, such “spread widening” risk. Additionally, the perceived discount in pricing from previous environments described herein may still not reflect the true value of the assets underlying debt instruments in which the Company invests.

We may enter into a TRS agreement that exposes us to certain risks, including market risk, liquidity risk and other risks similar to those associated with the use of leverage.

A total return swap (“TRS”) is a contract in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in the market value of the assets underlying the TRS, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during a specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate. A TRS effectively adds leverage to a portfolio by providing investment exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Because of the unique structure of a TRS, a TRS often offers lower financing costs than are offered through more traditional borrowing arrangements.

A TRS is subject to market risk, liquidity risk and risk of imperfect correlation between the value of the TRS and the loans underlying the TRS. In addition, we may incur certain costs in connection with the TRS that could in the aggregate be significant. A TRS is also subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations thereunder or that we will not be able to meet our obligations to the counterparty.

We may enter into repurchase agreements.

Subject to our investment objective and policies, we may invest in repurchase agreements as a buyer for investment purposes. Repurchase agreements typically involve the acquisition by the Company of debt securities from a selling financial institution such as a bank, savings and loan association or broker-dealer. The agreement provides that the Company will sell the securities back to the institution at a fixed time in the future for the purchase price plus premium (which often reflects the interests). The Company does not bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security unless the seller defaults under its repurchase obligation. In the event of the bankruptcy or other default of a seller of a repurchase agreement, the Company could experience both delays in liquidating the underlying securities and losses, including (1) possible decline in the value of the underlying security during the period in which the Company seeks to enforce its rights thereto; (2) possible lack of access to income on the underlying security during this period; and (3) expenses of enforcing its rights. In addition, as described above, the value of the collateral underlying the repurchase agreement will be at least equal to the repurchase price, including any accrued interest earned on the repurchase agreement. In the event of a default or bankruptcy by a selling financial institution, the Company generally will seek to liquidate such collateral. However, the exercise of the Company’s right to liquidate such collateral could involve certain costs or delays and, to the extent that proceeds from any sale upon a default of the obligation to repurchase were less than the repurchase price, the Company could suffer a loss.

41


Table of Contents

 

We may enter into securities lending agreements.

We may from time to time make secured loans of our marginable securities to brokers, dealers and other financial institutions if our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, would at least equal 150% immediately after each such loan. The risks in lending portfolio securities, as with other extensions of credit, consist of possible delay in recovery of the securities or possible loss of rights in the collateral should the borrower fail financially. However, such loans will be made only to brokers and other financial institutions that are believed by the Adviser to be of high credit standing. Securities loans are made to broker-dealers pursuant to agreements requiring that loans be continuously secured by collateral consisting of U.S. government securities, cash or cash equivalents (e.g., negotiable certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances or letters of credit) maintained on a daily mark-to-market basis in an amount at least equal at all times to the market value of the securities lent. If the Company enters into a securities lending arrangement, the Adviser, as part of its responsibilities under the Advisory Agreement, will invest the Company’s cash collateral in accordance with the Company’s investment objectives and strategies. The Company will pay the borrower of the securities a fee based on the amount of the cash collateral posted in connection with the securities lending program. The borrower will pay to the Company, as the lender, an amount equal to any dividends or interest received on the securities lent.

The Company may invest the cash collateral received only in accordance with its investment objectives, subject to the Company’s agreement with the borrower of the securities. In the case of cash collateral, the Company expects to pay a rebate to the borrower. The reinvestment of cash collateral will result in a form of effective leverage for the Company.

Although voting rights or rights to consent with respect to the loaned securities pass to the borrower, the Company, as the lender, will retain the right to call the loans and obtain the return of the securities loaned at any time on reasonable notice, and it will do so in order that the securities may be voted by the Company if the holders of such securities are asked to vote upon or consent to matters materially affecting the investment. The Company may also call such loans in order to sell the securities involved. When engaged in securities lending, the Company’s performance will continue to reflect changes in the value of the securities loaned and will also reflect the receipt of interest through investment of cash collateral by the Company in permissible investments.

We may from time to time enter into credit default swaps or other derivative transactions which expose us to certain risks, including credit risk, market risk, liquidity risk and other risks similar to those associated with the use of leverage.

We may from time to time enter into credit default swaps or other derivative transactions that seek to modify or replace the investment performance of a particular reference security or other asset. These transactions are typically individually negotiated, non-standardized agreements between two parties to exchange payments, with payments generally calculated by reference to a notional amount or quantity. Swap contracts and similar derivative contracts are not traded on exchanges; rather, banks and dealers act as principals in these markets. These investments may present risks in excess of those resulting from the referenced security or other asset. Because these transactions are not an acquisition of the referenced security or other asset itself, the investor has no right directly to enforce compliance with the terms of the referenced security or other asset and has no voting or other consensual rights of ownership with respect to the referenced security or other asset. In the event of insolvency of a counterparty, we will be treated as a general creditor of the counterparty and will have no claim of title with respect to the referenced security or other asset.

A credit default swap is a contract in which one party buys or sells protection against a credit event with respect to an issuer, such as an issuer’s failure to make timely payments of interest or principal on its debt obligations, bankruptcy or restructuring during a specified period. Generally, if we sell credit protection using a credit default swap, we will receive fixed payments from the swap counterparty and if a credit event occurs with respect to the applicable issuer, we will pay the swap counterparty par for the issuer’s defaulted debt securities and the swap counterparty will deliver the defaulted debt securities to us. Generally, if we buy credit protection using a credit default swap, we will make fixed payments to the counterparty and if a credit event occurs with respect to the applicable issuer, we will deliver the issuer’s defaulted securities underlying the swap to the swap counterparty and the counterparty will pay us par for the defaulted securities. Alternatively, a credit default swap may be cash settled and the buyer of protection would receive the difference between the par value and the market value of the issuer’s defaulted debt securities from the seller of protection.

Credit default swaps are subject to the credit risk of the underlying issuer. If we are selling credit protection, there is a risk that we will not properly assess the risk of the underlying issuer, a credit event will occur and we will have to pay the counterparty. If we are buying credit protection, there is a risk that we will not properly assess the risk of the underlying issuer, no credit event will occur and we will receive no benefit for the premium paid.

A derivative transaction is also subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations thereunder or that we will not be able to meet our obligations to the counterparty. In some cases, we may post collateral to secure our obligations to the counterparty, and we may be required to post additional collateral upon the occurrence of certain events such as a decrease in the value of the reference security or other asset. In some cases, the counterparty may not collateralize any of its obligations to us. Derivative investments effectively add leverage to a portfolio by providing investment exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. In addition to the risks described above, such arrangements are subject to risks similar to those associated with the use of leverage. See “Risk Factors— Risks Related to Debt Financing.”

We may acquire various financial instruments for purposes of “hedging” or reducing our risks, which may be costly and ineffective and could reduce our cash available for distribution to our shareholders.

We may seek to hedge against interest rate and currency exchange rate fluctuations and credit risk by using financial instruments such as futures, options, swaps and forward contracts, subject to the requirements of the 1940 Act. These financial instruments may be purchased on exchanges or may be individually negotiated and traded in over-the-counter markets. Use of such financial instruments for hedging purposes may present significant risks, including the risk of loss of the amounts invested. Defaults by the other party to a hedging transaction can result in losses in the hedging transaction. Hedging activities also involve the risk of an imperfect correlation between the hedging instrument and the asset being hedged, which could result in losses both on the hedging transaction and on the instrument being hedged. Use of hedging activities may not prevent significant losses and could increase our losses. Further, hedging transactions may reduce cash available to pay distributions to our shareholders.

42


Table of Contents

 

Prepayments of our debt investments by our portfolio companies could adversely impact our results of operations and reduce our return on equity.

We are subject to the risk that the investments we make in our portfolio companies may be repaid prior to maturity. When this occurs, we will generally reinvest these proceeds in temporary investments, pending their future investment in new portfolio companies. These temporary investments will typically have substantially lower yields than the debt being prepaid and we could experience significant delays in reinvesting these amounts. Any future investment in a new portfolio company may also be at lower yields than the debt that was repaid. As a result, our results of operations could be materially adversely affected if one or more of our portfolio companies elect to prepay amounts owed to us. Additionally, prepayments, net of prepayment fees, could negatively impact our return on equity. This risk will be more acute when interest rates decrease, as we may be unable to reinvest at rates as favorable as when we made our initial investment.

Technological innovations and industry disruptions may negatively impact us.

Current trends in the market generally have been toward disrupting a traditional approach to an industry with technological innovation, and multiple young companies have been successful where this trend toward disruption in markets and market practices has been critical to their success. In this period of rapid technological and commercial innovation, new businesses and approaches may be created that will compete with the Company and/ or its investments or alter the market practices the Company’s strategy has been designed to function within and depend on for investment returns. Any of these new approaches could damage the Company’s investments, significantly disrupt the market in which it operates and subject it to increased competition, which could materially and adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of investments.

Syndication of Co-Investments.

From time to time, the Company may make an investment with the expectation of offering a portion of its interests therein as a co-investment opportunity to third-party investors. There can be no assurance that the Company will be successful in syndicating any such co-investment, in whole or in part, that the closing of such co-investment will be consummated in a timely manner, that any syndication will take place on terms and conditions that will be preferable for the Company or that expenses incurred by the Company with respect to any such syndication will not be substantial. In the event that the Company is not successful in syndicating any such co-investment, in whole or in part, the Company may consequently hold a greater concentration and have more exposure in the related investment than initially was intended, which could make the Company more susceptible to fluctuations in value resulting from adverse economic and/or business conditions with respect thereto. Moreover, an investment by the Company that is not syndicated to coinvestors as originally anticipated could significantly reduce the Company’s overall investment returns.

To the extent we invest in middle market companies, investments in middle market companies involves a number of significant risks, any one of which could have a material adverse effect on our operating results.

Investments in middle market companies involve the same risks that apply generally to investments in larger, more established companies. However, such investments have more pronounced risks in that middle market companies:

may have limited financial resources and may be unable to meet their obligations under their debt securities that we hold, which may be accompanied by a deterioration in the value of any collateral and a reduction in the likelihood of us realizing on any guarantees we may have obtained in connection with our investment;
have shorter operating histories, narrower product lines and smaller market shares than larger businesses, which tends to render them more vulnerable to competitors’ actions and changing market conditions, as well as general economic downturns;
are more likely to depend on the management talents and efforts of a small group of persons; therefore, the death, disability, resignation or termination of one or more of these persons could have a material adverse impact on our portfolio company and, in turn, on us;
generally have less predictable operating results, may from time to time be parties to litigation, may be engaged in rapidly changing businesses with products subject to a substantial risk of obsolescence and may require substantial additional capital to support their operations, finance expansion or maintain their competitive position. In addition, our executive officers, Trustees and members of the Adviser may, in the ordinary course of business, be named as defendants in litigation arising from our investments in the portfolio companies; and
may have difficulty accessing the capital markets to meet future capital needs, which may limit their ability to grow or to repay their outstanding indebtedness upon maturity.

Risks Related to the Adviser and Its Affiliates; Conflicts of Interest

The Adviser and its affiliates, including our officers and some of our Trustees, face conflicts of interest caused by compensation arrangements with us and our affiliates, which could result in actions that are not in the best interests of our shareholders.

The Adviser and its affiliates receive substantial fees from us in return for their services, and these fees could influence the advice provided to us. We pay to the Adviser an incentive fee that is based on the performance of our portfolio and an annual base management fee that is based on the value of our net assets as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the applicable month. Because the incentive fee is based on the performance of our portfolio, the Adviser may be incentivized to make investments on our behalf that are riskier or more speculative than would be the case in the absence of such compensation arrangement. The way in which the incentive fee is determined may also encourage the Adviser to use leverage to increase the return on our investments. Our compensation arrangements could therefore result in our making riskier or more speculative investments than would otherwise be the case. This could result in higher investment losses, particularly during cyclical economic downturns. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

43


Table of Contents

 

We may be obligated to pay the Adviser incentive compensation even if we incur a net loss due to a decline in the value of our portfolio.

Our Advisory Agreement entitles the Adviser to receive Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns regardless of any capital losses. In such case, we may be required to pay the Adviser incentive compensation for a fiscal quarter even if there is a decline in the value of our portfolio or if we incur a net loss for that quarter.

In addition, any Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns may be computed and paid on income that may include interest that has been accrued but not yet received. If a portfolio company defaults on a loan that is structured to provide accrued interest, it is possible that accrued interest previously included in the calculation of the incentive fee will become uncollectible. The Adviser is not under any obligation to reimburse us for any part of the incentive fee it received that was based on accrued income that we never received as a result of a default by an entity on the obligation that resulted in the accrual of such income, and such circumstances would result in our paying an incentive fee on income we never received.

There may be conflicts of interest related to obligations that the Adviser’s senior management and Investment Team have to Other Clients.

The members of the senior management and Investment Team of the Adviser serve or may serve as officers, directors or principals of entities that operate in the same or a related line of business as we do, or of investment funds managed by the same personnel. In serving in these multiple capacities, they may have obligations to Other Clients or investors in those entities, the fulfillment of which may not be in our best interests or in the best interest of our shareholders. Our investment objective may overlap with the investment objectives of such investment funds, accounts or other investment vehicles. In particular, we will rely on the Adviser to manage our day-to-day activities and to implement our investment strategy. The Adviser and certain of its affiliates are presently, and plan in the future to continue to be, involved with activities that are unrelated to us. As a result of these activities, the Adviser, its officers and employees and certain of its affiliates will have conflicts of interest in allocating their time between us and other activities in which they are or may become involved, including the management of its affiliated equipment funds. The Adviser and its officers and employees will devote only as much of its or their time to our business as the Adviser and its officers and employees, in their judgment, determine is reasonably required, which may be substantially less than their full time.

We rely, in part, on the Adviser to assist with identifying investment opportunities and making investment recommendations to the Adviser. The Adviser and its affiliates are not restricted from forming additional investment funds, entering into other investment advisory relationships or engaging in other business activities. These activities could be viewed as creating a conflict of interest in that the time and effort of the members of the Adviser, its affiliates and their officers and employees will not be devoted exclusively to our business, but will be allocated between us and such other business activities of the Adviser and its affiliates in a manner that the Adviser deems necessary and appropriate. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

The time and resources that individuals employed by the Adviser devote to us may be diverted and we may face additional competition due to the fact that individuals employed by the Adviser are not prohibited from raising money for or managing other entities that make the same types of investments that we target.

The Adviser and individuals employed by the Adviser are generally not prohibited from raising capital for and managing other investment entities that make the same types of investments as those we target. As a result, the time and resources that these individuals may devote to us may be diverted. In addition, we may compete with any such investment entity for the same investors and investment opportunities. We may participate in certain transactions originated by the Adviser or its affiliates under our exemptive relief from the SEC that allows us to engage in coinvestment transactions with the Adviser and its affiliates, subject to certain terms and conditions. However, while the terms of the exemptive relief require that the Adviser will be given the opportunity to cause us to participate in certain transactions originated by affiliates of the Adviser, the Adviser may determine that we not participate in those transactions and for certain other transactions (as set forth in guidelines approved by the Board of Trustees) the Adviser may not have the opportunity to cause us to participate. Affiliates of the Adviser, whose primary business includes the origination of investments or investing in non-originated assets, engage in investment advisory business with accounts that compete with us. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

Our shares may be purchased by the Adviser or its affiliates.

Affiliates of the Adviser have purchased and the Adviser and its affiliates in the future expect to purchase our shares. The Adviser and its affiliates will not acquire any shares with the intention to resell or re-distribute such shares. The purchase of shares by the Adviser and its affiliates could create certain risks, including, but not limited to, the following:

the Adviser and its affiliates may have an interest in disposing of our assets at an earlier date so as to recover their investment in our shares; and
substantial purchases of shares by the Adviser and its affiliates may limit the Adviser’s ability to fulfill any financial obligations that it may have to us or incurred on our behalf.

The Adviser relies on key personnel, the loss of any of whom could impair its ability to successfully manage us.

Our future success depends, to a significant extent, on the continued services of the officers and employees of the Adviser or its affiliates. The loss of services of one or more members of the Adviser’s management team, including members of Apollo’s investment committee (the “Investment Committee”), could adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. The Adviser does not have an employment agreement with any of these key personnel and we cannot guarantee that all, or any particular one, will remain affiliated with us and/or the Adviser. Further, we do not intend to separately maintain key person life insurance on any of these individuals.

44


Table of Contents

 

The compensation we pay to the Adviser will be determined without independent assessment on our behalf, and these terms may be less advantageous to us than if such terms had been the subject of arm’s-length negotiations.

The Advisory Agreement will not be entered into on an arm’s-length basis with an unaffiliated third party. As a result, the form and amount of compensation we pay the Adviser may be less favorable to us than they might have been had an investment advisory agreement been entered into through arm’s-length transactions with an unaffiliated third party.

The Intermediary Manager’s influence on this offer gives it the ability to increase the fees payable to the Adviser.

The Adviser is paid a base management fee calculated as a percentage of our net assets and unrelated to net income or any other performance base or measure. The Intermediary Manager, an affiliate of the Adviser will be incentivized to raise more proceeds in our offering to increase our net assets, even if it would be difficult for us to efficiently deploy additional capital, which in turn would increase the base management fee payable to the Adviser.

Because the Intermediary Manager is an affiliate of Apollo, you will not have the benefit of an independent review of this prospectus customarily performed in underwritten offerings.

The Intermediary Manager is an affiliate of Apollo and will not make an independent review of us or the offering. Accordingly, you will have to rely on your own broker to make an independent review of the terms of our offering. If your broker does not conduct such a review, you will not have the benefit of an independent review of the terms of our offering. Further, the due diligence investigation of us by the Intermediary Manager cannot be considered to be an independent review and, therefore, may not be as meaningful as a review conducted by an unaffiliated broker-dealer or investment banker. You will not have the benefit of an independent review and investigation of our offering of the type normally performed by an unaffiliated, independent underwriter in an underwritten public securities offering. In addition, we do not, and do not expect to, have research analysts reviewing our performance or our securities on an ongoing basis. Therefore, you will not have an independent review of our performance and the value of our common shares relative to publicly traded companies.

Risks Related to Business Development Companies

The requirement that we invest a sufficient portion of our assets in Qualifying Assets could preclude us from investing in accordance with our current business strategy; conversely, the failure to invest a sufficient portion of our assets in Qualifying Assets could result in our failure to maintain our status as a BDC.

Under the 1940 Act, a BDC may not acquire any asset other than assets of the type listed in section 55(a) of the 1940 Act described as “qualifying” assets, (“Qualifying Assets”) unless, at the time of and after giving effect to such acquisition, at least 70% of our total assets are Qualifying Assets. Therefore, we may be precluded from investing in what we believe are attractive investments if such investments are not Qualifying Assets. Conversely, if we fail to invest a sufficient portion of our assets in Qualifying Assets, we could lose our status as a BDC, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Similarly, these rules could prevent us from making additional investments in existing portfolio companies, which could result in the dilution of our position, or could require us to dispose of investments at an inopportune time to comply with the 1940 Act. If we were forced to sell non-qualifying investments in the portfolio for compliance purposes, the proceeds from such sale could be significantly less than the current value of such investments.

Failure to maintain our status as a BDC would reduce our operating flexibility.

If we do not remain a BDC, we might be regulated as a registered closed-end investment company under the 1940 Act, which would subject us to substantially more regulatory restrictions under the 1940 Act and correspondingly decrease our operating flexibility.

Regulations governing our operation as a BDC and RIC will affect our ability to raise, and the way in which we raise, additional capital or borrow for investment purposes, which may have a negative effect on our growth.

As a result of the annual distribution requirement to qualify as a RIC, we may need to periodically access the capital markets to raise cash to fund new investments. We may issue “senior securities,” as defined under the 1940 Act, including borrowing money from banks or other financial institutions only in amounts such that our asset coverage meets the threshold set forth in the 1940 Act immediately after each such issuance. The 1940 Act currently requires an asset coverage of at least 150% (i.e., the amount of debt may not exceed two-thirds of the value of our assets). Our ability to issue different types of securities is also limited. Compliance with these requirements may unfavorably limit our investment opportunities and reduce our ability in comparison to other companies to profit from favorable spreads between the rates at which we can borrow and the rates at which we can lend. As a BDC, therefore, we intend to continuously issue equity at a rate more frequent than our privately-owned competitors, which may lead to greater shareholder dilution.

We expect to borrow for investment purposes. If the value of our assets declines, we may be unable to satisfy the asset coverage test, which would prohibit us from paying distributions and could prevent us from qualifying as a RIC. If we cannot satisfy the asset coverage test, we may be required to sell a portion of our investments and, depending on the nature of our debt financing, repay a portion of our indebtedness at a time when such sales may be disadvantageous.

 

45


Table of Contents

 

Under the 1940 Act, we generally are prohibited from issuing or selling our shares at a price per share, after deducting selling commissions, that is below our NAV per share, which may be a disadvantage as compared with other public companies. We may, however, sell our shares, or warrants, options or rights to acquire our shares, at a price below the current NAV of our shares if our Board of Trustees, including our independent Trustees, determine that such sale is in our best interests and the best interests of our shareholders, and our shareholders, as well as those shareholders that are not affiliated with us, approve such sale. In any such case, the price at which our securities are to be issued and sold may not be less than a price that, in the determination of our Board of Trustees, closely approximates the fair value of such securities.

Our ability to enter into transactions with our affiliates is restricted.

We are prohibited under the 1940 Act from participating in certain transactions with certain of our affiliates (including portfolio companies of Other Clients) without the prior approval of a majority of the independent members of our Board of Trustees and, in some cases, the SEC. Any person that owns, directly or indirectly, 5% or more of our outstanding voting securities will be our affiliate for purposes of the 1940 Act and generally we will be prohibited from buying or selling any securities from or to such affiliate, absent the prior approval of our Board of Trustees. However, we may under certain circumstances purchase any such affiliate’s loans or securities in the secondary market, which could create a conflict for the Adviser between our interests and the interests of such affiliate, in that the ability of the Adviser to recommend actions in our best interest may be limited. The 1940 Act also prohibits certain “joint” transactions with certain of our affiliates, which could include investments in the same portfolio company (whether at the same or closely related times), without prior approval of our Board of Trustees and, in some cases, the SEC. If a person acquires more than 25% of our voting securities, we will be prohibited from buying or selling any security from or to such person or certain of that person’s affiliates, or entering into prohibited joint transactions (including certain co-investments) with such persons, absent the prior approval of the SEC. Similar restrictions limit our ability to transact business with our officers, Trustees, investment advisers, sub-advisers or their affiliates. As a result of these restrictions, we may be prohibited from buying or selling any security from or to any fund or any portfolio company of a fund managed by the Adviser, or entering into joint arrangements such as certain co-investments with these companies or funds without the prior approval of the SEC, which may limit the scope of investment opportunities that would otherwise be available to us.

We have obtained exemptive relief from the SEC that allows us to engage in co-investment transactions with the Adviser and its affiliates, subject to certain terms and conditions. However, while the terms of the exemptive relief require that the Adviser will be given the opportunity to cause us to participate in certain transactions originated by affiliates of the Adviser, the Adviser may determine that we not participate in those transactions and for certain other transactions (as set forth in guidelines approved by the Board of Trustees) the Adviser may not have the opportunity to cause us to participate.

We are uncertain of our sources for funding our future capital needs; if we cannot obtain debt or equity financing on acceptable terms, our ability to acquire investments and to expand our operations will be adversely affected.

The net proceeds from the sale of shares will be used for our investment opportunities, operating expenses and for payment of various fees and expenses such as base management fees, incentive fees and other expenses. Any working capital reserves we maintain may not be sufficient for investment purposes, and we may require debt or equity financing to operate. Accordingly, in the event that we develop a need for additional capital in the future for investments or for any other reason, these sources of funding may not be available to us. Consequently, if we cannot obtain debt or equity financing on acceptable terms, our ability to acquire investments and to expand our operations will be adversely affected. As a result, we would be less able to create and maintain a broad portfolio of investments and achieve our investment objective, which may negatively impact our results of operations and reduce our ability to make distributions to our shareholders.

We are a non-diversified investment company within the meaning of the 1940 Act, and therefore we are not limited with respect to the proportion of our assets that may be invested in securities of a single issuer.

We are classified as a non-diversified investment company within the meaning of the 1940 Act, which means that we are not limited by the 1940 Act with respect to the proportion of our assets that we may invest in securities of a single issuer. Under the 1940 Act, a “diversified” investment company is required to invest at least 75% of the value of its total assets in cash and cash items, government securities, securities of other investment companies and other securities limited in respect of any one issuer to an amount not greater than 5% of the value of the total assets of such company and no more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer. As a non-diversified investment company, we are not subject to this requirement. To the extent that we assume large positions in the securities of a small number of issuers, or within a particular industry, our NAV may fluctuate to a greater extent than that of a diversified investment company as a result of changes in the financial condition or the market’s assessment of the issuer. We may also be more susceptible to any single economic or regulatory occurrence than a diversified investment company or to a general downturn in the economy. However, we will be subject to the diversification requirements applicable to RICs under Subchapter M of the Code.

Risks Related to Debt Financing

When we borrow money, the potential for loss on amounts invested in us will be magnified and may increase the risk of investing in us. Borrowed money may also adversely affect the return on our assets, reduce cash available for distribution to our shareholders and result in losses.

The use of borrowings, also known as leverage, increases the volatility of investments by magnifying the potential for loss on invested equity capital. The use of leverage involves increased risk, including increased variability of the Company’s net income, distributions and NAV in relation to market changes. If the value of our assets decreases, leveraging would cause NAV to decline more sharply than it otherwise would have had we not leveraged. Similarly, any decrease in our income would cause net income to decline more sharply than it would have had we not borrowed. Such a decline could negatively affect our ability to make distributions to our shareholders. In addition, our shareholders will bear the burden of any increase in our expenses as a result of our use of leverage, including interest expenses and any increase in the management or incentive fees payable to the Adviser.

46


Table of Contents

 

We use and expect to continue to use leverage to finance our investments. The amount of leverage that we employ will depend on the Adviser’s and our Board of Trustees’ assessment of market and other factors at the time of any proposed borrowing. There can be no assurance that leveraged financing will be available to us on favorable terms or at all. However, to the extent that we use leverage to finance our assets, our financing costs will reduce cash available for distributions to shareholders. Moreover, we may not be able to meet our financing obligations and, to the extent that we cannot, we risk the loss of some or all of our assets to liquidation or sale to satisfy the obligations. In such an event, we may be forced to sell assets at significantly depressed prices due to market conditions or otherwise, which may result in losses.

As a BDC, we generally are required to meet a coverage ratio of total assets to total borrowings and other senior securities, which include all of our borrowings and any preferred shares that we may issue in the future, of at least 150%. If this ratio were to fall below 150%, we could not incur additional debt and could be required to sell a portion of our investments to repay some debt when it is disadvantageous to do so. This could have a material adverse effect on our operations and investment activities. Moreover, our ability to make distributions to you may be significantly restricted or we may not be able to make any such distributions whatsoever. The amount of leverage that we will employ will be subject to oversight by our Board of Trustees, a majority of whom are independent Trustees with no material interests in such transactions.

Although borrowings by the Company have the potential to enhance overall returns that exceed the Company’s cost of funds, they will further diminish returns (or increase losses on capital) to the extent overall returns are less than the Company’s cost of funds. In addition, borrowings by the Company may be secured by the shareholders’ investments as well as by the Company’s assets and the documentation relating to such borrowing may provide that during the continuance of a default under such borrowing, the interests of the investors may be subordinated to such borrowing.

Our credit facilities and unsecured notes impose financial and operating covenants that restrict our business activities, including limitations that could hinder our ability to finance additional loans and investments or to make the distributions required to maintain our status as a regulated investment company. A failure to renew our facilities or to add new or replacement debt facilities or issue additional debt securities or other evidences of indebtedness could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

The following table illustrates the effect of leverage on returns from an investment in our shares assuming various annual returns on our portfolio, net of expenses. The calculations in the table below are hypothetical, and actual returns may be higher or lower than those appearing in the table below.

 Assumed Return on Portfolio (Net of Expenses) (1)

 

-10

%

 

-5

%

 

0

%

 

5

%

 

10

%

 Corresponding Return to Common Stockholders (2)

 

-27

%

 

-17

%

 

-6

%

 

4

%

 

15

%

(1)
The assumed portfolio return is required by SEC regulations and is not a prediction of, and does not represent, our projected or actual performance. Actual returns may be greater or less than those appearing in the table. Pursuant to SEC regulations, this table is calculated as of December 31, 2022. As a result, it has not been updated to take into account any changes in assets or leverage since December 31, 2022.
(2)
In order to compute the “Corresponding Return to Common Shareholders,” the “Assumed Return on Portfolio” is multiplied by the total value of our assets at December 31, 2022 to obtain an assumed return to us. From this amount, the interest expense (calculated by multiplying the weighted average stated interest rate of 6.05% by the approximately $2,193.6 of principal debt outstanding) is subtracted to determine the return available to shareholders. The return available to shareholders is then divided by the total value of our net assets as of December 31, 2022 to determine the “Corresponding Return to Common Shareholders.”

We may default under our credit facilities.

In the event we default under a credit facility or other borrowings, our business could be adversely affected as we may be forced to sell a portion of our investments quickly and prematurely at what may be disadvantageous prices to us in order to meet our outstanding payment obligations and/or support working capital requirements under such borrowing facility, any of which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In addition, following any such default, the agent for the lenders under such borrowing facility could assume control of the disposition of any or all of our assets which constitute collateral, including the selection of such assets to be disposed and the timing of such disposition, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Provisions in a credit facility may limit our investment discretion.

A credit facility may be backed by all or a portion of our loans and securities on which the lenders will have a security interest. We may pledge up to 100% of our assets and may grant a security interest in all of our assets under the terms of any debt instrument we enter into with lenders. We expect that any security interests we grant will be set forth in a pledge and security agreement and evidenced by the filing of financing statements by the agent for the lenders. In addition, we expect that the custodian for our securities serving as collateral for such loan would include in its electronic systems notices indicating the existence of such security interests and, following notice of occurrence of an event of default, if any, and during its continuance, will only accept transfer instructions with respect to any such securities from the lender or its designee. If we were to default under the terms of any debt instrument, the agent for the applicable lenders would be able to assume control of the timing of disposition of any or all of our assets securing such debt, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

In addition, any security interests and/or negative covenants required by a credit facility may limit our ability to create liens on assets to secure additional debt and may make it difficult for us to restructure or refinance indebtedness at or prior to maturity or obtain additional debt or equity financing. In addition, if our borrowing base under a credit facility were to decrease, we may be required to secure additional assets in an amount sufficient to cure any borrowing base deficiency. In the event that all of our assets are secured at the time of such a borrowing base deficiency, we could be required to repay advances under a credit facility or make deposits to a collection account, either of which could have a material adverse impact on our ability to fund future investments and to make distributions.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

In addition, we may be subject to limitations as to how borrowed funds may be used, which may include restrictions on geographic and industry concentrations, loan size, payment frequency and status, average life, collateral interests an investment ratings, as well as regulatory restrictions on leverage which may affect the amount of funding that may be obtained. There may also be certain requirements relating to portfolio performance, including required minimum portfolio yield and limitations on delinquencies and charge-offs, a violation of which could limit further advances and, in some cases, result in an event of default. An event of default under a credit facility could result in an accelerated maturity date for all amounts outstanding thereunder, which could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial condition. This could reduce our liquidity and cash flow and impair our ability to grow our business.

Changes in interest rates may affect our cost of capital and net investment income.

Since we intend to use debt to finance a portion of our investments, our net investment income will depend, in part, upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds and the rate at which we invest those funds. As a result, we can offer no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates will not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income. In periods of rising interest rates when we have debt outstanding, our cost of funds will increase, which could reduce our net investment income. We expect that our long-term fixed-rate investments will be financed primarily with equity and long-term debt. We may use interest rate risk management techniques in an effort to limit our exposure to interest rate fluctuations. These techniques may include various interest rate hedging activities to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act. These activities may limit our ability to participate in the benefits of lower interest rates with respect to the hedged portfolio. Adverse developments resulting from changes in interest rates or hedging transactions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Also, we have limited experience in entering into hedging transactions, and we will initially have to purchase or develop such expertise.

A rise in the general level of interest rates can be expected to lead to higher interest rates applicable to our debt investments. Accordingly, an increase in interest rates would make it easier for us to meet or exceed the incentive fee hurdle rate and may result in a substantial increase in the amount of incentive fees payable to the Adviser with respect to pre-incentive fee net investment income.

We may form one or more CLOs, which may subject us to certain structured financing risks.

To finance investments, we may securitize certain of our secured loans or other investments, including through the formation of one or more CLOs, while retaining all or most of the exposure to the performance of these investments. This would involve contributing a pool of assets to a special purpose entity, and selling debt interests in such entity on a non-recourse or limited-recourse basis to purchasers. It is possible that an interest in any such CLO held by us may be considered a “non-qualifying” portfolio investment for purposes of the 1940 Act.

If we create a CLO, we will depend in part on distributions from the CLO’s assets out of its earnings and cash flows to enable us to make distributions to shareholders. The ability of a CLO to make distributions will be subject to various limitations, including the terms and covenants of the debt it issues. Also, a CLO may take actions that delay distributions in order to preserve ratings and to keep the cost of present and future financings lower or the CLO may be obligated to retain cash or other assets to satisfy over-collateralization requirements commonly provided for holders of the CLO’s debt, which could impact our ability to receive distributions from the CLO. If we do not receive cash flow from any such CLO that is necessary to satisfy the annual distribution requirement for maintaining RIC status, and we are unable to obtain cash from other sources necessary to satisfy this requirement, we may not maintain our qualification as a RIC, which would have a material adverse effect on an investment in the shares.

In addition, a decline in the credit quality of loans in a CLO due to poor operating results of the relevant borrower, declines in the value of loan collateral or increases in defaults, among other things, may force a CLO to sell certain assets at a loss, reducing their earnings and, in turn, cash potentially available for distribution to us for distribution to shareholders. To the extent that any losses are incurred by the CLO in respect of any collateral, such losses will be borne first by us as owner of equity interests in the CLO.

The manager for a CLO that we create may be the Company, the Adviser or an affiliate, and such manager may be entitled to receive compensation for structuring and/or management services. To the extent the Adviser or an affiliate other than the Company serves as manager and the Company is obligated to compensate the Adviser or the affiliate for such services, we, the Adviser or the affiliate will implement offsetting arrangements to assure that we, and indirectly, our shareholders, pay no additional management fees to the Adviser or the affiliate in connection therewith. To the extent we serve as manager, we will waive any right to receive fees for such services from the Company (and indirectly its shareholders) or any affiliate.

 

48


Table of Contents

 

Federal Income Tax Risks

We will be subject to corporate-level income tax if we are unable to qualify as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code or to satisfy RIC distribution requirements.

To obtain and maintain RIC tax treatment under Subchapter M of the Code, we must, among other things, meet annual distribution, income source and asset diversification requirements. If we do not qualify for or maintain RIC tax treatment for any reason and are subject to corporate income tax, the resulting corporate taxes could substantially reduce our net assets, the amount of income available for distribution and the amount of our distributions.

We may have difficulty paying our required distributions if we recognize income before or without receiving cash representing such income.

For federal income tax purposes, we may be required to recognize taxable income in circumstances in which we do not receive a corresponding payment in cash. For example, if we hold debt obligations that are treated under applicable tax rules as having original issue discount (such as zero coupon securities, debt instruments with PIK interest or, in certain cases, increasing interest rates or debt instruments that were issued with warrants), we must include in income each year a portion of the original issue discount that accrues over the life of the obligation, regardless of whether cash representing such income is received by us in the same taxable year. We may also have to include in income other amounts that we have not yet received in cash, such as deferred loan origination fees that are paid after origination of the loan or are paid in non-cash compensation such as warrants or stock. We anticipate that a portion of our income may constitute original issue discount or other income required to be included in taxable income prior to receipt of cash. Further, we may elect to amortize market discount and include such amounts in our taxable income in the current year, instead of upon disposition, as an election not to do so would limit our ability to deduct interest expenses for tax purposes.

Because any original issue discount or other amounts accrued will be included in our investment company taxable income for the year of the accrual, we may be required to make a distribution to our shareholders in order to satisfy the annual distribution requirement, even though we will not have received any corresponding cash amount. As a result, we may have difficulty meeting the annual distribution requirement necessary to qualify for and maintain RIC tax treatment under Subchapter M of the Code. We may have to sell some of our investments at times and/or at prices we would not consider advantageous, raise additional debt or equity capital or forgo new investment opportunities for this purpose. If we are not able to obtain cash from other sources, we may not qualify for or maintain RIC tax treatment and thus become subject to corporate-level income tax.

We may be impacted by loan origination regulation.

The Company intends to engage in originating, lending and/or servicing loans, and may therefore be subject to state and federal regulation, borrower disclosure requirements, limits on fees and interest rates on some loans, state lender licensing requirements and other regulatory requirements in the conduct of its business as they pertain to such transactions. The Company may also be subject to consumer disclosures and substantive requirements on consumer loan terms and other federal regulatory requirements applicable to consumer lending that are administered by the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau and other applicable regulatory authorities. These state and federal regulatory programs are designed to protect borrowers.

Some of our investments may be subject to corporate-level income tax.

We may invest in certain debt and equity investments through taxable subsidiaries and the taxable income of these taxable subsidiaries will be subject to federal and state corporate income taxes. We may invest in certain foreign debt and equity investments which could be subject to foreign taxes (such as income tax, withholding and value added taxes).

Our portfolio investments may present special tax issues.

The Company expects to invest in debt securities that are rated below investment grade by rating agencies or that would be rated below investment grade if they were rated. Investments in these types of instruments may present special tax issues for the Company. U.S. federal income tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as when the Company may cease to accrue interest, original issue discount or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or worthless instruments, how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income and whether exchanges of debt obligations in a bankruptcy or workout context are taxable. These and other issues will be addressed by the Company, to the extent necessary, to preserve its status as a RIC and to distribute sufficient income to not become subject to U.S. federal income tax.

Legislative or regulatory tax changes could adversely affect investors.

At any time, the federal income tax laws governing RICs or the administrative interpretations of those laws or regulations may be amended. Any of those new laws, regulations or interpretations may take effect retroactively and could adversely affect the taxation of us or our shareholders. Therefore, changes in tax laws, regulations or administrative interpretations or any amendments thereto could diminish the value of an investment in our shares or the value or the resale potential of our investments.

 

49


Table of Contents

 

Risks Related to an Investment in the Shares

We may have difficulty sourcing investment opportunities.

We cannot assure investors that we will be able to locate a sufficient number of suitable investment opportunities to allow us to deploy all investments successfully. In addition, privately-negotiated investments in loans and illiquid securities of large private U.S. borrowers require substantial due diligence and structuring, and we cannot assure investors that we will achieve our anticipated investment pace. As a result, investors will be unable to evaluate any future portfolio company investments prior to purchasing our shares. Additionally, our Adviser will select our investments subsequent to our offering, and our shareholders will have no input with respect to such investment decisions. These factors increase the uncertainty, and thus the risk, of investing in our shares. To the extent we are unable to deploy all investments, our investment income and, in turn, our results of operations, will likely be materially adversely affected.

We may have difficulty paying distributions and the tax character of any distributions is uncertain.

We generally intend to distribute substantially all of our available earnings annually by paying distributions on a monthly basis, as determined by the Board of Trustees in its discretion. We cannot assure investors that we will achieve investment results that will allow us to make a specified level of cash distributions or year-to-year increases in cash distributions. Our ability to pay distributions might be adversely affected by the impact of one or more of the risk factors described in this Annual Report. Due to the asset coverage test applicable to us under the 1940 Act as a BDC, we may be limited in our ability to make distributions. In addition, if we enter into a credit facility or any other borrowing facility, for so long as such facility is outstanding, we anticipate that we may be required by its terms to use all payments of interest and principal that we receive from our current investments as well as any proceeds received from the sale of our current investments to repay amounts outstanding thereunder, which could adversely affect our ability to make distributions.

Furthermore, the tax treatment and characterization of our distributions may vary significantly from time to time due to the nature of our investments. The ultimate tax characterization of our distributions made during a taxable year may not finally be determined until after the end of that taxable year. We may make distributions during a taxable year that exceed our investment company taxable income and net capital gains for that taxable year. In such a situation, the amount by which our total distributions exceed investment company taxable income and net capital gains generally would be treated as a return of capital up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in the shares, with any amounts exceeding such tax basis treated as a gain from the sale or exchange of such shares. A return of capital generally is a return of a shareholder’s investment rather than a return of earnings or gains derived from our investment activities. Moreover, we may pay all or a substantial portion of our distributions from borrowings or sources other than cash flow from operations in anticipation of future cash flow, which could constitute a return of shareholders’ capital and will lower such shareholders’ tax basis in our shares, which may result in increased tax liability to shareholders when they sell such shares.

An investment in our shares will have limited liquidity.

Our shares constitute illiquid investments for which there is not, and will likely not be, a secondary market at any time prior to a public offering and listing of our shares on a national securities exchange. There can be no guarantee that we will conduct a public offering and list our shares on a national securities exchange. Investment in the Company is suitable only for sophisticated investors and requires the financial ability and willingness to accept the high risks and lack of liquidity inherent in an investment in the Company. Except in limited circumstances for legal or regulatory purposes, shareholders are not entitled to redeem their shares. Shareholders must be prepared to bear the economic risk of an investment in our shares for an extended period of time.

Certain investors will be subject to 1934 Act filing requirements.

Because our Common Shares will be registered under the 1934 Act, ownership information for any person who beneficially owns 5% or more of our Common Shares will have to be disclosed in a Schedule 13G or other filings with the SEC. Beneficial ownership for these purposes is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC, and includes having voting or investment power over the securities. In some circumstances, our shareholders who choose to reinvest their dividends may see their percentage stake in the Company increased to more than 5%, thus triggering this filing requirement. Each shareholder is responsible for determining their filing obligations and preparing the filings. In addition, our shareholders who hold more than 10% of a class of our shares may be subject to Section 16(b) of the 1934 Act, which recaptures for the benefit of the Company profits from the purchase and sale of registered stock (and securities convertible or exchangeable into such registered stock) within a six-month period.

50


Table of Contents

 

Special considerations for certain benefit plan investors.

We intend to conduct our affairs so that our assets should not be deemed to constitute “plan assets” under ERISA and the Plan Asset Regulations. In this regard, until such time as all classes of our Common Shares are considered “publicly-offered securities” within the meaning of the Plan Asset Regulations, we intend to limit investment in each class of our Common Shares by “benefit plan investors” to less than 25% of the total value of each class of our Common Shares (within the meaning of the Plan Asset Regulations). If, notwithstanding our intent, the assets of the Company were deemed to be “plan assets” of any shareholder that is a “benefit plan investor” under the Plan Asset Regulations, this would result, among other things, in (i) the application of the prudence and other fiduciary responsibility standards of ERISA to investments made by the Company, and (ii) the possibility that certain transactions in which the Company might seek to engage could constitute “prohibited transactions” under ERISA and the Code. If a prohibited transaction occurs for which no exemption is available, the Adviser and/or any other fiduciary that has engaged in the prohibited transaction could be required to (i) restore to the “benefit plan investor” any profit realized on the transaction and (ii) reimburse the Covered Plan for any losses suffered by the “benefit plan investor” as a result of the investment. In addition, each disqualified person (within the meaning of Section 4975 of the Code) involved could be subject to an excise tax equal to 15% of the amount involved in the prohibited transaction for each year the transaction continues and, unless the transaction is corrected within statutorily required periods, to an additional tax of 100%. The Fiduciary of a “benefit plan investor” who decides to invest in the Company could, under certain circumstances, be liable for prohibited transactions or other violations as a result of their investment in the Company or as co-fiduciaries for actions taken by or on behalf of the Company or the Adviser. With respect to a “benefit plan investor” that is an individual retirement account (an “IRA”) that invests in the Company, the occurrence of a prohibited transaction involving the individual who established the IRA, or his or her beneficiaries, would cause the IRA to lose its tax-exempt status.

Until such time as all the classes of our Common Shares constitute “publicly traded securities” within the meaning of the Plan Asset Regulations, we have the power to (a) exclude any shareholder or potential shareholder from purchasing our Common Shares; (b) prohibit any redemption of our Common Shares; and (c) redeem some or all Common Shares held by any holder if, and to the extent that, our Board of Trustees determines that there is a substantial likelihood that such holder’s purchase, ownership or redemption of Common Shares would result in our assets to be characterized as “plan assets,” for purposes of the fiduciary responsibility or prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, and all Common Shares of the Company shall be subject to such terms and conditions.

Prospective investors should carefully review the matters discussed under “Restrictions on Share Ownership” and should consult with their own advisors as to the consequences of making an investment in the Company.

No shareholder approval is required for certain mergers.

The Independent Trustees may undertake to approve mergers between us and certain other funds or vehicles. Subject to the requirements of the 1940 Act, such mergers will not require shareholder approval so you will not be given an opportunity to vote on these matters unless such mergers are reasonably anticipated to result in a material dilution of the NAV per share of the Company. These mergers may involve funds managed by affiliates of Apollo. The Independent Trustees may also convert the form and/or jurisdiction of organization, including to take advantage of laws that are more favorable to maintaining board control in the face of dissident shareholders.

Shareholders may experience dilution.

All distributions declared in cash payable to shareholders that are participants in our distribution reinvestment plan will generally be automatically reinvested in our Common Shares. As a result, shareholders that do not participate in our distribution reinvestment plan may experience dilution over time.

Holders of our Common Shares will not have preemptive rights to any shares we issue in the future. Our charter allows us to issue an unlimited number of Common Shares. After you purchase Common Shares in our offering, our Board of Trustees may elect, without shareholder approval, to:

i.
sell additional shares in this or future public offerings;
ii.
issue Common Shares or interests in any of our subsidiaries in private offerings;
iii.
issue Common Shares upon the exercise of the options we may grant to our independent trustees or future employees; or
iv.
subject to applicable law, issue Common Shares in payment of an outstanding obligation to pay fees for services rendered to us.

To the extent we issue additional Common Shares after your purchase in our offering, your percentage ownership interest in us will be diluted. Because of these and other reasons, our shareholders may experience substantial dilution in their percentage ownership of our shares or their interests in the underlying assets held by our subsidiaries.

Investing in our shares involves a high degree of risk and is highly speculative.

The investments we make in accordance with our investment objective may result in a higher amount of risk than alternative investment options and volatility or loss of principal. Our investments in portfolio companies may be highly speculative and aggressive and, therefore, an investment in our shares may not be suitable for someone with lower risk tolerance.

51


Table of Contents

 

The NAV of our shares may fluctuate significantly.

The NAV and liquidity, if any, of the market for our shares may be significantly affected by numerous factors, some of which are beyond our control and may not be directly related to our operating performance. These factors include:

changes in regulatory policies or tax guidelines, particularly with respect to RICs or BDCs;
changes in law, regulatory policies or tax guidelines, or interpretations thereof, particularly with respect to RICs or BDCs;
loss of RIC or BDC status;
changes in earnings or variations in operating results;
changes in the value of our portfolio of investments;
changes in accounting guidelines governing valuation of our investments;
any shortfall in revenue or net income or any increase in losses from levels expected by investors;
departure of either of our adviser or certain of its respective key personnel;
uncertainty surrounding the strength of the U.S. economic recovery;
uncertainty between the U.S. and other countries with respect to trade policies, treaties and tariffs;
general economic trends and other external factors; and
loss of a major funding source.

 

 

52


Table of Contents

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

Item 2. Properties

As of December 31, 2022, we did not own any real estate or other physical properties materially important to our operations. Our administrative and principal executive offices are located at 9 West 57th Street, New York, NY 10019, respectively. We believe that our office facilities are suitable and adequate for our business as it is currently conducted.

 

We are not currently subject to any material legal proceedings, nor, to our knowledge, are any material legal proceeding threatened against us. From time to time, we may be a party to certain legal proceedings in the ordinary course of business, including proceedings relating to the enforcement of our rights under contracts with our portfolio companies. Our business is also subject to extensive regulation, which may result in regulatory proceedings against us. While the outcome of any such future legal or regulatory proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty, we do not expect that any such future proceedings will have a material effect upon our financial condition or results of operations.

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

 

53


Table of Contents

 

PART II

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Market Information

There is not currently and, until an exchange listing, we do not expect there to be, a public market for our shares, nor can we give any assurance that one will develop.

Share Issuances

The offering consists of three classes of shares of our common stock, Class S shares, Class D shares and Class I shares. The share classes have different ongoing stockholder servicing fees. Other than the differences in ongoing stockholder servicing fees, each class of common stock has the same economics and voting rights. As of March 16, 2023, there were 1,827 holders of record of our Class S common shares, 34 holders of record of our Class D common shares and 928 holders of record of our Class I common shares.

We will determine our NAV for each class of shares each month as of the last day of each calendar month. The NAV per share for each class of shares is determined by dividing the value of total assets attributable to the class minus liabilities attributable to the class by the total number of Common Shares outstanding of the class at the date as of which the determination is made. The following table presents our monthly NAV per share for each of the three classes of shares for the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

NAV Per Share

 

For the Month Ended

 

Class S

 

 

Class D

 

 

Class I

 

January 31, 2022

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

25.04

 

February 28, 2022

 

 

 

24.74

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.74

 

March 31, 2022

 

 

 

24.71

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.71

 

April 30, 2022

 

 

 

24.63

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.63

 

May 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.72

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

23.72

 

June 30, 2022

 

 

 

22.87

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22.87

 

July 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.43

 

 

 

 

23.43

 

 

 

 

23.43

 

August 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.55

 

 

 

 

23.55

 

 

 

 

23.55

 

September 30, 2022

 

 

 

22.97

 

 

 

 

22.97

 

 

 

 

22.97

 

October 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.07

 

 

 

 

23.07

 

 

 

 

23.07

 

November 30, 2022

 

 

 

23.13

 

 

 

 

23.13

 

 

 

 

23.13

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.20

 

 

 

 

23.20

 

 

 

 

23.20

 

(1) Class S commenced operations on February 1, 2022, at which time the Company first accepted subscriptions at a NAV per share of $25.04.

(2) Class D commenced operations on July 1, 2022, at which time the Company first accepted subscriptions at a NAV per share of $22.87.

Distributions

We have paid regular monthly distributions commencing with the first full calendar quarter after the escrow period concludes. Any distributions we make will be at the discretion of our Board, considering factors such as our earnings, cash flow, capital needs and general financial condition and the requirements of Delaware law. As a result, our distribution rates and payment frequency may vary from time to time.

Our Board of Trustees’ discretion as to the payment of distributions will be directed, in substantial part, by its determination to cause us to comply with the RIC requirements. To maintain our treatment as a RIC, we generally are required to make aggregate annual distributions to our shareholders of at least 90% of our net investment income. See “Description of our Shares” and “Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.”

The per share amount of distributions on Class S, Class D and Class I shares generally differ because of different class-specific shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees that are deducted from the gross distributions for each share class. Specifically, distributions on Class S shares will be lower than Class D shares, and Class D shares will be lower than Class I shares because we are required to pay higher ongoing shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees with respect to the Class S shares (compared to Class D shares and Class I shares) and we are required to pay higher ongoing shareholder servicing fees with respect to Class D shares (compared to Class I shares).

 

54


Table of Contents

 

The following table summarizes our distributions declared and payable for the year ended December 31, 2022 (dollars in thousands except per share amounts) by share class:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class S Distributions

 

 

Class D Distributions

 

 

Class I Distributions

 

Declaration Date

 

Record Date

 

Payment Date

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

January 31, 2022

 

January 31, 2022

 

March 7, 2022

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

0.1045

 

 

$

 

2,744

 

February 28, 2022

 

February 28, 2022

 

April 1, 2022

 

 

 

0.1245

 

 

 

 

22

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

6,096

 

March 29, 2022

 

March 29, 2022

 

April 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1229

 

 

 

 

225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

7,472

 

April 21, 2022

 

April 30, 2022

 

May 26, 2022

 

 

 

0.1235

 

 

 

 

426

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

8,388

 

May 20, 2022

 

May 31, 2022

 

June 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1230

 

 

 

 

576

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,105

 

June 22, 2022

 

June 30, 2022

 

July 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

717

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,404

 

July 25, 2022

 

July 29, 2022

 

August 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

842

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,013

 

August 23, 2022

 

August 31, 2022

 

September 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1239

 

 

 

 

955

 

 

 

 

0.1358

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,373

 

September 22, 2022

 

September 30, 2022

 

October 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

1,119

 

 

 

 

0.1360

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,767

 

October 21, 2022

 

October 31, 2022

 

November 25, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

1,214

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

11,435

 

November 16, 2022

 

November 30, 2022

 

December 27, 2022

 

 

 

0.1439

 

 

 

 

1,473

 

 

 

 

0.1553

 

 

 

 

13

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,174

 

December 15, 2022

 

December 30, 2022

 

January 27, 2023

 

 

 

0.1433

 

 

 

 

1,552

 

 

 

 

0.1551

 

 

 

 

16

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,395

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

Distribution and Servicing Plan

The Board approved a distribution and servicing plan (the “Distribution and Servicing Plan”). The following table shows the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees the Company will pay the Intermediary Manager with respect to the Class S, Class D and Class I on an annualized basis as a percentage of the Company’s NAV for such class. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees will be paid monthly in arrears, calculated using the NAV of the applicable class as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month.

 

 

 

Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution
Fee as a % of NAV

 

Class S shares

 

 

0.85

%

Class D shares

 

 

0.25

%

Class I shares

 

 

 

 

Subject to FINRA and other limitations on underwriting compensation, the Company will pay a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.85% per annum of the aggregate NAV for the Class S shares and a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.25% per annum of the aggregate NAV for the Class D shares, in each case, payable monthly.

The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees will be paid monthly in arrears. The Intermediary Manager will reallow (pay) all or a portion of the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to participating brokers and servicing brokers for ongoing shareholder services performed by such brokers, and will waive shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to the extent a broker is not eligible to receive it for failure to provide such services. Because the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees with respect to Class S shares and Class D shares are calculated based on the aggregate NAV for all of the outstanding shares of each such class, it reduces the NAV with respect to all shares of each such class, including shares issued under the Company’s distribution reinvestment plan.

Eligibility to receive the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee is conditioned on a broker providing the following ongoing services with respect to the Class S or Class D shares: assistance with recordkeeping, answering investor inquiries regarding us, including regarding distribution payments and reinvestments, helping investors understand their investments upon their request, and assistance with share repurchase requests. If the applicable broker is not eligible to receive the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee due to failure to provide these services, the Intermediary Manager will waive the shareholder servicing fee and/or distribution that broker would have otherwise been eligible to receive. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees are ongoing fees that are not paid at the time of purchase.

55


Table of Contents

 

Dividend Reinvestment Plan

We have adopted a distribution reinvestment plan, pursuant to which we will reinvest all cash dividends declared by the Board of Trustees on behalf of our shareholders who do not elect to receive their dividends in cash as provided below. As a result, if the Board authorizes, and we declare, a cash dividend or other distribution, then our shareholders who have not opted out of our distribution reinvestment plan will have their cash distributions automatically reinvested in additional shares as described below, rather than receiving the cash dividend or other distribution. Distributions on fractional shares will be credited to each participating shareholder’s account to three decimal places.

No action is required on the part of a registered shareholder to have his, her or its cash dividend or other distribution reinvested in our shares, except shareholders in certain states. Shareholders can elect to “opt out” of the Fund’s distribution reinvestment plan in their subscription agreements (other than Alabama, Arkansas, Idaho, Kansas, Kentucky, Maine, Maryland, Massachusetts, Nebraska, New Jersey, Ohio, Oklahoma, Oregon, Texas, Vermont and Washington investors and clients of certain participating brokers that do not permit automatic enrollment in our distribution reinvestment plan and must affirmatively opt in to participate in the plan). Alabama, Arkansas, Idaho, Kansas, Kentucky, Maine, Maryland, Massachusetts, Nebraska, New Jersey, Oklahoma, Oregon, Texas, Vermont and Washington investors and clients of certain participating brokers that do not permit automatic enrollment in our distribution reinvestment plan will automatically receive their distributions in cash unless they elect to have their cash distributions reinvested in additional Common Shares. Ohio residents that own Class S or Class D Shares are not eligible to participate in our distribution reinvestment plan.

If any shareholder initially elects not to participate, they may later become a participant by subsequently completing and executing an enrollment form or any distribution authorization form as may be available from the Fund or the DST Systems Inc. (the “Plan Administrator”). Participation in the distribution reinvestment plan will begin immediately after acceptance of a participant’s subscription, enrollment or authorization. Shares will be purchased under the distribution reinvestment plan as of the first calendar day of the month following the record date of the distribution.

Share Repurchase Program

At the discretion of the Board, we have commenced a share repurchase program in which the Company may repurchase, in each quarter, up to 5% of the NAV of our common shares outstanding (either by number of shares or aggregate NAV) as of the close of the previous calendar quarter. The Board may amend or suspend the share repurchase program at any time if in its reasonable judgment it deems such action to be in the best interest of shareholders, such as when a repurchase offer would place an undue burden on the Company’s liquidity, adversely affect the Company’s operations or risk having an adverse impact on the Company that would outweigh the benefit of the repurchase offer. As a result, share repurchases may not be available each quarter. We intend to conduct such repurchase offers in accordance with the requirements of Rule 13e-4 promulgated under the 1934 Act and the 1940 Act. All shares purchased pursuant to the terms of each tender offer will be retired and thereafter will be authorized and unissued shares.

Under the share repurchase plan, to the extent the Company offers to repurchase shares in any particular quarter, it is expected to repurchase shares pursuant to tender offers on or around the last business day of that quarter using a purchase price equal to the NAV per share as of the last calendar day of the applicable quarter, except that shares that have not been outstanding for at least one year will be repurchased at 98% of such NAV (an “Early Repurchase Deduction”). The one-year holding period is measured as of the subscription closing date immediately following the prospective repurchase date. The Early Repurchase Deduction may be waived in the case of repurchase requests arising from the death, divorce or qualified disability of the holder. The Early Repurchase Deduction will be retained by the Company for the benefit of remaining shareholders.

The following table further summarizes the share repurchases completed during the year ended December 31, 2022:

Repurchase Deadline Request

 

Percentage of Outstanding Shares the Company Offered to Repurchase

 

 

Price Paid Per Share

 

 

Repurchase Pricing Date

 

Amount Repurchased (all classes)

 

 

Number of Shares Repurchased (all classes)

 

 

Percentage of Outstanding Shares Repurchased

 

 

Maximum number of shares that were available for purchase under the repurchase plan

 

June 17, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

$

22.87

 

 

June 30, 2022

 

 

1,822

 

 

 

81,278

 

 

 

0.15

%

 

 

2,745,085

 

September 13, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

 

22.97

 

 

September 30, 2022

 

 

5,699

 

 

 

252,255

 

 

 

0.35

%

 

 

3,623,806

 

December 14, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

 

23.20

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

40,854

 

 

 

1,780,665

 

 

 

2.09

%

 

 

4,264,898

 

 

Item 6. Reserved

The selected financial data previously required by Item 301 of Regulation S-K has been omitted in reliance on SEC Release No. 33-10890, Management's Discussion and Analysis, Selected Financial Data, and Supplementary Financial Information.

56


Table of Contents

 

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The discussion and analysis contained in this section refers to our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. The information contained in this section should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K "Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data." This discussion contains forward-looking statements and involves numerous risks and uncertainties, including, but not limited to those described in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K "Risk Factors". Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated by such forward-looking information due to factors discussed under "Risk Factors" and "Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements" appearing elsewhere in this Form 10-K. The year ended December 31, 2022 represents the period from January 7, 2022 (commencement of operations) to December 31, 2022.

These forward-looking statements are not historical facts, but rather are based on current expectations, estimates and projections about Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “Company,” “we”, “us”, or “our”), our current and prospective portfolio investments, our industry, our beliefs and opinions, and our assumptions. Words such as “anticipates,” “expects,” “intends,” “plans,” “will,” “may,” “continue,” “believes,” “seeks,” “estimates,” “would,” “could,” “should,” “targets,” “projects,” “outlook,” “potential,” “predicts” and variations of these words and similar expressions are intended to identify forward-looking statements. These statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, uncertainties and other factors, some of which are beyond our control and difficult to predict and could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed or forecasted in the forward-looking statements, including without limitation:

our future operating results;
our business prospects and the prospects of the companies in which we may invest;
the impact of the investments that we expect to make;
our ability to raise sufficient capital to execute our investment strategy;
general economic and political trends and other external factors, including the current COVID-19 pandemic and recent supply chain disruptions;
the ability of our portfolio companies to achieve their objectives;
our current and expected financing arrangements and investments;
changes in the general interest rate environment;
the adequacy of our cash resources, financing sources and working capital;
the timing and amount of cash flows, distributions and dividends, if any, from our portfolio companies;
our contractual arrangements and relationships with third parties;
actual and potential conflicts of interest with Apollo Credit Management, LLC (the “Adviser”) or any of its affiliates
the elevating levels of inflation, and its impact on our portfolio companies and on the industries in which we invest;
the dependence of our future success on the general economy and its effect on the industries in which we may invest;
our use of financial leverage;
the ability of the Adviser to source suitable investments for us and to monitor and administer our investments;
the ability of the Adviser or its affiliates to attract and retain highly talented professionals;
our ability to qualify for and maintain our qualification as a regulated investment company and as a business development company (“BDC”);
the impact on our business of U.S. and international financial reform legislation, rules and regulations;
the effect of changes to tax legislation and our tax position; and
the tax status of the enterprises in which we may invest.

Although we believe that the assumptions on which these forward-looking statements are based are reasonable, any of those assumptions could prove to be inaccurate, and as a result, the forward-looking statements based on those assumptions also could be inaccurate. In light of these and other uncertainties, the inclusion of a projection or forward-looking statement in this report should not be regarded as a representation by us that our plans and objectives will be achieved. These risks and uncertainties include those described or identified in the section entitled “Item 1A. Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this report. These forward-looking statements apply only as of the date of this report. Moreover, we assume no duty and do not undertake to update the forward-looking statements, except as required by applicable law. Because we are an investment company, the forward-looking statements and projections contained in this report are excluded from the safe harbor protection provided by Section 21E of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 Act, as amended (the “1934 Act”).

57


Table of Contents

 

Overview

We are a newly organized, externally managed, non-diversified closed-end management investment company that has elected to be treated as a BDC under the 1940 Act. Formed as a Delaware statutory trust on December 4, 2020, we are externally managed by the Adviser, which is responsible for sourcing potential investments, conducting due diligence on prospective investments, analyzing investment opportunities, structuring investments and monitoring our portfolio on an ongoing basis. Our Adviser is registered as investment adviser with the SEC. We also have elected to be treated, and intend to qualify annually thereafter, as a RIC under the Code.

Under our Investment Advisory Agreement, we have agreed to pay the Adviser a management fee as well as an incentive fee based on our investment performance. Also, under the Administration Agreement, we have agreed to reimburse the Administrator for the allocable portion of overhead and other expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its obligations under the Administration Agreement, including, but not limited to, our allocable portion of the costs of compensation and related expenses of our chief compliance officer, chief financial officer and their respective staffs.

Our investment objectives are to generate current income and, to a lesser extent, long-term capital appreciation. We invest primarily in private credit opportunities in directly originated assets, including loans and other debt securities, made to or issued by large private U.S. borrowers, with a strong emphasis on senior secured lending. While most of our investments will be in private U.S. companies (subject to compliance with BDC regulatory requirement to invest at least 70% of its assets in private U.S. companies), we also expect to invest from time to time in European and other non-U.S. companies. Our portfolio may also include equity interests such as common stock, preferred stock, warrants or options, which generally would be obtained as part of providing a broader financing solution. Under normal circumstances, we will invest directly or indirectly at least 80% of our total assets (net assets plus borrowings for investment purposes) in debt instruments of varying maturities.

Most of the debt instruments we invest in are unrated or rated below investment grade, which is often an indication of size, credit worthiness and speculative nature relative to the capacity of the borrower to pay interest and principal. Generally, if our unrated investments were rated, they would be rated below investment grade. These securities, which are often referred to as “junk” or “high yield”, have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. They may also be difficult to value and are illiquid.

Investments

We focus primarily on loans and securities, including syndicated loans, of private U.S. companies. Our level of investment activity (both the number of investments and the size of each investment) can and will vary substantially from period to period depending on many factors, including the amount of debt and equity capital available to private companies, the level of merger and acquisition activity for such companies, the general economic environment, trading prices of loans and other securities and the competitive environment for the types of investments we make.

Revenues

We generate revenues in the form of interest income on debt investments, capital gains, and dividend income from our equity investments in our portfolio companies. Our senior and subordinated debt investments are expected to bear interest at a fixed or floating rate. Interest on debt securities is generally payable quarterly or semiannually. In some cases, some of our investments may provide for deferred interest payments or PIK interest. The principal amount of the debt securities and any accrued but unpaid PIK interest generally will become due at the maturity date. In addition, we may generate revenue in the form of commitment and other fees in connection with transactions. Original issue discounts and market discounts or premiums are capitalized, and we accrete or amortize such amounts as interest income. We record prepayment premiums on loans and debt securities as interest income. Dividend income, if any, is recognized on an accrual basis to the extent that we expect to collect such amounts.

Expenses

Except as specifically provided below, all investment professionals and staff of the Adviser, when and to the extent engaged in providing investment advisory services to us, and the base compensation, bonus and benefits, and the routine overhead expenses, of such personnel allocable to such services, is provided and paid for by the Adviser. We bear all other costs and expenses of our operations, administration and transactions, including, but not limited to (a) investment advisory fees, including management fees and incentive fees, to the Adviser, pursuant to the Investment Advisory Agreement; (b) our allocable portion of compensation, overhead (including rent, office equipment and utilities) and other expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its administrative obligations under the Administration Agreement, including but not limited to: (i) our chief compliance officer, chief financial officer and their respective staffs; (ii) investor relations, legal, operations and other non-investment professionals at the Administrator that performs duties for us; and (iii) any internal audit group personnel of AGM or any of its affiliates; and (c) all other expenses of our operations, administrations and transactions.

With respect to costs incurred in connection with our organization and offering and all other costs incurred prior to the time we break escrow for the offering, the Adviser has agreed to advance all such costs on our behalf. Unless the Adviser elects to cover such expenses pursuant to the Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement we entered into with the Adviser, we will be obligated to reimburse the Adviser for such advanced expenses upon breaking escrow for our offering of common shares. See “—Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement.” Any reimbursements that may be made by us in the future will not exceed actual expenses incurred by the Adviser and its affiliates.

From time to time, the Adviser, the Administrator or their affiliates may pay third-party providers of goods or services. We will reimburse the Adviser, the Administrator or such affiliates thereof for any such amounts paid on our behalf. From time to time, the Adviser or the Administrator may defer or waive fees and/or rights to be reimbursed for expenses. All of the foregoing expenses will ultimately be borne by our shareholders.

58


Table of Contents

 

Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement

We have entered into an Expense Support Agreement with the Adviser. For additional information see “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 3. Fees, Expenses, Agreements and Related Party Transactions”.

LIBOR Developments

On July 27, 2017, the U.K Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) announced that it would phase out LIBOR as a benchmark by the end of 2021. As of December 31, 2021, all non-U.S. dollar LIBOR publications have been phased out. The phase out of a majority of the U.S. dollar publications is delayed until June 30, 2023. The Alternative Reference Rates Committee (“ARRC”) of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York previously confirm that this constitutes a “benchmark transition event” and established “benchmark replacement dates” in ARRC standard LIBOR transition provisions that exist in many U.S. law contracts using LIBOR.

The publication of all EUR and CHF LIBOR settings, the Spot Next/Overnight, 1 week, 2 month and 12 month JPY and GBP LIBOR settings, and the 1 week and 2 months USD LIBOR settings has ceased. The publication of the overnight, 1 month, 3 month, 6 month, and 12 months USD LIBOR settings will cease after June 30, 2023. The FCA plans to consult the market on creating “synthetic” 1 month, 3 month and 6 month rates for GBP and JPY LIBOR, to be published for a limited time.

The New York State legislation was signed into law to aid “tough legacy” LIBOR contracts. Other legislative solutions are being pursued at the Federal level, in the U.K. and in Europe. The U.S. Federal banking agencies have also issued guidance encouraging banking and global organizations to cease reference to USD LIBOR as soon as practicable and, in any event, by December 31, 2021. The E.U. Benchmarks Regulation imposed conditions under which only compliant benchmarks may be used in new contracts after 2021.

The ARRC has identified the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”) as its preferred alternative rate for LIBOR. SOFR is a measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight, collateralized by the U.S. Treasury securities, and is based on directly observable U.S. Treasury-backed repurchase transactions. However, the COVID-19 pandemic may adversely impact the timing of many firms’ transition planning, and we continue to assess the potential impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on our transition plans. Although SOFR appears to be the preferred replacement rate for U.S. dollar LIBOR, it is not possible at this time to predict the effect of any such changes, any establishment of alternative reference rates, whether the COVID-19 pandemic will have further effect on LIBOR transition timelines or plans, or other reforms to LIBOR that may be enacted in the United States, United Kingdom or elsewhere.

The discontinuation of LIBOR could have a significant impact on our business. We anticipate significant operational challenges for the transition away from LIBOR, including, but not limited to, amending existing loan agreements with borrowers on investments that may have not been modified with fallback language and adding effective fallback language to new agreements in the event that LIBOR is discontinued before maturity.

Beyond these challenges, we anticipate there may be additional risks to our current processes and information systems that we will need to identify and evaluate. Due to the uncertainty of the replacement for LIBOR, the potential effect of any such event on our cost of capital and net investment income cannot yet be determined. In addition, any further changes or reforms to the determination or supervision of LIBOR may result in a sudden or prolonged increase or decrease in reported LIBOR, which could have an adverse impact on the market value of any LIBOR-linked securities, loans and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by or due to us and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

 

59


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio and Investment Activity

Our portfolio and investment activity during the year ended December 31, 2022 was as follows:

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

(in thousands)*

2022

 

Investments made in portfolio companies

$

 

6,606,772

 

Investments sold

 

 

(1,839,291

)

Net activity before repaid investments

$

 

4,767,481

 

Investments repaid

 

 

(330,946

)

Net investment activity

$

 

4,436,535

 

 

 

 

 

Portfolio companies at beginning of period

 

 

 

Number of new portfolio companies

 

 

203

 

Number of exited portfolio companies

 

 

(75

)

Portfolio companies at end of period

 

 

128

 

 

 

 

 

Number of investments made in existing portfolio companies

 

 

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

Our portfolio composition and weighted average yields as of December 31, 2022 was as follows:

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

Portfolio composition, at fair value:

 

 

 

First lien secured debt

 

 

99.0

%

Unsecured debt

 

 

1.0

%

Weighted average yields, at amortized cost (1):

 

 

 

First lien secured debt (2)

 

 

10.0

%

Unsecured debt portfolio (2)

 

 

11.1

%

Total portfolio (3)

 

 

10.1

%

Interest rate type, at fair value:

 

 

 

Fixed rate amount

 

$0.1 billion

 

Floating rate amount

 

$4.2 billion

 

Fixed rate, as percentage of total

 

 

1.5

%

Floating rate, as percentage of total

 

 

98.5

%

Interest rate type, at amortized cost:

 

 

 

Fixed rate amount

 

$0.1 billion

 

Floating rate amount

 

$4.3 billion

 

Fixed rate, as percentage of total

 

 

2.1

%

Floating rate, as percentage of total

 

 

97.9

%

Weighted average spread over reference rate of all floating rate investments

 

 

5.5

%

 

(1)
An investor’s yield may be lower than the portfolio yield due to sales loads and other expenses.
(2)
Exclusive of investments on non-accrual status. As of December 31, 2022 there were no investments on non-accrual status.
(3)
Inclusive of all income generating investments, non-income generating investments and investments on non-accrual status. As of December 31, 2022 there were no investments on non-accrual status.

 

Our Adviser monitors our portfolio companies on an ongoing basis. It monitors the financial trends of each portfolio company to determine if they are meeting their respective business plans and to assess the appropriate course of action with respect to each portfolio company. Our Adviser has several methods of evaluating and monitoring the performance and fair value of our investments, which may include the following:

assessment of success of the portfolio company in adhering to its business plan and compliance with covenants;
periodic and regular contact with portfolio company management and, if appropriate, the financial or strategic sponsor, to discuss financial position, requirements and accomplishments;
comparisons to other companies in the portfolio company’s industry; and
review of monthly or quarterly financial statements and financial projections for portfolio companies.

 

 

60


Table of Contents

 

As part of the monitoring process, our Adviser employs an investment rating system to categorize our investments. In addition to various risk management and monitoring tools, our Adviser rates the credit risk of all investments on a scale of 1 to 5. This system is intended primarily to reflect the underlying risk of a portfolio investment relative to our initial cost basis in respect of such portfolio investment (i.e., at the time of origination or acquisition), although it may also take into account the performance of the portfolio company’s business, the collateral coverage of the investment and other relevant factors. The rating system is as follows:

 

Investment Rating

 

 

Description

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

Investments rated 1 involve the least amount of risk to our initial cost basis. The borrower is performing above expectations, and the trends and risk factors for this investment since origination or acquisition are generally favorable;

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

Investments rated 2 involve an acceptable level of risk that is similar to the risk at the time of origination or acquisition. The borrower is generally performing as expected and the risk factors are neutral to favorable. All investments or acquired investments in new portfolio companies are initially assessed a rating of 2;

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3

 

 

Investments rated 3 involve a borrower performing below expectations and indicates that the loan’s risk has increased somewhat since origination or acquisition;

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4

 

 

Investments rated 4 involve a borrower performing materially below expectations and indicates that the loan’s risk has increased materially since origination or acquisition. In addition to the borrower being generally out of compliance with debt covenants, loan payments may be past due (but generally not more than 120 days past due); and

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5

 

 

Investments rated 5 involve a borrower performing substantially below expectations and indicates that the loan’s risk has increased substantially since origination or acquisition. Most or all of the debt covenants are out of compliance and payments are substantially delinquent. Loans rated 5 are not anticipated to be repaid in full and we will reduce the fair market value of the loan to the amount we anticipate will be recovered.

 

The following table shows the composition of our portfolio on the 1 to 5 rating scale as of December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

Investment Ranking

 

Fair Value

 

 

Percentage

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

$

 

8,536

 

 

 

 

0.2

%

2

 

 

 

4,220,721

 

 

 

 

98.0

%

3

 

 

 

79,635

 

 

 

 

1.8

%

4

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.0

%

5

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.0

%

Total

 

$

 

4,308,892

 

 

 

 

100.0

%

 

Critical Accounting Policies

Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based upon our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses, gains and losses. Changes in the economic environment, financial markets, credit worthiness of portfolio companies and any other parameters used in determining such estimates could cause actual results to differ materially. In addition to the discussion below, our critical accounting policies are further described in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

Investments

Investments are recognized when we assume an obligation to acquire a financial instrument and assume the risks for gains and losses related to that instrument. Investments are derecognized when we assume an obligation to sell a financial instrument and forego the risks for gains or losses related to that instrument. Specifically, we record all security transactions on a trade date basis. Amounts for investments recognized or derecognized but not yet settled are reported as a receivable for investments sold and a payable for investments purchased, respectively, in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Realized gains or losses are measured by the difference between the net proceeds received (excluding prepayment fees, if any) and the amortized cost basis of the investment using the specific identification method without regard to unrealized gains or losses previously recognized, and include investments charged off during the period, net of recoveries. The net change in unrealized gains or losses primarily reflects the change in investment values, including the reversal of previously recorded unrealized gains or losses with respect to investments realized during the period.

 

61


Table of Contents

 

Fair Value Measurements

The Company follows guidance in ASC 820, Fair Value Measurement (“ASC 820”), where fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Fair value measurements are determined within a framework that establishes a three-tier hierarchy which maximizes the use of observable market data and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs to establish a classification of fair value measurements for disclosure purposes. Inputs refer broadly to the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including assumptions about risk, such as the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique used to measure fair value using a pricing model and/or the risk inherent in the inputs for the valuation technique. Inputs may be observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Company. Unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability based on the information available. The inputs or methodology used for valuing assets or liabilities may not be an indication of the risks associated with investing in those assets or liabilities.

ASC 820 classifies the inputs used to measure these fair values into the following hierarchy:

Level 1: Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities, accessible by us at the measurement date.

Level 2: Quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, or quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or other observable inputs other than quoted prices.

Level 3: Unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

In all cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which th3e fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement. Our assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment and considers factors specific to each investment. The level assigned to the investment valuations may not be indicative of the risk or liquidity associated with investing in such investments. Because of the inherent uncertainties of valuation, the values reflected in the consolidated financial statements may differ materially from the values that would be received upon an actual disposition of such investments.

Investment Valuation Process

The Board of Trustees has designated the Adviser as its "valuation designee" pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the 1940 Act, and in that role the Adviser is responsible for performing fair value determinations relating to all of the Company's investments, including periodically assessing and managing any material valuation risks and establishing and applying fair value methodologies, in accordance with valuation policies and procedures that have been approved by the Company's Board of Trustees. Even though the Company's Board of Trustees designated the Company's Adviser as "valuation designee," the Company's Board of Trustees continues to be responsible for overseeing the processes for determining fair valuation.

In calculating the value of our total assets, we value investments for which market quotations are readily available at such market quotations if they are deemed to represent fair value. Debt and equity securities that are not publicly traded or whose market price is not readily available or whose market quotations are not deemed to represent fair value are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by or under the direction of the Adviser. Market quotations may be deemed not to represent fair value in certain circumstances where the Adviser reasonably believes that facts and circumstances applicable to an issuer, a seller or purchaser or the market for a particular security causes current market quotes not to reflect the fair value of the security. Examples of these events could include cases in which material events are announced after the close of the market on which a security is primarily traded, when a security trades infrequently causing a quoted purchase or sale price to become stale or in the event of a “fire sale” by a distressed seller.

If and when market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, we typically utilize independent third party valuation firms to assist us in determining fair value. Accordingly, such investments go through our multi-step valuation process as described below. The Adviser engages multiple independent valuation firms based on a review of each firm’s expertise and relevant experience in valuing certain securities. In each case, our independent valuation firms consider observable market inputs together with significant unobservable inputs in arriving at their valuation recommendations for such Level 3 categorized assets.

 

62


Table of Contents

 

With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available or when such market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, our Adviser undertakes a multi-step valuation process each quarter, as described below:

(1)
Independent valuation firms engaged conduct independent appraisals and assessments for all the investments they have been engaged to review. If an independent valuation firm is not engaged during a particular quarter, the valuation may be conducted by the Adviser;
(2)
At least each quarter, the valuation will be reassessed and updated by the Adviser or an independent valuation firm to reflect company specific events and latest market data;
(3)
Preliminary valuation conclusions are then documented and discussed with senior management of our Adviser;
(4)
The Adviser discusses valuations and determines in good faith the fair value of each investment in our portfolio based on the input of the applicable independent valuation firm; and
(5)
For Level 3 investments entered into within the current quarter, the cost (purchase price adjusted for accreted original issue discount/amortized premium) or any recent comparable trade activity on the security investment shall be considered to reasonably approximate the fair value of the investment, provided that no material change has since occurred in the issuer’s business, significant inputs or the relevant environment.

Investments are valued utilizing a market approach, an income approach, or both approaches, as appropriate. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities (including a business). The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts (for example, cash flows or earnings) to a single present amount (discounted). The measurement is based on the value indicated by current market expectations about those future amounts. During the year ended December 31, 2022, there were no significant changes to the Company’s valuation techniques and related inputs considered in the valuation process.

Investment Income Recognition

Interest Income

Interest income is recorded on an accrual basis and includes the accretion of discounts and amortizations of premiums. Discounts from and premiums to par value on debt investments purchased are accreted/amortized into interest income over the life of the respective security using the effective interest method. The amortized cost of debt investments represents the original cost, including loan origination fees and upfront fees received that are deemed to be an adjustment to yield, adjusted for the accretion of discounts and amortization of premiums, if any. Upon prepayment of a loan or debt security, any prepayment premiums, unamortized upfront loan origination fees and unamortized discounts are recorded as interest income in the current period.

PIK Income

The Company may have loans in its portfolio that contain PIK provisions. PIK represents interest that is accrued and recorded as interest income at the contractual rates, increases the loan principal on the respective capitalization dates, and is generally due at maturity. Such income is included in interest income in the Company’s statement of operations. If at any point the Company believes PIK is not expected to be realized, the investment generating PIK will be placed on non-accrual status. When a PIK investment is placed on non-accrual status, the accrued, uncapitalized interest is generally reversed through interest income. To maintain the Company’s status as a RIC, this non-cash source of income must be paid out to shareholders in the form of dividends, even though the Company has not yet collected cash.

Dividend Income

Dividend income on preferred equity securities is recorded on the accrual basis to the extent that such amounts are payable by the portfolio company and are expected to be collected. Dividend income on common equity securities is recorded on the record date for private portfolio companies or on the ex-dividend date for publicly-traded portfolio companies.

Fee Income

The Company may receive various fees in the ordinary course of business such as structuring, consent, waiver, amendment, syndication fees as well as fees for managerial assistance rendered by the Company to the portfolio companies. Such fees are recognized as income when earned or the services are rendered.

Non-Accrual Income

Loans are generally placed on non-accrual status when there is reasonable doubt that principal or interest will be collected in full. Accrued interest is generally reversed when a loan is placed on non-accrual status. Additionally, any original issue discount and market discount are no longer accreted to interest income as of the date the loan is placed on non-accrual status. Interest payments received on non-accrual loans may be recognized as income or applied to principal depending upon management’s judgment regarding collectability. Non-accrual loans are restored to accrual status when past due principal and interest is paid current and, in management’s judgment, are likely to remain current. Management may make exceptions to this treatment and determine to not place a loan on non-accrual status if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection.

 

63


Table of Contents

 

Expenses

Expenses include management fees, performance-based incentive fees, interest expense, insurance expenses, administrative service fees, legal fees, trustees’ fees, audit and tax service expenses, third-party valuation fees and other general and administrative expenses. Expenses are recognized on an accrual basis.

Fee Waivers

The Adviser agreed to waive the management fee and incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022. Commencing on July 7, 2022, the Adviser is entitled to management fees and performance-based incentive fees as described in “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 3. Fees, Expenses, Agreements and Related Party Transactions”

Expense Support

The Company entered into an expense support and conditional reimbursement agreement with the Adviser. The Adviser may elect to pay certain expenses provided that no portion of the payment will be used to pay any interest or distributions and/or shareholder servicing fees of the Company. Any Expense Payment that the Adviser has committed to pay must be paid by the Adviser to the Company in any combination of cash or other immediately available funds no later than forty-five days after such commitment was made in writing, and/or offset against amounts due from the Company to the Adviser or its affiliates.

Net Realized Gains (Losses) and Net Change in Unrealized Gains (Losses)

We measure realized gains or losses by the difference between the net proceeds from the repayment or sale and the amortized cost basis of the investment, without regard to unrealized gains or losses previously recognized, but considering unamortized upfront fees and prepayment penalties. Net change in unrealized gain (loss) reflects the net change in portfolio investment values during the reporting period, including the reversal of previously recorded unrealized gains or losses. Within the context of these critical accounting policies, we are not currently aware of any reasonably likely events or circumstances that would result in materially different amounts being reported.

Income Taxes

We have elected to be treated as a RIC under the Code and operate in a manner so as to qualify for the tax treatment applicable to RICs. To qualify as a RIC, the Company must (among other requirements) meet certain source-of-income and asset diversification requirements and timely distribute to its stockholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income as defined by the Code, for each year. The Company (among other requirements) has made and intends to continue to make the requisite distributions to its stockholders, which will generally relieve the Company from corporate-level income taxes. For income tax purposes, distributions made to stockholders are reported as ordinary income, capital gains, non-taxable return of capital, or a combination thereof. The tax character of distributions paid to stockholders through December 31, 2022 may include return of capital, however, the exact amount cannot be determined at this point. The final determination of the tax character of distributions will not be made until we file our tax return for the tax year ending December 31, 2022. The character of income and gains that we will distribute is determined in accordance with income tax regulations that may differ from GAAP. Book and tax basis differences relating to stockholder dividend and distributions and other permanent book and tax difference are reclassified to paid-in capital.

If we do not distribute (or are not deemed to have distributed) at least 98% of our annual ordinary income and 98.2% of our capital gains in the calendar year earned, we will generally be required to pay excise tax equal to 4% of the amount by which 98% of our annual ordinary income and 98.2% of our capital gains exceed the distributions from such taxable income for the year. To the extent that we determine that our estimated current year annual taxable income will be in excess of estimated current year dividend distributions from such taxable income, we accrue excise taxes, if any, on estimated undistributed taxable income.

If we fail to satisfy the annual distribution requirement or otherwise fail to qualify as a RIC in any taxable year, we would be subject to tax on all of our taxable income at regular corporate rates. Distribution would generally be taxable to our individual and other non-corporate taxable stockholders as ordinary dividend income eligible for the reduced maximum rate applicable to qualified dividend income to the extent of our current and accumulated earnings and profits provided certain holding period and other requirements are met. Subject to certain limitation under the Code, corporate distributions would be eligible for the dividend-received deduction. To qualify again to be taxed as a RIC in a subsequent year, we would be required to distribute to our stockholders our accumulated earnings and profits attributable to non RIC years. In addition, if we failed to qualify as a RIC for a period greater than two taxable years, then, in order to qualify as a RIC in a subsequent year, we would be required to elect to recognize and pay tax on any net built-in gain (the excess of aggregate gain, including items of income, over aggregate loss that would have been realized if we had been liquidated) or, alternatively, be subject to taxation on such built-in gain recognized for a period of five years.

We follow ASC 740, Income Taxes (“ASC 740”). ASC 740 provides guidance for how uncertain tax positions should be recognized, measured, presented, and disclosed in the consolidated financial statements. ASC 740 requires the evaluation of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in the course of preparing our tax returns to determine whether the tax positions are “more-likely-than-not” of being sustained by the applicable tax authority. Tax positions not deemed to meet the more-likely-than-not threshold are recorded as a tax benefit or expense in the current year. Penalties or interest, if applicable, that may be assessed relating to income taxes would be classified as other operating expenses in the consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2022, there were no uncertain tax positions and no amounts accrued for interest or penalties. Management’s determinations regarding ASC 740 may be subject to review and adjustment at a later date based upon factors including, but not limited to, an on-going analysis of tax laws, regulations and interpretations thereof. Although we file both federal and state income tax returns, our major tax jurisdiction is federal.

 

64


Table of Contents

 

Results of Operations

On January 7, 2022, we commenced operations and accepted $657 million of subscriptions. As of December 31, 2021, we had not commenced operations and had not made any investments.

Operating results for the year ended December 31, 2022 was as follows (dollar amounts in millions):

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Total investment income

$

 

252.3

 

Net expenses

 

 

104.4

 

Net investment income

 

 

147.9

 

Net realized gain (loss)

 

 

(14.9

)

Net unrealized appreciation (depreciation)

 

 

(130.2

)

Net increase (decrease) in net assets resulting from operations

$

 

2.8

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

Net increase (decrease) in net assets resulting from operations can vary from period to period as a result of various factors, including acquisitions, the level of new investment commitments, the recognition of realized gains and losses and changes in unrealized appreciation and depreciation on the investment portfolio. As a result, comparisons may not be meaningful.

Investment Income

Investment income, was as follows (dollar amounts in millions):

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Investment Income

 

 

 

Interest income

$

 

236.0

 

Dividend income

 

 

0.0

 

PIK interest income

 

 

5.5

 

Other income

 

 

10.8

 

Total investment income

$

 

252.3

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, total investment income was $252.3 million, respectively, driven primarily by our deployment of capital. The size of our investment portfolio at fair value was $4.309 billion at December 31, 2022 and the weighted average yield on the debt and income producing portfolio at fair value was 10.8%.

 

65


Table of Contents

 

Expenses

Expenses were as follows (dollar amounts in millions):

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Management fees

$

 

20.9

 

Performance-based incentive fees

 

 

18.8

 

Interest and other debt expenses

 

 

69.7

 

Organization costs

 

 

0.9

 

Offering costs

 

 

2.0

 

Trustees' fees

 

 

0.4

 

Shareholder servicing fees

 

 

1.2

 

Administrative service expenses

 

 

2.1

 

Other general and administrative expenses

 

 

6.6

 

Total expenses

$

 

122.6

 

Management and performance-based incentive fees waived

 

 

(13.7

)

Expense support

 

 

(4.4

)

Net Expenses

$

 

104.4

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, net expenses were $104.4 million, primarily attributable to interest and other debt expenses.

Interest and other debt expenses

Total interest expense (including unused fees, amortization of deferred financing costs and accretion of net discounts on unsecured debt) of $69.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2022 was driven by $1.5 billion of average borrowings under our existing and new credit facilities at a total annualized cost of debt of 4.8%.

Management fees

For the year ended December 31, 2022, management fees were $20.9 million. Management fees are payable monthly in arrears at an annual rate of 1.25% of the value of our net assets as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the applicable month. The Adviser waived management fees through July 7, 2022, which resulted in a waiver of $8.6 million for year ended December 31, 2022.

Incentive fees

For the year ended December 31, 2022, incentive fees were $18.8 million. The Adviser waived incentive fees through July 7, 2022, which resulted in a waiver of $5.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2022.

Expense support

For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company received $4.4 million in expense support from the Adviser. Such expenses may be subject to reimbursement from the Company in the future.

Net Realized Gain (Loss)

Net realized gain (loss) was comprised of the following (dollar amounts in millions):

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments

$

 

(19.4

)

Foreign currency transactions

 

 

4.0

 

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

0.5

 

Net realized gains (losses)

$

 

(14.9

)

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, we recognized gross realized gains of $130.6 million and gross realized losses of $150.0 million, resulting in net realized losses on investments of $19.4 million through our first year of operations.

 

66


Table of Contents

 

Net Unrealized Gain (Loss)

Net unrealized gain (loss) was comprised of the following (dollar amounts in millions):

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments

$

 

(118.6

)

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

0.2

 

Foreign currency translations

 

 

(11.8

)

Net unrealized gains (losses)

$

 

(130.2

)

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, we recognized gross unrealized gains on investments of 20.6 million and gross unrealized losses on investments of $139.2 million, including the impact of transferring unrealized to realized gains (losses), resulting in net change in unrealized losses of $118.6 million on investments through our first year of operations.

Interest Rate Swaps

The Company uses interest rate swaps to mitigate interest rate risk associated with the Company's fixed rate liabilities, and has designated certain interest rate swaps to be in a hedge accounting relationship. See “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data - Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements - Note 2. Significant Accounting Policies” for additional disclosure regarding our accounting for derivative instruments designated in a hedge accounting relationship. See our schedule of investments for additional disclosure regarding these derivative instruments. See “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data - Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 6. Debt and Foreign Currency Transactions and Translations” for additional disclosure regarding the carrying value of our debt.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

The Company’s liquidity and capital resources are generated and generally available through our continuous offering of common shares and debt offerings, our Senior Secured Facility (as defined in Note 6 of the consolidated financial statements), investments in special purpose entities in which we hold and finance particular investments on a non-recourse basis, as well as from cash flows from operations, investment sales of liquid assets and repayments of senior and subordinated loans and income earned from investments.

As of December 31, 2022, we had three asset based leverage facilities, four unsecured debt issuances and one revolving credit facility outstanding. We have and will continue to, from time to time, enter into additional credit facilities, increase the size of our existing credit facilities or issue additional debt securities, including debt securitizations and unsecured debt. Any such incurrence or issuance may be from sources within the U.S. or from various foreign geographies or jurisdictions, and may be denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar. Additionally, any such incurrence or issuance would be subject to prevailing market conditions, our liquidity requirements, contractual and regulatory restrictions and other factors. In accordance with the 1940 Act, with certain limited exceptions, we are only allowed to incur borrowings, issue debt securities or issue preferred stock, if immediately after the borrowing or issuance, the ratio of total assets (less total liabilities other than indebtedness) to total indebtedness plus preferred stock, is at least 150%.

We believe that our current cash and cash equivalents on hand, our short-term investments, our available borrowing capacity under our Senior Secured Facility and our anticipated cash flows from operations will be adequate to meet our cash needs for our daily operations in the near term.

Cash Equivalents

The Company defines cash equivalents as securities that are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and near their maturity that they present insignificant risk of changes in value because of changes in interest rates. Generally, only securities with a maturity of three months or less from the date of purchase would qualify, with limited exceptions. The Company deems that certain money market funds, U.S. Treasury bills, repurchase agreements and other high-quality, short-term debt securities would qualify as cash equivalents (See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements.) At the end of each fiscal quarter, we consider taking proactive steps utilizing cash equivalents with the objective of enhancing our investment flexibility during the following quarter, pursuant to Section 55 of the 1940 Act. More specifically, we may purchase U.S. Treasury bills from time-to-time on the last business day of the quarter and typically close out that position on the following business day, settling the sale transaction on a net cash basis with the purchase, subsequent to quarter end. We may also utilize repurchase agreements or other balance sheet transactions, including drawing down on our Senior Secured Facility, as we deem appropriate. The amount of these transactions or such drawn cash for this purpose is excluded from total assets for purposes of computing the asset base upon which the management fee is determined.

 

67


Table of Contents

 

Debt

See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements for information on the Company’s debt.

The following table shows the contractual maturities of our debt obligations as of December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

 

Payments Due by Period*

 

(in millions)

 

 

Total

 

 

 

Less than 1 Year

 

 

 

1 to 3 Years

 

 

 

3 to 5 Years

 

 

 

More than 5 Years

 

Senior Secured Facility (1)

 

$

 

976

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

976

 

 

$

 

 

SPV Financing Facilities

 

 

 

1,073

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,073

 

 

 

 

 

Unsecured Notes

 

 

 

144

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

144

 

 

 

 

 

Total Debt Obligations

 

$

 

2,193

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

2,193

 

 

$

 

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

(1)
As of December 31, 2022, aggregate lender commitments under the Senior Secured Facility totaled $1,108.5 million of unused capacity.

Net Assets

See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements for information on the Company’s common shares and related capital activities.

Distributions

The following table summarizes our distributions declared and payable for the year ended December 31, 2022 (dollar amounts in thousands, except per share amounts):

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class S Distributions

 

 

Class D Distributions

 

 

Class I Distributions

 

Declaration Date

 

Record Date

 

Payment Date

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

January 31, 2022

 

January 31, 2022

 

March 7, 2022

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

0.1045

 

 

$

 

2,744

 

February 28, 2022

 

February 28, 2022

 

April 1, 2022

 

 

 

0.1245

 

 

 

 

22

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

6,096

 

March 29, 2022

 

March 29, 2022

 

April 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1229

 

 

 

 

225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

7,472

 

April 21, 2022

 

April 30, 2022

 

May 26, 2022

 

 

 

0.1235

 

 

 

 

426

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

8,388

 

May 20, 2022

 

May 31, 2022

 

June 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1230

 

 

 

 

576

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,105

 

June 22, 2022

 

June 30, 2022

 

July 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

717

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,404

 

July 25, 2022

 

July 29, 2022

 

August 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

842

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,013

 

August 23, 2022

 

August 31, 2022

 

September 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1239

 

 

 

 

955

 

 

 

 

0.1358

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,373

 

September 22, 2022

 

September 30, 2022

 

October 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

1,119

 

 

 

 

0.1360

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,767

 

October 21, 2022

 

October 31, 2022

 

November 25, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

1,214

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

11,435

 

November 16, 2022

 

November 30, 2022

 

December 27, 2022

 

 

 

0.1439

 

 

 

 

1,473

 

 

 

 

0.1553

 

 

 

 

13

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,174

 

December 15, 2022

 

December 30, 2022

 

January 27, 2023

 

 

 

0.1433

 

 

 

 

1,552

 

 

 

 

0.1551

 

 

 

 

16

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,395

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

The Company has adopted a distribution reinvestment plan, pursuant to which the Company will reinvest all cash dividends declared by the Board on behalf of our shareholders who do not elect to receive their dividends in cash as provided below. As a result, if the Board authorizes, and the Company declares, a cash dividend or other distribution, then shareholders who have not opted out of our distribution reinvestment plan will have their cash distributions automatically reinvested in additional shares as described below, rather than receiving the cash dividend or other distribution. Distributions on fractional shares will be credited to each participating shareholder’s account to three decimal places.

 

68


Table of Contents

 

Sources of distributions, other than net investment income and realized gains on a U.S. GAAP basis, include required adjustments to U.S. GAAP net investment income in the current period to determine taxable income available for distributions. The following table reflects the sources of cash distributions on a U.S. GAAP basis that the Company has declared on its shares of common stock during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Class S

 

 

Class D

 

 

Class I

 

Source of Distribution

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

Net investment income

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

Net realized gains

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Distributions in excess of net investment income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

 

To maintain our RIC status, we must distribute at least 90% of our ordinary income and realized net short-term capital gains in excess of realized net long-term capital losses, if any, out of the assets legally available for distribution. Although we currently intend to distribute realized net capital gains (i.e., net long-term capital gains in excess of short-term capital losses), if any, at least annually, out of the assets legally available for such distributions, we may in the future decide to retain such capital gains for investments.

We may not be able to achieve operating results that will allow us to make distributions at a specific level or to increase the amount of these distributions from time to time. In addition, due to the asset coverage test applicable to us as a BDC, we may in the future be limited in our ability to make distributions. Also, our Senior Secured Facility and SPV Financing Facilities may limit our ability to declare distributions if we default under certain provisions or fail to satisfy certain other conditions. If we do not distribute a certain percentage of our income annually, we may suffer adverse tax consequences, including possible loss of the tax benefits available to us as a RIC. In addition, in accordance with GAAP and tax regulations, we include in income certain amounts that we have not yet received in cash, such as contractual PIK, which represents contractual interest added to the loan balance that becomes due at the end of the loan term, or the accrual of original issue or market discount. Since we may recognize income before or without receiving cash representing such income, we may not be able to meet the requirement to distribute at least 90% of our investment company taxable income to obtain tax benefits as a RIC. With respect to the distributions to stockholders, income from origination, structuring, closing, commitment and other upfront fees associated with investments in portfolio companies is treated as taxable income and accordingly, distributed to stockholders.

Share Repurchase Program

At the discretion of our Board of Trustees, the Company has commenced a share repurchase program in which it has the ability to repurchase the Company’s common shares outstanding as of the close of the previous calendar quarter. The Board of Trustees may amend or suspend the share repurchase program if in its reasonable judgment it deems such action to be in the Company’s best interest and the best interest of our shareholders. As a result, share repurchases may not be available each quarter. Should the Board of Trustees suspend the share repurchase program, the Board of Trustees will consider whether the continued suspension of the program is in the best interests of the Company and shareholders on a quarterly basis. The Company intends to conduct such repurchase offers in accordance with the requirements of Rule 13e-4 promulgated under the Exchange Act and the 1940 Act. All shares purchased by the Company pursuant to the terms of each tender offer will be retired and thereafter will be authorized and unissued shares.

Under the share repurchase plan, to the extent the Company offers to repurchase shares in any particular quarter, it is expected to repurchase shares pursuant to tender offers on or around the last business day of that quarter using a purchase price equal to the NAV per share as of the last calendar day of the applicable quarter, except that shares that have not been outstanding for at least one year will be repurchased at 98% of such NAV (the "Early Repurchase Deduction"). The one-year holding period is measured as of the subscription closing date immediately following the prospective repurchase date. The Early Repurchase Deduction may be waived in the case of repurchase requests arising from the death, divorce or qualified disability of the holder. The Early Repurchase Deduction will be retained by the Company for the benefit of remaining shareholders.

Equity

On July 22, 2021, an affiliate of the Adviser purchased 2,000 shares of the Company’s common shares of beneficial interest at $25.00 per share.

As of January 7, 2022, the Company had satisfied the minimum offering requirement, and the Company’s Board of Trustees had authorized the release of proceeds from escrow. As of such date, the Company issued and sold 26,258,912 shares (consisting entirely of Class I shares; no Class S or Class D shares were issued or sold as of such date), and the escrow agent released net proceeds of approximately $657 million to the Company as payment for such shares. Apollo and its employees, including the Company’s executive officers, owned approximately $3 million of shares as of January 7, 2022.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Contractual Obligations

We have entered into the Advisory Agreement with the Adviser to provide us with investment advisory services and the Administration Agreement with the Administrator to provide us with administrative services. We have also entered into an Expense Support Agreement with the Adviser to provide us with support with respect to certain expenses and subject to reimbursement. Payments for investment advisory services under the Advisory Agreements, reimbursements under the Administration Agreement and support and reimbursements under the Expense Support Agreement are described in “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 3. Fees, Expenses, Agreements and Related Party Transactions.”

We intend to establish one or more credit facilities or enter into other financing arrangements to facilitate investments and the timely payment of our expenses. It is anticipated that any such credit facilities will bear interest at floating rates at to-be-determined spreads over LIBOR or an alternative reference rate. We cannot assure shareholders that we will be able to enter into a credit facility on favorable terms or at all. In connection with a credit facility or other borrowings, lenders may require us to pledge assets, commitments and/or drawdowns (and the ability to enforce the payment thereof) and may ask to comply with positive or negative covenants that could have an effect on our operations.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The Adviser has agreed to bear all expenses incurred prior to us breaking escrow for the offering, including our organization and offering expenses, through the date on which we break escrow for the initial offering of its common shares. We will be obligated to reimburse the Adviser for such advanced expenses upon breaking escrow for the offering. The total organization and offering costs incurred through December 31, 2022 were $2.9 million.

We entered into a warehousing transaction (the “Warehousing Transaction”) whereby we agreed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase certain assets from parties unaffiliated with the Adviser. The warehousing transaction, i.e. the Facility Agreement, was designed to assist us in deploying capital upon receipt of subscriptions, and related primarily to originated or anchor investments in middle market loans. For additional information see “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 8. Commitment and Contingencies.”

From time to time, we may become a party to certain legal proceedings incidental to the normal course of our business. At December 31, 2022, management is not aware of any pending or threatened litigation.

Related-Party Transactions

We entered into a number of business relationships with affiliated or related parties, including the following:

Investment Advisory Agreement;
Administration Agreement
Intermediary Manager Agreement; and
Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement.

In addition to the aforementioned agreements, we, our Adviser and certain of our Adviser’s affiliates have been granted exemptive relief by the SEC to co-invest with other funds managed by our Adviser or its affiliates in a manner consistent with our investment objective, positions, policies, strategies and restrictions as well as regulatory requirements and other pertinent factors. See “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 3. Fees, Expenses, Agreements and Related Party Transactions.”

Recent Developments

See “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data — Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 10. Subsequent Events” for a summary of recent developments.

Critical Accounting Policies

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses. Changes in the economic environment, financial markets, and any other parameters used in determining such estimates could cause actual results to differ. Our critical accounting policies should be read in connection with our risk factors described in “Item 1A. Risk Factors”. See “Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements—Note 2. Significant Accounting Policies.”

70


Table of Contents

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

We are subject to financial market risks, including changes in interest rates and the valuations of our investment portfolio. Uncertainty with respect to the economic effects of rising interest rates in response to inflation, the war in Russia and Ukraine and the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic introduced significant volatility in the financial markets, and the effects of this volatility has materially impacted and could continue to materially impact our market risks, including those listed below. For additional information concerning potential impact on our business and our operating results, see Part II - Other information, Item 1A. Risk Factors.

Investment Valuation Risk

Because there is not a readily available market value for most of the investments in our portfolio, we value most of our portfolio investments at fair value as determined in good faith by our Board of Trustees based on, among other things, the input of our management and audit committee and independent valuation firms that have been engaged at the direction of our Board of Trustees to assist in the valuation of each portfolio investment without a readily available market quotation (with certain de minimis exceptions). Due to the inherent uncertainty of determining the fair value of investments that do not have a readily available market value, the fair value of our investments may fluctuate from period to period. Additionally, the fair value of our investments may differ significantly from the values that would have been used had a ready market existed for such investments and may differ materially from the values that we may ultimately realize. Further, such investments are generally subject to legal and other restrictions on resale or otherwise are less liquid than publicly traded securities. If we were required to liquidate a portfolio investment in a forced or liquidation sale, we could realize significantly less than the value at which we have recorded it. In addition, changes in the market environment and other events that may occur over the life of the investments may cause the gains or losses ultimately realized on these investments to be different than the unrealized gains or losses reflected in the valuations currently assigned. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies” and “—Fair Value Measurements” as well as Notes 2 and 4 to our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2022, for more information relating to our investment valuation.

Interest Rate Risk

Interest rate sensitivity refers to the change in our earnings that may result from changes in the level of interest rates. Because we fund a portion of our investments with borrowings, our net investment income is affected by the difference between the rate at which we invest and the rate at which we borrow. As a result, there can be no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates will not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income.

As of December 31, 2022, 99% of our debt portfolio investments bore interest at variable rates, which generally are SOFR based (or based on an equivalent applicable currency rate) and typically have durations of one to six months after which they reset to current market interest rates, and substantially all are subject to certain floors. Our Senior Secured Facility and SPV Financing Facilities bear interest at SOFR rates with no interest rate floor. Our Unsecured Notes, which bear interest at fixed rates, are hedged by entering into fixed to floating interest rate swaps, in order to align the interest rates of our liabilities in our investment portfolio. As of December 31, 2022, all non-U.S. dollar LIBOR publications have been phased out. The phase out of a majority of the U.S. dollar publications is delayed until June 30, 2023. Potential changes, or uncertainty related to such potential changes, may adversely affect the market for LIBOR-based securities, including our portfolio of LIBOR-indexed, floating-rate debt securities, or the cost of our borrowings. Please see “Item 2. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations— Critical Accounting Policies". Uncertainty relating to the LIBOR calculation process may adversely affect the value of our portfolio of the LIBOR-indexed, floating-rate debt securities in our portfolio or the cost of our borrowings.

We regularly measure our exposure to interest rate risk. We assess interest rate risk and manage our interest rate exposure on an ongoing basis by comparing our interest rate sensitive assets to our interest rate sensitive liabilities. Based on that review, we determine whether or not any hedging transactions are necessary to mitigate exposure to changes in interest rates.

The following table shows the estimated annual impact on net investment income of base rate changes in interest rates (considering interest rate flows for variable rate instruments) to our loan portfolio and outstanding debt as of December 31, 2022, assuming no changes in our investment and borrowing structure:

 

Basis Point Change

 

Net Investment Income

 

 

Net Investment Income Per Share

 

(in millions)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Up 200 basis points

 

$

 

41.4

 

 

$

 

0.446

 

Up 100 basis points

 

 

 

20.7

 

 

 

 

0.223

 

Up 50 basis points

 

 

 

10.4

 

 

 

 

0.111

 

Down 50 basis points

 

 

 

(10.4

)

 

 

 

(0.111

)

Down 100 basis points

 

 

 

(20.7

)

 

 

 

(0.223

)

 

We may hedge against interest rate fluctuations from time-to-time by using standard hedging instruments such as futures, options and forward contracts subject to the requirements of the 1940 Act and applicable commodities laws. While hedging activities may insulate us against adverse changes in interest rates, they may also limit our ability to participate in the benefits of lower interest rates with respect to our portfolio of investments.

71


Table of Contents

 

Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PCAOB ID: 34)

73

Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities

75

Consolidated Statement of Operations

76

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Net Assets

77

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

78

Consolidated Schedule of Investments

79

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

100

 

72


Table of Contents

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the shareholders and the Board of Trustees of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC:

 

Opinion on the Financial Statements

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statement of assets and liabilities of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC and subsidiaries (the "Company"), as of December 31, 2022 and 2021, including the consolidated schedule of investments as of December 31, 2022, and the related consolidated statement of operations, changes in net assets, cash flows, and the financial highlights for the year ended December 31, 2022, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the "financial statements"). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, and the results of their operations, cash flows and financial highlights for the year ended December 31, 2022, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

Basis for Opinion

 

This financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's financial statements based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audit, we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.

 

Our audit included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audit also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

Critical Audit Matter

 

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current-period audit of the financial statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

 

Fair Value of Investments — Refer to Notes 2 and 4 to the financial statements

 

Critical Audit Matter Description

 

The Company held investments fair valued under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These investments include debt securities that consider a combination of multiple levels of market and asset specific inputs. The valuation techniques used in estimating the fair value of these investments vary and certain significant inputs used, including the discount rate, were unobservable. The fair value of the Company’s investments was $4.31 billion as of December 31, 2022.

 

We identified the valuation of investments as a critical audit matter because of the judgments necessary for management to select valuation techniques and to use significant unobservable inputs to estimate the fair value. This required a high degree of auditor judgement and extensive audit effort, including the need to involve fair value specialists, for certain investments, who possess significant valuation experience to evaluate the appropriateness of the valuation techniques and the significant unobservable inputs used when performing procedures to audit management’s estimate of fair value of investments.

 

 

73


Table of Contents

 

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

 

Our audit procedures related to the valuation of investments included the following, among other factors:

1.
We tested the design and implementation of controls over management’s valuation of investments, including those related to significant unobservable inputs.
2.
We evaluated and tested the related significant unobservable inputs by comparing these inputs to external sources. For a selected sample of investments, we evaluated management’s ability to estimate fair value by comparing management’s historical estimates to subsequent transactions, taking into account changes in market or investment specific conditions, where applicable.
3.
For a selected sample of investments, we performed procedures with the assistance of our fair value specialists to evaluate significant unobservable inputs and assumptions utilized.

 

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

 

New York, New York

March 16, 2023

 

We have served as the Company's auditor since 2021.


 

74


Table of Contents

 

Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

 

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

December 31, 2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investments at fair value:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments (cost —$4,427,510 and $0 at December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, respectively)

 

$

 

4,308,892

 

 

$

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

 

 

47,322

 

 

 

 

50

 

Foreign currencies (cost — $4,312 and $0 at December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, respectively)

 

 

 

4,336

 

 

 

 

 

Receivable for investments sold

 

 

 

107,868

 

 

 

 

 

Interest receivable

 

 

 

27,753

 

 

 

 

 

Expense reimbursement receivable

 

 

 

4,433

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized appreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

 

249

 

 

 

 

 

Other assets

 

 

 

5,367

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

 

4,506,220

 

 

$

 

50

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Debt (net of deferred financing costs of $20,508)

 

$

 

2,172,620

 

 

$

 

 

Payable for investments purchased

 

 

 

88,788

 

 

 

 

 

Payable for share repurchases (Note 7)

 

 

 

40,854

 

 

 

 

 

Distributions payable

 

 

 

14,964

 

 

 

 

 

Interest payable

 

 

 

8,611

 

 

 

 

 

Management and performance-based incentive fees payable

 

 

 

10,451

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued administrative services expense payable

 

 

 

2,101

 

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

 

 

 

12,898

 

 

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

 

$

 

2,351,287

 

 

$

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Net Assets

 

$

 

2,154,933

 

 

$

 

50

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common shares, $0.01 par value (92,877,753 and 2,000 shares issued and outstanding, respectively)

 

$

 

929

 

 

$

 

 

Capital in excess of par value

 

 

 

2,270,655

 

 

 

 

50

 

Accumulated distributed earnings (losses)

 

 

 

(116,651

)

 

 

 

 

Total Net Assets

 

$

 

2,154,933

 

 

$

 

50

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net Asset Value Per Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class S Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net assets

 

$

 

251,223

 

 

$

 

 

Common shares outstanding ($0.01 par value, unlimited shares authorized)

 

 

 

10,827,739

 

 

 

 

 

Net asset value per share

 

$

 

23.20

 

 

$

 

 

Class D Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net assets

 

$

 

2,481

 

 

$

 

 

Common shares outstanding ($0.01 par value, unlimited shares authorized)

 

 

 

106,943

 

 

 

 

 

Net asset value per share

 

$

 

23.20

 

 

$

 

 

Class I Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net assets

 

$

 

1,901,229

 

 

$

 

50

 

Common shares outstanding ($0.01 par value, unlimited shares authorized)

 

 

 

81,943,071

 

 

 

 

2,000

 

Net asset value per share

 

$

 

23.20

 

 

$

 

25.00

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

75


Table of Contents

 

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

 

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Investment Income

 

 

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments:

 

 

 

Interest income

$

 

236,005

 

Payment-in-kind interest income

 

 

5,467

 

Dividend income

 

 

15

 

Other income

 

 

10,814

 

Total Investment Income

$

 

252,301

 

Operating Expenses

 

 

 

Management fees

$

 

20,929

 

Performance-based incentive fees

 

 

18,760

 

Interest and other debt expenses

 

 

69,650

 

Organization costs

 

 

934

 

Offering costs

 

 

1,968

 

Trustees' fees

 

 

439

 

Shareholder servicing fees

 

 

1,174

 

Administrative service expenses

 

 

2,101

 

Other general and administrative expenses

 

 

6,639

 

Total expenses

 

 

122,594

 

Management and performance-based incentive fees waived

 

 

(13,723

)

Expense support

 

 

(4,433

)

Net Expenses

$

 

104,438

 

Net Investment Income

$

 

147,863

 

Net Realized and Change in Unrealized Gains (Losses)

 

 

 

Net realized gains (losses):

 

 

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments

$

 

(19,411

)

Foreign currency transactions

 

 

4,028

 

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

489

 

Net realized gains (losses)

 

 

(14,894

)

Net change in unrealized gains (losses):

 

 

 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments

 

 

(118,617

)

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

249

 

Foreign currency translations

 

 

(11,840

)

Net unrealized gains (losses)

 

 

(130,208

)

Net Realized and Change in Unrealized Gains (Losses)

$

 

(145,102

)

Net Increase (Decrease) in Net Assets Resulting from Operations

$

 

2,761

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

76


Table of Contents

 

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS

 

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Operations

 

 

 

Net investment income

$

 

147,863

 

Net realized gains (losses)

 

 

(14,894

)

Net change in unrealized gains (losses)

 

 

(130,208

)

Net Increase (Decrease) in Net Assets Resulting from Operations

$

 

2,761

 

 

 

 

 

Distributions to Shareholders

 

 

 

Class S

$

 

(9,121

)

Class D

 

 

(54

)

Class I

 

 

(112,366

)

Net Decrease in Net Assets Resulting from Distributions to Shareholders

$

 

(121,541

)

 

 

 

 

Capital Share Transactions

 

 

 

Class S:

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

$

 

254,686

 

Repurchase of common shares, net of early repurchase deduction

 

 

(241

)

Distributions reinvested

 

 

4,463

 

Class D:

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

 

 

2,495

 

Repurchase of common shares, net of early repurchase deduction

 

 

 

Distributions reinvested

 

 

3

 

Class I:

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

 

 

2,012,264

 

Repurchase of common shares, net of early repurchase deduction

 

 

(48,134

)

Distributions reinvested

 

 

48,127

 

Net Increase (Decrease) from Capital Share Transactions

$

 

2,273,663

 

 

 

 

 

Net Assets

 

 

 

Total increase (decrease) in net assets during the period

 

 

2,154,883

 

Net Assets, beginning of period

 

 

50

 

Net Assets at End of Period

$

 

2,154,933

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

77


Table of Contents

 

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

 

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2022

 

Operating Activities

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in net assets resulting from operations

 

$

 

2,761

 

Net realized (gain) loss on investments

 

 

 

19,411

 

Net change in unrealized (gains) losses on investments

 

 

 

118,617

 

Net unrealized (appreciation) depreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

 

(249

)

Net unrealized (appreciation) depreciation on translation of assets and liabilities in foreign currencies

 

 

 

11,840

 

Payment-in-kind interest capitalized

 

 

 

(5,333

)

Net accretion of discount and amortization of premium

 

 

 

(5,632

)

Amortization of deferred financing costs

 

 

 

3,907

 

Amortization of offering costs

 

 

 

1,968

 

Purchases of investments

 

 

 

(6,606,772

)

Proceeds from sale of investments and principal repayments

 

 

 

2,170,237

 

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

Interest receivable

 

 

 

(27,753

)

Receivable for investments sold

 

 

 

(107,868

)

Expense reimbursement receivable

 

 

 

(4,433

)

Other assets

 

 

 

(5,367

)

Payable for investments purchased

 

 

 

88,788

 

Management and performance-based incentive fees payable

 

 

 

10,451

 

Accrued administrative services expense payable

 

 

 

2,101

 

Interest payable

 

 

 

8,611

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

 

 

 

12,898

 

Net Cash Used in/Provided by Operating Activities

 

$

 

(4,311,817

)

 

 

 

 

 

Financing Activities

 

 

 

 

Issuances of debt

 

$

 

4,330,139

 

Payments of debt

 

 

 

(2,148,292

)

Financing costs paid and deferred

 

 

 

(24,419

)

Proceeds from issuance of common shares

 

 

 

2,269,445

 

Repurchased shares, net of early repurchase deduction paid

 

 

 

(7,520

)

Distributions paid

 

 

 

(53,984

)

Offering costs paid and deferred

 

 

 

(1,968

)

Net Cash Used in/Provided by Financing Activities

 

$

 

4,363,401

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash, Cash Equivalents and Foreign Currencies

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents and foreign currencies during the period

 

$

 

51,584

 

Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

 

 

 

24

 

Cash, cash equivalents and foreign currencies at beginning of period

 

 

 

50

 

Cash, Cash Equivalents and Foreign Currencies at the End of Period

 

$

 

51,658

 

 

 

 

 

 

Supplemental Disclosure and Non-Cash Information

 

 

 

 

Cash interest paid

 

$

 

57,132

 

Distributions payable

 

$

 

14,964

 

Reinvestment of distributions during the period

 

$

 

52,593

 

PIK income

 

$

 

5,467

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

78


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Aerospace & Defense

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

MRO Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

MRO Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+625, 0.50% Floor

 

12/18/2028

 

 $

 

5,000

 

 

 $

 

5,000

 

 

 $

 

4,975

 

 

(4)(8)(14)

Vertex Aerospace Services Corp.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vertex Aerospace Services Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+350, 0.75% Floor

 

12/6/2028

 

 

 

6,605

 

 

 

 

6,620

 

 

 

 

6,499

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Aerospace & Defense

 

 

 $

 

11,620

 

 

 $

 

11,474

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset Backed Securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Roaring Fork III-B, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Roaring Fork III-B, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+540, 0.00% Floor

 

7/16/2026

 

 $

 

48,000

 

 

 $

 

25,721

 

 

 $

 

25,241

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(11)(17)(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.00% Floor

 

7/16/2026

 

 

 

2,000

 

 

 

 

2,000

 

 

 

 

1,963

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Asset Backed Securities

 

 

 $

 

27,721

 

 

 $

 

27,204

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Auto Components

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mavis Tire Express Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mavis Tire Express Services Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+400, 0.75% Floor

 

5/4/2028

 

 $

 

30,613

 

 

 $

 

30,617

 

 

 $

 

29,261

 

 

(17)

Truck Hero, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RealTruck Group, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

1/31/2028

 

 

 

25,243

 

 

 

 

25,065

 

 

 

 

21,772

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Auto Components

 

 

 $

 

55,682

 

 

 $

 

51,033

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Biotechnology

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Azurity Pharmaceuticals, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Azurity Pharmaceuticals, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+600, 0.75% Floor

 

9/20/2027

 

 $

 

37,962

 

 

 $

 

37,036

 

 

 $

 

36,546

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Biotechnology

 

 

 $

 

37,036

 

 

 $

 

36,546

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Building Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cornerstone Building Brands

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cornerstone Building Brands, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+563, 0.50% Floor

 

8/1/2028

 

 $

 

56,525

 

 

 $

 

55,949

 

 

 $

 

53,557

 

 

(17)

Oldcastle Building

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Oscar Acquisitionco, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.50% Floor

 

4/29/2029

 

 

 

15,960

 

 

 

 

15,440

 

 

 

 

15,157

 

 

(17)

US LBM

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LBM Acquisition, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

12/17/2027

 

 

 

43,388

 

 

 

 

43,018

 

 

 

 

37,856

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Building Products

 

 

 $

 

114,407

 

 

 $

 

106,570

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Capital Markets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arrowhead Engineered Products Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arrowhead Holdco Company

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.75% Floor

 

8/31/2028

 

 $

 

9,925

 

 

 $

 

9,925

 

 

 $

 

9,677

 

 

(4)(17)

Edelman Financial Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Edelman Financial Engines Centre, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+350, 0.75% Floor

 

4/7/2028

 

 

 

33,756

 

 

 

 

33,736

 

 

 

 

31,520

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Capital Markets

 

 

 $

 

43,661

 

 

 $

 

41,197

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Chemicals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AOC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LSF11 A5 HoldCo LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+350, 0.50% Floor

 

10/15/2028

 

 $

 

20,852

 

 

 $

 

20,858

 

 

 $

 

20,192

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Heubach

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SK Neptune Husky Group Sarl

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+500, 0.50% Floor

 

1/3/2029

 

 

 

9,540

 

 

 

 

9,491

 

 

 

 

7,620

 

 

(8)(17)

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

79


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Solenis

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Olympus Water US Holding Corporation

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.50% Floor

 

11/9/2028

 

 

 

13,476

 

 

 

 

13,277

 

 

 

 

13,106

 

 

(10)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.50% Floor

 

11/9/2028

 

 

 

13,144

 

 

 

 

12,937

 

 

 

 

12,654

 

 

(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

7.13%

 

10/1/2027

 

 

 

3,000

 

 

 

 

2,972

 

 

 

 

2,871

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

29,186

 

 

 

 

28,631

 

 

 

W.R. Grace Holdings LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

W.R. Grace Holdings LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.50% Floor

 

9/22/2028

 

 

 

5,982

 

 

 

 

5,978

 

 

 

 

5,881

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Chemicals

 

 

 $

 

65,513

 

 

 $

 

62,324

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial Services & Supplies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allied Universal

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allied Universal Holdco LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+375, 0.50% Floor

 

5/12/2028

 

 $

 

15,783

 

 

 $

 

15,260

 

 

 $

 

15,019

 

 

(16)

Beeline

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

IQN Holding Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.75% Floor

 

5/2/2029

 

 

 

61,877

 

 

 

 

61,301

 

 

 

 

60,318

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

5/2/2029

 

 

 

12,834

 

 

 

 

962

 

 

 

 

646

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

5/2/2028

 

 

 

5,134

 

 

 

 

(46

)

 

 

 

(128

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

62,217

 

 

 

 

60,836

 

 

 

Calypso

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AxiomSL Group, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+575, 1.00% Floor

 

12/3/2027

 

 

 

14,599

 

 

 

 

14,241

 

 

 

 

14,599

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+600, 1.00% Floor

 

12/3/2027

 

 

 

956

 

 

 

 

(12

)

 

 

 

 

 

(4)(11)(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+600, 1.00% Floor

 

12/3/2025

 

 

 

1,043

 

 

 

 

(32

)

 

 

 

(10

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

14,197

 

 

 

 

14,589

 

 

 

Garda World Security Corporation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Garda World Security Corporation

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+425, 0.00% Floor

 

10/30/2026

 

 

 

24,543

 

 

 

 

24,512

 

 

 

 

23,950

 

 

(8)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+425, 0.00% Floor

 

2/1/2029

 

 

 

10,430

 

 

 

 

10,336

 

 

 

 

10,078

 

 

(8)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

34,848

 

 

 

 

34,028

 

 

 

HKA

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mount Olympus Bidco Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.50% Floor

 

8/9/2029

 

 

 

18,465

 

 

 

 

17,233

 

 

 

 

17,173

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(18)(26)

LABL, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LABL, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+500, 0.50% Floor

 

10/29/2028

 

 

 

33,640

 

 

 

 

33,794

 

 

 

 

32,042

 

 

(14)

Liberty Tire Recycling

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LTR Intermediate Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+450, 1.00% Floor

 

5/5/2028

 

 

 

9,122

 

 

 

 

9,076

 

 

 

 

8,324

 

 

(14)

Profile Products LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profile Products LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

11/12/2027

 

 

 

4,963

 

 

 

 

4,963

 

 

 

 

4,963

 

 

(4)(14)

Public Partnerships, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PPL Acquisition LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+625, 0.75% Floor

 

7/1/2028

 

 

 

8,836

 

 

 

 

8,621

 

 

 

 

8,659

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+625, 0.75% Floor

 

7/1/2028

 

 

 

1,000

 

 

 

 

(18

)

 

 

 

(20

)

 

(4)(5)(9)
(11)(26)

PPL Equity LP

 

Preferred Equity - Preferred Stocks

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

50,000 Shares

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

(4)(9)

 

 

Preferred Equity - Equity Unit

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

50,000 Shares

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

6

 

 

(4)(9)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,703

 

 

 

 

8,695

 

 

 

R. R. Donnelley

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

R. R. Donnelley & Sons Company

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+625, 0.50% Floor

 

11/1/2026

 

 

 

168,271

 

 

 

 

166,842

 

 

 

 

165,747

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

80


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

SAVATREE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CI (Quercus) Intermediate Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+525, 0.75% Floor

 

10/12/2028

 

 

 

17,576

 

 

 

 

15,883

 

 

 

 

15,814

 

 

(4)(11)(14)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/12/2028

 

 

 

2,273

 

 

 

 

(49

)

 

 

 

(43

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,834

 

 

 

 

15,771

 

 

 

Tranzonic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TZ Buyer LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

8/14/2028

 

 

 

9,325

 

 

 

 

7,336

 

 

 

 

7,324

 

 

(4)(9)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

8/14/2028

 

 

 

606

 

 

 

 

(14

)

 

 

 

(15

)

 

(4)(5)(9)
(11)(26)

TZ Parent LLC

 

Common Equity - Equity Unit

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

50 Shares

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

(4)(9)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,372

 

 

 

 

7,359

 

 

 

TravelCenters of America Inc

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TravelCenters of America Inc

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+600, 1.00% Floor

 

12/14/2027

 

 

 

19,600

 

 

 

 

19,779

 

 

 

 

19,796

 

 

(4)(8)(14)

United Site Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PECF USS Intermediate Holding III Corporation

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+425, 0.50% Floor

 

12/15/2028

 

 

 

25,245

 

 

 

 

25,336

 

 

 

 

21,101

 

 

(14)

Version 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment Company 24 Bidco Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SONIA+575, 0.00% Floor

 

7/11/2029

 

 £

 

6,559

 

 

 

 

7,615

 

 

 

 

7,692

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(19)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+575, 0.00% Floor

 

7/11/2029

 

 €

 

5,406

 

 

 

 

3,920

 

 

 

 

4,140

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(22)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,535

 

 

 

 

11,832

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Commercial Services & Supplies

 

 

 $

 

446,989

 

 

 $

 

437,275

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Communications Equipment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mitel Networks

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

MLN US Holdco LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+670, 1.00% Floor

 

10/18/2027

 

 $

 

38,156

 

 

 $

 

39,744

 

 

 $

 

33,673

 

 

(4)(8)(16)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+644, 1.00% Floor

 

10/18/2027

 

 

 

6,395

 

 

 

 

6,163

 

 

 

 

6,158

 

 

(4)(8)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

45,907

 

 

 

 

39,831

 

 

 

Ufinet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Zacapa S.a r.l.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+425, 0.50% Floor

 

3/22/2029

 

 

 

20,844

 

 

 

 

20,761

 

 

 

 

20,076

 

 

(8)(18)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Communications Equipment

 

 

 $

 

66,668

 

 

 $

 

59,907

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction & Engineering

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trench Plate Rental Co.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trench Plate Rental Co.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

12/3/2026

 

 $

 

45,227

 

 

 $

 

44,574

 

 

 $

 

44,549

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

12/3/2026

 

 

 

4,545

 

 

 

 

1,146

 

 

 

 

1,136

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(17)(26)

Trench Safety Solutions Holdings, LLC

 

Common Equity - Equity Unit

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

331 Shares

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

51

 

 

(4)(9)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Construction & Engineering

 

 

 $

 

45,770

 

 

 $

 

45,736

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consumer Finance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

American Express GBT

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

GBT Group Services B.V.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+650, 1.00% Floor

 

12/2/2026

 

 $

 

25,000

 

 

 $

 

25,231

 

 

 $

 

24,906

 

 

(8)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Consumer Finance

 

 

 $

 

25,231

 

 

 $

 

24,906

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Containers & Packaging

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Berlin Packaging L.L.C.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Berlin Packaging L.L.C.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.50% Floor

 

3/11/2028

 

 $

 

34,648

 

 

 $

 

34,646

 

 

 $

 

33,403

 

 

(14)

BOX Partners

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bp Purchaser LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

12/11/2028

 

 

 

7,444

 

 

 

 

7,444

 

 

 

 

7,444

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

81


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Tekni-Plex

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trident TPI Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+400, 0.50% Floor

 

9/15/2028

 

 

 

35,907

 

 

 

 

35,951

 

 

 

 

34,576

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Containers & Packaging

 

 

 $

 

78,041

 

 

 $

 

75,423

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Diversified Consumer Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2U

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2U, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+575, 0.75% Floor

 

12/30/2024

 

 $

 

24,625

 

 

 $

 

24,226

 

 

 $

 

24,502

 

 

(4)(8)(14)

Houghton Mifflin

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Houghton Mifflin Harcourt Company

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.50% Floor

 

4/9/2029

 

 

 

49,882

 

 

 

 

47,586

 

 

 

 

47,575

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Diversified Consumer Services

 

 

 $

 

71,812

 

 

 $

 

72,077

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Diversified Financial Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Acuity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trident Bidco Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.00% Floor

 

6/7/2029

 

 $

 

61,619

 

 

 $

 

60,358

 

 

 $

 

60,079

 

 

(4)(8)(9)

Apex Group Treasury LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Apex Group Treasury LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+500, 0.50% Floor

 

7/27/2028

 

 

 

12,500

 

 

 

 

11,751

 

 

 

 

12,188

 

 

(8)(16)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Diversified Financial Services

 

 

 $

 

72,109

 

 

 $

 

72,267

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Diversified Telecommunication Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ORBCOMM, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ORBCOMM, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+425, 0.75% Floor

 

9/1/2028

 

 $

 

4,005

 

 

 $

 

4,015

 

 

 $

 

3,441

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Diversified Telecommunication Services

 

 

 $

 

4,015

 

 

 $

 

3,441

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Electric Utilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Congruex Group LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Congruex Group LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.75% Floor

 

5/3/2029

 

 $

 

29,850

 

 

 $

 

29,152

 

 

 $

 

29,178

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Electric Utilities

 

 

 $

 

29,152

 

 

 $

 

29,178

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Electrical Equipment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Antylia Scientific

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CPI Buyer, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

11/1/2028

 

 $

 

41,407

 

 

 $

 

33,342

 

 

 $

 

32,928

 

 

(4)(14)(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/30/2026

 

 

 

3,346

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(33

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Electrical Equipment

 

 

 $

 

33,342

 

 

 $

 

32,895

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Entertainment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Chernin Entertainment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Jewel Purchaser, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.50% Floor

 

7/1/2027

 

 $

 

92,831

 

 

 $

 

90,636

 

 

 $

 

91,439

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Entertainment

 

 

 $

 

90,636

 

 

 $

 

91,439

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Oak View Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

OVG Business Services, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+625, 1.00% Floor

 

11/20/2028

 

 $

 

7,444

 

 

 $

 

7,444

 

 

 $

 

7,332

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Equity Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

 

 

 $

 

7,444

 

 

 $

 

7,332

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financing

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Transportation Insight

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TI Intermediate Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+425, 1.00% Floor

 

12/18/2024

 

 $

 

7,443

 

 

 $

 

7,443

 

 

 $

 

7,369

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Financing

 

 

 $

 

7,443

 

 

 $

 

7,369

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

82


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Food & Staples Retailing

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Rise and Brill

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ultimate Baked Goods Midco LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+650, 1.00% Floor

 

8/13/2027

 

 $

 

8,300

 

 

 $

 

8,062

 

 

 $

 

8,019

 

 

(4)(9)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+650, 1.00% Floor

 

8/13/2027

 

 

 

1,016

 

 

 

 

226

 

 

 

 

232

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(14)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Food & Staples Retailing

 

 

 $

 

8,288

 

 

 $

 

8,251

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Food Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tate & Lyle

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Primary Products Finance LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+400, 0.50% Floor

 

4/1/2029

 

 $

 

11,008

 

 

 $

 

11,018

 

 

 $

 

10,853

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Food Products

 

 

 $

 

11,018

 

 

 $

 

10,853

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Health Care Equipment & Supplies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Embecta Corp.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Embecta Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

5.00%

 

2/15/2030

 

 $

 

7,500

 

 

 $

 

6,860

 

 

 $

 

6,319

 

 

 

Treace Medical Concepts, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Treace Medical Concepts, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 1.00% Floor

 

4/1/2027

 

 

 

17,500

 

 

 

 

7,259

 

 

 

 

7,028

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(16)(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+400, 1.00% Floor

 

4/1/2027

 

 

 

1,500

 

 

 

 

200

 

 

 

 

178

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(11)(16)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,459

 

 

 

 

7,206

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Health Care Equipment & Supplies

 

 

 $

 

14,319

 

 

 $

 

13,525

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Health Care Providers & Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advarra Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advarra Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.75% Floor

 

8/24/2029

 

 $

 

200,000

 

 

 $

 

180,135

 

 

 $

 

180,424

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(17)(26)

Affordable Care

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ACI Group Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+450, 0.75% Floor

 

8/2/2028

 

 

 

4,962

 

 

 

 

4,962

 

 

 

 

4,863

 

 

(4)(14)

Athenahealth

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Athenahealth Group Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+350, 0.50% Floor

 

2/15/2029

 

 

 

50,532

 

 

 

 

43,660

 

 

 

 

40,215

 

 

(11)(17)
(26)

CoreTrust

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Coretrust Purchasing Group LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+675, 0.75% Floor

 

10/1/2029

 

 

 

32,526

 

 

 

 

31,575

 

 

 

 

31,551

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+675, 0.75% Floor

 

9/30/2029

 

 

 

4,737

 

 

 

 

(69

)

 

 

 

(142

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+675, 0.75% Floor

 

9/30/2029

 

 

 

4,737

 

 

 

 

(137

)

 

 

 

(142

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

31,369

 

 

 

 

31,267

 

 

 

Dental Care Alliance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

DCA Investment Holding LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

4/3/2028

 

 

 

2,479

 

 

 

 

2,479

 

 

 

 

2,479

 

 

(4)(17)

Eating Recovery Center

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ERC Topco Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

11/10/2028

 

 

 

40,250

 

 

 

 

35,297

 

 

 

 

34,089

 

 

(4)(11)(14)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

11/10/2027

 

 

 

3,195

 

 

 

 

1,970

 

 

 

 

1,843

 

 

(4)(11)(14)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

37,267

 

 

 

 

35,932

 

 

 

Gateway US Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gateway US Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

9/22/2026

 

 

 

89,227

 

 

 

 

84,784

 

 

 

 

84,289

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

9/22/2026

 

 

 

3,402

 

 

 

 

2,824

 

 

 

 

2,797

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

9/22/2026

 

 

 

2,629

 

 

 

 

1,427

 

 

 

 

1,407

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

89,035

 

 

 

 

88,493

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

83


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

84


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Medical Solutions Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Medical Solutions Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+350, 0.50% Floor

 

11/1/2028

 

 

 

8,906

 

 

 

 

8,917

 

 

 

 

8,372

 

 

(14)

Practice Plus Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Practice Plus Group Bidco Limited / Practice Plus Group Holdings Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SONIA+650, 0.50% Floor

 

11/18/2029

 

 £

 

10,000

 

 

 

 

11,562

 

 

 

 

11,757

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(19)

Smile Brands Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Smile Brands Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+475, 1.00% Floor

 

10/12/2024

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,332

 

 

(4)(14)

Thrive Pet Healthcare

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pathway Vet Alliance LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.00% Floor

 

3/31/2027

 

 

 

29,207

 

 

 

 

29,163

 

 

 

 

24,643

 

 

(14)

Tivity Health, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tivity Health, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

6/28/2029

 

 

 

114,713

 

 

 

 

113,066

 

 

 

 

112,992

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Health Care Providers & Services

 

 

 $

 

559,058

 

 

 $

 

548,769

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Health Care Technology

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

eResearchTechnology, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

eResearchTechnology, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+450, 1.00% Floor

 

2/4/2027

 

 $

 

29,636

 

 

 $

 

29,103

 

 

 $

 

26,242

 

 

(14)

Wellsky

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Project Ruby Ultimate Parent Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.75% Floor

 

3/10/2028

 

 

 

53,366

 

 

 

 

51,851

 

 

 

 

51,365

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Health Care Technology

 

 

 $

 

80,954

 

 

 $

 

77,607

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Hotels, Restaurants & Leisure

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fertitta Entertainment LLC/NV

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fertitta Entertainment LLC/NV

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+400, 0.50% Floor

 

1/27/2029

 

 $

 

18,168

 

 

 $

 

18,233

 

 

 $

 

17,313

 

 

(17)

PARS Group LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PARS Group LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+675, 1.50% Floor

 

4/3/2028

 

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

 

8,916

 

 

 

 

8,898

 

 

(4)(9)(16)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Hotels, Restaurants & Leisure

 

 

 $

 

27,149

 

 

 $

 

26,211

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Household Durables

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ergotron

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ergotron Acquisition, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.75% Floor

 

7/6/2028

 

 $

 

9,925

 

 

 $

 

9,739

 

 

 $

 

9,727

 

 

(4)(17)

Ergotron Investments, LLC

 

Common Equity - Equity Unit

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

500 Shares

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

54

 

 

(4)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Household Durables

 

 

 $

 

9,789

 

 

 $

 

9,781

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Household Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advantice Health

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Jazz AH Holdco, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+500, 0.75% Floor

 

4/3/2028

 

 $

 

9,182

 

 

 $

 

7,182

 

 

 $

 

6,901

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+500, 0.75% Floor

 

4/3/2028

 

 

 

800

 

 

 

 

286

 

 

 

 

275

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,468

 

 

 

 

7,176

 

 

 

Vita Global

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vita Global FinCo Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SONIA+700, 0.00% Floor

 

7/6/2027

 

 £

 

17,857

 

 

 

 

24,170

 

 

 

 

21,049

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(19)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Household Products

 

 

 $

 

31,638

 

 

 $

 

28,225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Insurance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alera Group, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alera Group, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

10/2/2028

 

 $

 

39,929

 

 

 $

 

27,438

 

 

 $

 

27,449

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(17)(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

10/2/2028

 

 

 

16,605

 

 

 

 

16,213

 

 

 

 

16,275

 

 

(4)(9)

See notes to consolidated financial statements

85


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

43,651

 

 

 

 

43,724

 

 

 

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Asurion

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asurion, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+325, 0.00% Floor

 

12/23/2026

 

 

 

15,394

 

 

 

 

15,311

 

 

 

 

13,773

 

 

(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+325, 0.00% Floor

 

7/31/2027

 

 

 

11,136

 

 

 

 

11,124

 

 

 

 

9,751

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

26,435

 

 

 

 

23,524

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Howden Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Hyperion Refinance Sarl

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.75% Floor

 

11/12/2027

 

 

 

103,000

 

 

 

 

29,435

 

 

 

 

29,417

 

 

(4)(8)(17)
(26)

Patriot Growth Insurance Services, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Patriot Growth Insurance Services, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/16/2028

 

 

 

32,469

 

 

 

 

32,469

 

 

 

 

32,469

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/16/2028

 

 

 

2,311

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(4)(11)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

32,469

 

 

 

 

32,469

 

 

 

Risk Strategies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RSC Acquisition Inc

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/30/2026

 

 

 

26,982

 

 

 

 

7,725

 

 

 

 

7,611

 

 

(4)(11)(17)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Insurance

 

 

 $

 

139,715

 

 

 $

 

136,745

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Internet & Direct Marketing Retail

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Delivery Hero

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Delivery Hero Finco Germany GmbH

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+575, 0.00% Floor

 

8/12/2027

 

 €

 

79,000

 

 

 $

 

81,919

 

 

 $

 

82,451

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(21)

Delivery Hero SE

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.50% Floor

 

8/12/2027

 

 

 

17,870

 

 

 

 

17,514

 

 

 

 

17,289

 

 

(8)(9)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

99,433

 

 

 

 

99,740

 

 

 

Stamps.com

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Auctane, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+575, 0.75% Floor

 

10/5/2028

 

 

 

32,256

 

 

 

 

31,712

 

 

 

 

32,256

 

 

(4)(9)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Internet & Direct Marketing Retail

 

 

 $

 

131,145

 

 

 $

 

131,996

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

IT Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Anaplan, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Anaplan, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

6/21/2029

 

 $

 

146,692

 

 

 $

 

143,914

 

 

 $

 

143,758

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

6/21/2028

 

 

 

9,073

 

 

 

 

(166

)

 

 

 

(181

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

143,748

 

 

 

 

143,577

 

 

 

Genesys Cloud

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Greeneden U.S. Holdings II, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+400, 0.75% Floor

 

12/1/2027

 

 

 

40,351

 

 

 

 

40,240

 

 

 

 

38,813

 

 

(14)

Peraton Corp.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Peraton Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

2/1/2028

 

 

 

32,599

 

 

 

 

32,573

 

 

 

 

31,852

 

 

(14)

Virtusa

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Virtusa Corporation

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+375, 0.75% Floor

 

2/15/2029

 

 

 

18,547

 

 

 

 

18,385

 

 

 

 

17,968

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total IT Services

 

 

 $

 

234,946

 

 

 $

 

232,210

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Machinery

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charter Next Generation, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charter Next Generation, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

12/1/2027

 

 $

 

14,888

 

 

 $

 

14,898

 

 

 $

 

14,486

 

 

(14)

Pro Mach Group, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pro Mach Group, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+400, 1.00% Floor

 

8/31/2028

 

 

 

31,241

 

 

 

 

31,223

 

 

 

 

30,450

 

 

(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+500, 0.50% Floor

 

8/31/2028

 

 

 

2,514

 

 

 

 

2,388

 

 

 

 

2,438

 

 

(16)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

33,611

 

 

 

 

32,888

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

86


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Safe Fleet Holdings LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Safe Fleet Holdings LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+500, 0.50% Floor

 

2/23/2029

 

 

 

6,468

 

 

 

 

6,280

 

 

 

 

6,370

 

 

(17)

SPX Flow, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SPX Flow, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.50% Floor

 

4/5/2029

 

 

 

9,956

 

 

 

 

9,398

 

 

 

 

9,301

 

 

(17)

 

 

Unsecured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

8.75%

 

4/1/2030

 

 

 

6,255

 

 

 

 

5,973

 

 

 

 

4,941

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,371

 

 

 

 

14,242

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Machinery

 

 

 $

 

70,160

 

 

 $

 

67,986

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Media

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advantage Sales

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advantage Sales & Marketing Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+450, 0.75% Floor

 

10/28/2027

 

 $

 

29,983

 

 

 $

 

30,059

 

 

 $

 

24,886

 

 

(8)(14)

American Media

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accelerate360 Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

2/11/2027

 

 

 

75,777

 

 

 

 

75,777

 

 

 

 

75,398

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

2/11/2027

 

 

 

26,908

 

 

 

 

15,696

 

 

 

 

15,562

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(17)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

91,473

 

 

 

 

90,960

 

 

 

Associations Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Associations Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+400 Cash plus 2.50% PIK

 

7/2/2027

 

 

 

15,225

 

 

 

 

15,087

 

 

 

 

15,073

 

 

(4)(16)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+625 Cash plus 2.50% PIK

 

7/2/2027

 

 

 

979

 

 

 

 

970

 

 

 

 

969

 

 

(4)(16)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,057

 

 

 

 

16,042

 

 

 

Charter Communications

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CCO Holdings LLC / CCO Holdings Capital Corp

 

Unsecured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

4.75%

 

2/1/2032

 

 

 

10,500

 

 

 

 

9,396

 

 

 

 

8,536

 

 

 

Gannett Co., Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gannett Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+500, 0.50% Floor

 

10/15/2026

 

 

 

64,185

 

 

 

 

63,981

 

 

 

 

63,703

 

 

(8)(13)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

6.00%

 

11/1/2026

 

 

 

16,000

 

 

 

 

12,526

 

 

 

 

13,157

 

 

(8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

76,507

 

 

 

 

76,860

 

 

 

Material Holdings, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Material Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 0.75% Floor

 

8/19/2027

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,295

 

 

(4)(16)

McGraw Hill

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

McGraw-Hill Education, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+475, 0.50% Floor

 

7/28/2028

 

 

 

49,874

 

 

 

 

48,645

 

 

 

 

47,068

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Media

 

 

 $

 

279,580

 

 

 $

 

271,647

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Paper & Forest Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ahlstrom-Munksjö

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ahlstrom-Munksjo Holding 3 Oy

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

2/4/2028

 

 $

 

22,459

 

 

 $

 

22,448

 

 

 $

 

21,561

 

 

(8)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Paper & Forest Products

 

 

 $

 

22,448

 

 

 $

 

21,561

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Greencross

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vermont Aus Pty Ltd

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

3/23/2028

 

 $

 

103,039

 

 

 $

 

100,728

 

 

 $

 

98,917

 

 

(4)(8)(9)
(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

BBSW+575, 0.75% Floor

 

3/23/2028

 

 A$

 

9,925

 

 

 

 

7,196

 

 

 

 

6,521

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(20)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

107,924

 

 

 

 

105,438

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

87


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Heat Makes Sense

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Heat Makes Sense Shared Services, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

7/1/2029

 

 

 

8,313

 

 

 

 

8,151

 

 

 

 

8,146

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

7/1/2028

 

 

 

1,617

 

 

 

 

293

 

 

 

 

291

 

 

(4)(9)(11)
(17)(26)

Ishtar Co-Invest-B LP

 

Common Equity - Stock

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

38,889 Shares

 

 

 

 

39

 

 

 

 

39

 

 

(4)(9)

Oshun Co-Invest-B LP

 

Common Equity - Stock

 

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

 

11,111 Shares

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

(4)(9)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,494

 

 

 

 

8,487

 

 

 

VFS Global

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Speed Midco 3 S.A R.L.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+700, 0.00% Floor

 

5/16/2029

 

 €

 

111,776

 

 

 

 

114,128

 

 

 

 

118,155

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(22)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SONIA+750, 0.00% Floor

 

5/16/2029

 

 £

 

22,059

 

 

 

 

26,523

 

 

 

 

26,269

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(9)(19)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

140,651

 

 

 

 

144,424

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Personal Products

 

 

 $

 

257,069

 

 

 $

 

258,349

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pharmaceuticals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bausch Health

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bausch Health Companies Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+525, 0.50% Floor

 

2/1/2027

 

 $

 

41,928

 

 

 $

 

40,167

 

 

 $

 

32,424

 

 

(8)(17)

Galderma

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sunshine Luxembourg VII SARL

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

10/1/2026

 

 

 

16,502

 

 

 

 

16,111

 

 

 

 

15,835

 

 

(8)(15)

KEPRO

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CNSI Holdings, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.50% Floor

 

12/17/2028

 

 

 

36,000

 

 

 

 

34,753

 

 

 

 

34,740

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+650, 0.50% Floor

 

12/17/2027

 

 

 

4,000

 

 

 

 

(138

)

 

 

 

(140

)

 

(4)(5)(9)
(11)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

34,615

 

 

 

 

34,600

 

 

 

Pacira Biosciences, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pacira Biosciences, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+700, 0.75% Floor

 

12/7/2026

 

 

 

2,500

 

 

 

 

2,438

 

 

 

 

2,468

 

 

(8)(10)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Pharmaceuticals

 

 

 $

 

93,331

 

 

 $

 

85,327

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Professional Services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Kroll

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deerfield Dakota Holding, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+375, 1.00% Floor

 

4/9/2027

 

 $

 

27,307

 

 

 $

 

27,323

 

 

 $

 

25,549

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Professional Services

 

 

 $

 

27,323

 

 

 $

 

25,549

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real Estate Management & Development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3Phase Elevator

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Polyphase Elevator Holding Company

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

6/23/2027

 

 $

 

3,474

 

 

 $

 

3,474

 

 

 $

 

3,474

 

 

(4)(16)

Pritchard Industries, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pritchard Industries, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

10/13/2027

 

 

 

6,451

 

 

 

 

6,451

 

 

 

 

6,290

 

 

(4)(18)

WeWork Companies LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

WeWork Companies LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

11/30/2023

 

 

 

100,000

 

 

 

 

99,554

 

 

 

 

99,500

 

 

(4)(8)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Real Estate Management & Development

 

 

 $

 

109,479

 

 

 $

 

109,264

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Road & Rail

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PODS, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PODS, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+300, 0.75% Floor

 

3/31/2028

 

 $

 

10,596

 

 

 $

 

10,606

 

 

 $

 

10,027

 

 

(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Road & Rail

 

 

 $

 

10,606

 

 

 $

 

10,027

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

88


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Software

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Access Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Armstrong Bidco Limited

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SONIA+525, 0.00% Floor

 

6/28/2029

 

 £

 

42,000

 

 

 $

 

46,163

 

 

 $

 

46,116

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(11)(19)(26)

Avalara, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Avalara, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+725, 0.75% Floor

 

10/19/2028

 

 

 

136,364

 

 

 

 

133,037

 

 

 

 

132,955

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+725, 0.75% Floor

 

10/19/2028

 

 

 

13,636

 

 

 

 

(330

)

 

 

 

(341

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

132,707

 

 

 

 

132,614

 

 

 

BMC Software

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Boxer Parent Company Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.00% Floor

 

10/2/2025

 

 

 

26,263

 

 

 

 

26,270

 

 

 

 

25,204

 

 

(14)

DigiCert

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dcert Buyer, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+400, 0.00% Floor

 

10/16/2026

 

 

 

36,757

 

 

 

 

36,731

 

 

 

 

35,540

 

 

(16)

Flexera Software LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Flexera Software LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

3/3/2028

 

 

 

30,488

 

 

 

 

30,533

 

 

 

 

29,326

 

 

(14)

Imperva, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Imperva, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+400, 1.00% Floor

 

1/12/2026

 

 

 

47,786

 

 

 

 

47,776

 

 

 

 

39,304

 

 

(14)

Infoblox

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Delta Topco, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+375, 0.75% Floor

 

12/1/2027

 

 

 

29,068

 

 

 

 

29,041

 

 

 

 

26,888

 

 

(17)

Medallia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Medallia, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+600 Cash plus 0.75% PIK

 

10/29/2028

 

 

 

36,423

 

 

 

 

35,651

 

 

 

 

36,241

 

 

(4)(9)(14)

Ping Identity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ping Identity Holding Corp.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+700, 0.75% Floor

 

10/17/2029

 

 

 

22,727

 

 

 

 

22,171

 

 

 

 

22,159

 

 

(4)(16)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+700, 0.75% Floor

 

10/17/2028

 

 

 

2,273

 

 

 

 

(55

)

 

 

 

(57

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22,116

 

 

 

 

22,102

 

 

 

Relativity ODA LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Relativity ODA LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+650 Cash plus 1.00% PIK

 

5/12/2027

 

 

 

28,631

 

 

 

 

27,646

 

 

 

 

27,486

 

 

(4)(14)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

L+650 Cash plus 1.00% PIK

 

5/12/2027

 

 

 

2,500

 

 

 

 

(58

)

 

 

 

(100

)

 

(4)(5)(11)
(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,588

 

 

 

 

27,386

 

 

 

Solera, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Polaris Newco, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+400, 0.50% Floor

 

6/2/2028

 

 

 

49,944

 

 

 

 

50,010

 

 

 

 

45,730

 

 

(14)

Sovos Compliance, LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sovos Compliance, LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+450, 0.50% Floor

 

8/11/2028

 

 

 

5,187

 

 

 

 

5,179

 

 

 

 

4,792

 

 

(14)

Tibco Software Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TIBCO Software Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.50% Floor

 

9/29/2028

 

 

 

50,000

 

 

 

 

43,500

 

 

 

 

44,625

 

 

(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+450, 0.50% Floor

 

3/30/2029

 

 

 

28,179

 

 

 

 

25,672

 

 

 

 

25,229

 

 

(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

69,172

 

 

 

 

69,854

 

 

 

Zendesk, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Zendesk, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

11/22/2028

 

 

 

207,880

 

 

 

 

162,616

 

 

 

 

162,562

 

 

(4)(9)(17)
(26)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt - Revolver

 

 

S+650, 0.75% Floor

 

11/22/2028

 

 

 

17,120

 

 

 

 

(336

)

 

 

 

(342

)

 

(4)(5)(9)
(11)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

162,280

 

 

 

 

162,220

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Software

 

 

 $

 

721,217

 

 

 $

 

703,317

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Special Purpose Entity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

48forty Solutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alpine Acquisition Corp II

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 1.00% Floor

 

11/30/2026

 

 $

 

7,463

 

 

 $

 

7,463

 

 

 $

 

7,351

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Special Purpose Entity

 

 

 $

 

7,463

 

 

 $

 

7,351

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

89


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry/Company

 

Investment Type

 

 

Interest Rate (12)

 

Maturity Date

 

Par/Shares (3)

 

 

Cost (27)

 

 

Fair Value (1)(28)

 

 

 

Specialty Retail

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Carvana Co.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Carvana Co.

 

Unsecured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

10.25%

 

5/1/2030

 

 $

 

56,858

 

 

 $

 

51,863

 

 

 $

 

26,904

 

 

(8)

 

 

Unsecured Debt - Corporate Bond

 

 

4.88%

 

9/1/2029

 

 

 

3,300

 

 

 

 

2,044

 

 

 

 

1,284

 

 

(8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

53,907

 

 

 

 

28,188

 

 

 

Petco

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Petco Health and Wellness Company, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+325, 0.75% Floor

 

3/3/2028

 

 

 

12,400

 

 

 

 

12,441

 

 

 

 

12,052

 

 

(8)(16)

PetSmart LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PetSmart LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+375, 0.75% Floor

 

2/11/2028

 

 

 

9,875

 

 

 

 

9,881

 

 

 

 

9,698

 

 

(8)(14)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Specialty Retail

 

 

 $

 

76,229

 

 

 $

 

49,938

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Technology Hardware, Storage & Peripherals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Forterro

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Yellow Castle AB

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+550, 0.00% Floor

 

7/9/2029

 

 €

 

9,802

 

 

 $

 

9,728

 

 

 $

 

10,177

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(22)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

SARON+550, 0.00% Floor

 

7/9/2029

 

 ₣

 

3,296

 

 

 

 

3,304

 

 

 

 

3,457

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(23)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

STIBOR+550, 0.00% Floor

 

7/9/2029

 

 kr

 

34,792

 

 

 

 

3,226

 

 

 

 

3,234

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(24)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+550, 0.00% Floor

 

7/7/2029

 

 €

 

8,445

 

 

 

 

3,090

 

 

 

 

3,194

 

 

(3)(4)(8)
(22)(26)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Technology Hardware, Storage & Peripherals

 

 

 $

 

19,348

 

 

 $

 

20,062

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Textiles, Apparel & Luxury Goods

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Claire's Stores, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Claire's Stores, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

L+650, 0.00% Floor

 

12/18/2026

 

 $

 

12,018

 

 

 $

 

11,846

 

 

 $

 

10,862

 

 

(14)

Iconix Brand Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

IBG Borrower LLC

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+600, 1.00% Floor

 

8/22/2029

 

 

 

42,808

 

 

 

 

41,777

 

 

 

 

41,952

 

 

(4)(9)(17)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Textiles, Apparel & Luxury Goods

 

 

 $

 

53,623

 

 

 $

 

52,814

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Transportation Infrastructure

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alliance Ground International

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AGI-CFI Holdings, Inc.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+575, 0.75% Floor

 

6/11/2027

 

 $

 

9,950

 

 

 $

 

9,765

 

 

 $

 

9,851

 

 

(4)(17)

 

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

S+550, 0.75% Floor

 

6/11/2027

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

7,369

 

 

(4)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

17,208

 

 

 

 

17,220

 

 

 

Swissport

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Radar Bidco S.a.r.l.

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

 

E+725, 0.00% Floor

 

9/30/2027

 

 €

 

85,000

 

 

 

 

80,115

 

 

 

 

88,714

 

 

(3)(4)(8)(9)
(22)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Transportation Infrastructure

 

 

 $

 

97,323

 

 

 $

 

105,934

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Investments before Cash Equivalents

 

 

 $

 

4,427,510

 

 

 $

 

4,308,892

 

 

(2)(6)(25)

State Street Institutional US Government Money Market Fund

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4

 

 

 

 

4

 

 

(7)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Investments after Cash Equivalents

 

 

 $

 

4,427,514

 

 

 $

 

4,308,896

 

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

90


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Derivative Instrument

 

Company Receives

 

Company Pays

 

Maturity Date

 

Notional Amount

 

 

Footnote Reference

Interest rate swap (a)

 

4.02%

 

3-month SOFR

 

12/21/2025

 

$

 

62,000

 

 

Note 5

Interest rate swap (a)

 

3.97%

 

3-month SOFR

 

1/19/2026

 

 

 

38,000

 

 

Note 5

Interest rate swap (b)

 

3.67%

 

3-month SOFR

 

12/21/2027

 

 

 

82,000

 

 

Note 5

Interest rate swap (b)

 

3.65%

 

3-month SOFR

 

1/19/2028

 

 

 

18,000

 

 

Note 5

(a)
Bears interest at a rate determined by three-month SOFR. The interest rate locked two business days prior to settlement of the interest rate swaps. The three-month SOFR is 4.59% on December 31, 2022.
(b)
Bears interest at a rate determined by three-month SOFR. The interest rate swaps have not yet settled, so the interest rate has not yet been determined and accruals have not commenced.

 

Derivative Instrument

 

 

Settlement Date

 

Notional amount to be purchased

 

 

Notional amount to be sold

 

 

 

Footnote Reference

Foreign currency forward contract

 

 

3/15/2023

 

$

 

3,440

 

 

 

3,160

 

 

 

Note 5

Foreign currency forward contract

 

 

3/15/2023

 

 

 

1,903

 

 

 

1,790

 

 

 

Note 5

Foreign currency forward contract

 

 

3/31/2023

 

 

 

10,562

 

 

 

9,820

 

 

 

Note 5

Foreign currency forward contract

 

 

3/15/2023

 

 

 

14,813

 

 

£

 

12,010

 

 

 

Note 5

______________________________________

(1)
Fair value is determined in good faith by or under the direction of the Board of Trustees of the Company (See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements).
(2)
Aggregate gross unrealized gain and loss for federal income tax purposes is $9,946 and $135,828, respectively. Net unrealized loss is $125,882 based on a tax cost of $4,433,623.
(3)
Par amount is denominated in USD unless otherwise noted, British Pound (“£”), Australian Dollar (“A$”), European Euro ("€"), Swedish Krona ("kr") and Swiss Franc ("₣").
(4)
These investments were valued using unobservable inputs and are considered Level 3 investments. Fair value was determined in good faith by or under the direction of the Board of Trustees (the “Board”) (see Note 2 and Note 4), pursuant to the Company’s valuation policy.
(5)
The negative fair value is the result of the commitment being valued below par.
(6)
All debt investments are income producing unless otherwise indicated.
(7)
This security is included in Cash and Cash Equivalents on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.
(8)
Investments that the Company has determined are not “qualifying assets” under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act. Under the 1940 Act, we may not acquire any non-qualifying asset unless, at the time such acquisition is made, qualifying assets represent at least 70% of our total assets. The status of these assets under the 1940 Act is subject to change. The Company monitors the status of these assets on an ongoing basis. As of December 31, 2022, non-qualifying assets represented approximately 26.73% of the total assets of the Company.

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

91


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

(9)
These are co-investments made with the Company’s affiliates in accordance with the terms of the exemptive order the Company received from the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) permitting us to do so. (See to the consolidated financial statements for discussion of the exemptive order from the SEC.)
(10)
These debt investments are not pledged as collateral under any of the Company's credit facilities (see Note 6). For other debt investments that are pledged to the Company's credit facilities, a single investment may be divided into parts that are individually pledged as collateral to separate credit facilities.
(11)
The undrawn portion of these committed revolvers and delayed draw term loans includes a commitment and unused fee rate.
(12)
Unless otherwise indicated, loan contains a variable rate structure, and may be subject to an interest rate floor. Variable rate loans bear interest at a rate that may be determined by reference to either the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR” or “L”) (which can include one-, two-, three- or six-month LIBOR), the Secured Overnight Financing Rate ("SOFR" or "S") or an alternate base rate (which can include the Federal Funds Effective Rate or the Prime Rate), at the borrower’s option, and which reset periodically based on the terms of the loan agreement. The terms in the Consolidated Schedule of Investments disclose the actual interest rate in effect as of the reporting period, and may be subject to interest floors.
(13)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 1 month LIBOR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 4.39%
(14)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 3 months LIBOR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 4.77%
(15)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 6 months LIBOR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 5.14%
(16)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 1 month SOFR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 4.36%
(17)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 3 months SOFR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 4.59%
(18)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 6 months SOFR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 4.78%
(19)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to SONIA, which as of December 31, 2022 was 3.43%
(20)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 3 months BBSW, which as of December 31, 2022 was 3.26%
(21)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 3 months EURIBOR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 2.13%
(22)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 6 months EURIBOR, which as of December 31, 2022 was 2.69%
(23)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to Swiss Average Rate Overnight (SARON), which as of December 31, 2022 was 0.94%
(24)
The interest rate on these loans is subject to 6 months Stockholm Interbank Offered Rate (STIBOR), which as of December 31, 2022 was 3.09%
(25)
Unless otherwise indicated, all investments are non-controlled, non-affiliated investments. Non-controlled, non-affiliated investments are defined as investments in which the Company owns less than 5% of the portfolio company’s outstanding voting securities and does not have the power to exercise control over the management or policies of such portfolio company. As of December 31, 2022, all of the company's investments were non-controlled, non-affiliated.

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

92


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

(26)
As of December 31, 2022, the Company had the following commitments to fund various revolving and delayed draw senior secured and subordinated loans. Such commitments are subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions set forth in the documents governing these loans and there can be no assurance that such conditions will be satisfied. See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements for further information on revolving and delayed draw loan commitments, related to certain portfolio companies.

 

 Name of Issuer

Total revolving and delayed draw loan commitments

 

 

Less: funded commitments

 

 

Total unfunded commitments

 

 

Less: commitments substantially at discretion of the Company

 

 

Less: unavailable commitments due to borrowing base or other covenant restrictions

 

 

Total net adjusted unfunded revolving and delayed draw commitments

 

 Accelerate360 Holdings, LLC

$

 

26,908

 

 

$

 

(15,696

)

 

$

 

11,212

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

11,212

 

 Advarra Holdings, Inc.

 

 

16,576

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,576

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,576

 

 Alera Group, Inc.

 

 

11,733

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,733

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,733

 

 Anaplan, Inc.

 

 

9,073

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,073

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,073

 

 Armstrong Bidco Limited*

 

 

3,898

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,898

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,898

 

 Athenahealth Group Inc.

 

 

5,516

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,516

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,516

 

 Avalara, Inc.

 

 

13,636

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,636

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,636

 

 AxiomSL Group, Inc.

 

 

2,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,000

 

 CI (Quercus) Intermediate Holdings, LLC

 

 

3,705

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,705

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,705

 

 CNSI Holdings, LLC

 

 

4,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,000

 

 CPI Buyer, LLC

 

 

11,411

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,411

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,411

 

 Coretrust Purchasing Group LLC (HPG Enterprises LLC)

 

 

9,474

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,474

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,474

 

 ERC Topco Holdings, LLC

 

 

8,148

 

 

 

 

(1,970

)

 

 

 

6,178

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,953

 

 

 

 

1,225

 

 Gateway US Holdings, Inc.

 

 

6,783

 

 

 

 

(1,446

)

 

 

 

5,337

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,600

 

 

 

 

1,737

 

 Heat Makes Sense Shared Services, LLC

 

 

1,617

 

 

 

 

(323

)

 

 

 

1,293

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,293

 

 Hyperion Refinance Sarl

 

 

72,983

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72,983

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72,983

 

 IQN Holding Corp.

 

 

17,001

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

17,001

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

17,001

 

 Investment Company 24 Bidco Limited*

 

 

1,474

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,474

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,474

 

 Jazz AH Holdco, LLC

 

 

2,800

 

 

 

 

(300

)

 

 

 

2,500

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,500

 

 Mount Olympus Bidco Limited

 

 

831

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

831

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

831

 

 PARS Group LLC

 

 

952

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

952

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

952

 

 PPL Acquisition LLC

 

 

1,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,000

 

 Patriot Growth Insurance Services, LLC

 

 

2,311

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,311

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,311

 

 Ping Identity Holding Corp.

 

 

2,273

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,273

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,273

 

 RSC Acquisition Inc

 

 

19,085

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,085

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,085

 

 Relativity ODA LLC

 

 

2,500

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,500

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,500

 

 Roaring Fork III-B, LLC

 

 

21,871

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,871

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,871

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

93


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 Name of Issuer

Total revolving and delayed draw loan commitments

 

 

Less: funded commitments

 

 

Total unfunded commitments

 

 

Less: commitments substantially at discretion of the Company

 

 

Less: unavailable commitments due to borrowing base or other covenant restrictions

 

 

Total net adjusted unfunded revolving and delayed draw commitments

 

 TZ Buyer LLC

 

 

2,374

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,374

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,374

 

 Treace Medical Concepts, Inc.

 

 

11,708

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,708

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,833

 

 

 

 

5,875

 

 Trench Plate Rental Co.

 

 

4,545

 

 

 

 

(200

)

 

 

 

4,345

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,345

 

 Ultimate Baked Goods Midco LLC

 

 

1,016

 

 

 

 

(1,205

)

 

 

 

(188

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(188

)

 Yellow Castle AB*

 

 

5,574

 

 

 

 

(267

)

 

 

 

5,308

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,308

 

 Zendesk, Inc.

 

 

58,696

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

58,696

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

58,696

 

 Total

$

 

363,472

 

 

$

 

(21,407

)

 

$

 

342,064

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

14,386

 

 

$

 

327,678

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

94


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

(27)
The following shows the composition of the Company’s portfolio at cost by investment type and industry as of December 31, 2022:

 

Industry

 

 

First Lien - Secured Debt

 

 

Unsecured Debt

 

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

Common Equity

 

 

Total

 

Aerospace & Defense

 

 

$

 

11,620

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

11,620

 

Asset Backed Securities

 

 

 

 

27,721

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,721

 

Auto Components

 

 

 

 

55,682

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

55,682

 

Biotechnology

 

 

 

 

37,036

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

37,036

 

Building Products

 

 

 

 

114,407

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

114,407

 

Capital Markets

 

 

 

 

43,661

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

43,661

 

Chemicals

 

 

 

 

65,513

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

65,513

 

Commercial Services & Supplies

 

 

 

 

446,839

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

446,989

 

Communications Equipment

 

 

 

 

66,668

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

66,668

 

Construction & Engineering

 

 

 

 

45,720

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

45,770

 

Consumer Finance

 

 

 

 

25,231

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,231

 

Containers & Packaging

 

 

 

 

78,041

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

78,041

 

Diversified Consumer Services

 

 

 

 

71,812

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

71,812

 

Diversified Financial Services

 

 

 

 

72,109

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72,109

 

Diversified Telecommunication Services

 

 

 

 

4,015

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,015

 

Electric Utilities

 

 

 

 

29,152

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

29,152

 

Electrical Equipment

 

 

 

 

33,342

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

33,342

 

Entertainment

 

 

 

 

90,636

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

90,636

 

Equity Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

 

 

 

 

7,444

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,444

 

Financing

 

 

 

 

7,443

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,443

 

Food & Staples Retailing

 

 

 

 

8,288

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,288

 

Food Products

 

 

 

 

11,018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,018

 

Health Care Equipment & Supplies

 

 

 

 

14,319

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

14,319

 

Health Care Providers & Services

 

 

 

 

559,058

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

559,058

 

Health Care Technology

 

 

 

 

80,954

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

80,954

 

Hotels, Restaurants & Leisure

 

 

 

 

27,149

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,149

 

Household Durables

 

 

 

 

9,739

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

9,789

 

Household Products

 

 

 

 

31,638

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

31,638

 

Insurance

 

 

 

 

139,715

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

139,715

 

Internet & Direct Marketing Retail

 

 

 

 

131,145

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

131,145

 

IT Services

 

 

 

 

234,946

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

234,946

 

Machinery

 

 

 

 

64,187

 

 

 

 

5,973

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

70,160

 

Media

 

 

 

 

270,184

 

 

 

 

9,396

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

279,580

 

Paper & Forest Products

 

 

 

 

22,448

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22,448

 

Personal Products

 

 

 

 

257,019

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

257,069

 

Pharmaceuticals

 

 

 

 

93,331

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

93,331

 

Professional Services

 

 

 

 

27,323

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,323

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

95


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Industry

 

 

First Lien - Secured Debt

 

 

Unsecured Debt

 

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

Common Equity

 

 

Total

 

Real Estate Management & Development

 

 

 

 

109,479

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

109,479

 

Road & Rail

 

 

 

 

10,606

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,606

 

Software

 

 

 

 

721,217

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

721,217

 

Special Purpose Entity

 

 

 

 

7,463

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,463

 

Specialty Retail

 

 

 

 

22,322

 

 

 

 

53,907

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

76,229

 

Technology Hardware, Storage & Peripherals

 

 

 

 

19,348

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,348

 

Textiles, Apparel & Luxury Goods

 

 

 

 

53,623

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

53,623

 

Transportation Infrastructure

 

 

 

 

97,323

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

97,323

 

Total

 

 

$

 

4,357,934

 

 

$

 

69,276

 

 

$

 

100

 

 

$

 

200

 

 

$

 

4,427,510

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

96


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

(28)
The following shows the composition of the Company’s portfolio at fair value by investment type, industry and region as of December 31, 2022:

 

Industry

 

 

First Lien - Secured Debt

 

 

Unsecured Debt

 

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

Common Equity

 

 

Total

 

 

% of Net Assets

 

Aerospace & Defense

 

 

$

 

11,474

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

11,474

 

 

 

0.5

%

Asset Backed Securities

 

 

 

 

27,204

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,204

 

 

 

1.3

%

Auto Components

 

 

 

 

51,033

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

51,033

 

 

 

2.4

%

Biotechnology

 

 

 

 

36,546

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

36,546

 

 

 

1.7

%

Building Products

 

 

 

 

106,570

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

106,570

 

 

 

4.9

%

Capital Markets

 

 

 

 

41,197

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

41,197

 

 

 

1.9

%

Chemicals

 

 

 

 

62,324

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

62,324

 

 

 

2.9

%

Commercial Services & Supplies

 

 

 

 

437,169

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

56

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

437,275

 

 

 

20.3

%

Communications Equipment

 

 

 

 

59,907

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

59,907

 

 

 

2.8

%

Construction & Engineering

 

 

 

 

45,685

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

51

 

 

 

 

45,736

 

 

 

2.1

%

Consumer Finance

 

 

 

 

24,906

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24,906

 

 

 

1.2

%

Containers & Packaging

 

 

 

 

75,423

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

75,423

 

 

 

3.5

%

Diversified Consumer Services

 

 

 

 

72,077

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72,077

 

 

 

3.3

%

Diversified Financial Services

 

 

 

 

72,267

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72,267

 

 

 

3.4

%

Diversified Telecommunication Services

 

 

 

 

3,441

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,441

 

 

 

0.2

%

Electric Utilities

 

 

 

 

29,178

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

29,178

 

 

 

1.4

%

Electrical Equipment

 

 

 

 

32,895

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

32,895

 

 

 

1.5

%

Entertainment

 

 

 

 

91,439

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

91,439

 

 

 

4.2

%

Equity Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

 

 

 

 

7,332

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,332

 

 

 

0.3

%

Financing

 

 

 

 

7,369

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,369

 

 

 

0.3

%

Food & Staples Retailing

 

 

 

 

8,251

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,251

 

 

 

0.4

%

Food Products

 

 

 

 

10,853

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,853

 

 

 

0.5

%

Health Care Equipment & Supplies

 

 

 

 

13,525

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,525

 

 

 

0.6

%

Health Care Providers & Services

 

 

 

 

548,769

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

548,769

 

 

 

25.5

%

Health Care Technology

 

 

 

 

77,607

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

77,607

 

 

 

3.6

%

Hotels, Restaurants & Leisure

 

 

 

 

26,211

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

26,211

 

 

 

1.2

%

Household Durables

 

 

 

 

9,727

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

54

 

 

 

 

9,781

 

 

 

0.5

%

Household Products

 

 

 

 

28,225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

28,225

 

 

 

1.3

%

Insurance

 

 

 

 

136,745

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

136,745

 

 

 

10.8

%

Internet & Direct Marketing Retail

 

 

 

 

131,996

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

131,996

 

 

 

6.3

%

IT Services

 

 

 

 

232,210

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

232,210

 

 

 

6.1

%

Machinery

 

 

 

 

63,045

 

 

 

 

4,941

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

67,986

 

 

 

3.2

%

Media

 

 

 

 

263,111

 

 

 

 

8,536

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

271,647

 

 

 

12.6

%

Paper & Forest Products

 

 

 

 

21,561

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,561

 

 

 

1.0

%

Personal Products

 

 

 

 

258,299

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

50

 

 

 

 

258,349

 

 

 

12.0

%

Pharmaceuticals

 

 

 

 

85,327

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

85,327

 

 

 

4.0

%

Professional Services

 

 

 

 

25,549

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,549

 

 

 

1.2

%

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

97


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry

 

 

First Lien - Secured Debt

 

 

Unsecured Debt

 

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

Common Equity

 

 

Total

 

 

% of Net Assets

 

Real Estate Management & Development

 

 

$

 

109,264

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

109,264

 

 

 

5.1

%

Road & Rail

 

 

 

 

10,027

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,027

 

 

 

0.5

%

Software

 

 

 

 

703,317

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

703,317

 

 

 

32.6

%

Special Purpose Entity

 

 

 

 

7,351

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,351

 

 

 

0.3

%

Specialty Retail

 

 

 

 

21,750

 

 

 

 

28,188

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

49,938

 

 

 

2.3

%

Technology Hardware, Storage & Peripherals

 

 

 

 

20,062

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

20,062

 

 

 

0.9

%

Textiles, Apparel & Luxury Goods

 

 

 

 

52,814

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

52,814

 

 

 

2.5

%

Transportation Infrastructure

 

 

 

 

105,934

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

105,934

 

 

 

4.9

%

Total

 

 

$

 

4,266,966

 

 

$

 

41,665

 

 

$

 

56

 

 

$

 

205

 

 

$

 

4,308,892

 

 

 

200.0

%

% of Net Assets

 

 

 

 

198.0

%

 

 

 

1.9

%

 

 

 

0.0

%

 

 

 

0.0

%

 

 

 

200.0

%

 

 

 

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

98


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

CONSOLIDATED SCHEDULE OF INVESTMENTS

December 31, 2022

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

Industry Classification

Percentage of Total
Investments (at Fair Value)
as of December 31, 2022

 

Software

 

16.3

%

Health Care Providers & Services

 

12.7

%

Commercial Services & Supplies

 

10.1

%

Media

 

6.3

%

Personal Products

 

6.0

%

IT Services

 

5.4

%

Insurance

 

3.1

%

Internet & Direct Marketing Retail

 

3.0

%

Real Estate Management & Development

 

2.5

%

Building Products

 

2.5

%

Transportation Infrastructure

 

2.5

%

Entertainment

 

2.1

%

Pharmaceuticals

 

2.0

%

Health Care Technology

 

1.8

%

Containers & Packaging

 

1.7

%

Diversified Financial Services

 

1.7

%

Diversified Consumer Services

 

1.7

%

Machinery

 

1.6

%

Chemicals

 

1.4

%

Communications Equipment

 

1.4

%

Textiles, Apparel & Luxury Goods

 

1.2

%

Auto Components

 

1.2

%

Specialty Retail

 

1.2

%

Construction & Engineering

 

1.1

%

Capital Markets

 

1.0

%

Biotechnology

 

0.8

%

Electrical Equipment

 

0.8

%

Electric Utilities

 

0.7

%

Household Products

 

0.7

%

Asset Backed Securities

 

0.6

%

Hotels, Restaurants & Leisure

 

0.6

%

Professional Services

 

0.6

%

Consumer Finance

 

0.6

%

Paper & Forest Products

 

0.5

%

Technology Hardware, Storage & Peripherals

 

0.5

%

Health Care Equipment & Supplies

 

0.3

%

Aerospace & Defense

 

0.3

%

Food Products

 

0.2

%

Road & Rail

 

0.2

%

Household Durables

 

0.2

%

Food & Staples Retailing

 

0.2

%

Financing

 

0.2

%

Special Purpose Entity

 

0.2

%

Equity Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

 

0.2

%

Diversified Telecommunication Services

 

0.1

%

 

 

100.0

%

 

Geographic Region

 

December 31, 2022

 

United States

 

 

83.2

%

Europe

 

 

10.3

%

United Kingdom

 

 

3.0

%

Australia

 

 

2.7

%

Canada

 

 

0.8

%

 

See notes to consolidated financial statements

99


Table of Contents

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

Note 1. Organization

Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “Company,” “ADS,” “we,” “us,” or “our”), a Delaware statutory trust formed on December 4, 2020, is a closed-end, externally managed, non-diversified management investment company that has elected to be regulated as a business development company (“BDC”) under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the “1940 Act”). The Company has elected to be treated for federal income tax purposes, and intends to qualify annually thereafter, as a regulated investment company (“RIC”) as defined under Subchapter M of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”).

Apollo Credit Management, LLC (the “Adviser”) is our investment adviser and is an affiliate of Apollo Global Management, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries (“AGM”). The Adviser, subject to the overall supervision of our Board of Trustees, manages the day-to-day operations of the Company and provides investment advisory services to the Company.

Apollo Credit Management, LLC, as our administrator (the “Administrator”), provides, among other things, administrative services and facilities to the Company. Furthermore, the Administrator will offer to provide, on our behalf, managerial assistance to those portfolio companies to which we are required to provide such assistance.

Our investment objective is to generate current income and, to a lesser extent, long-term capital appreciation. The Company seeks to invest primarily in private credit opportunities in directly originated assets, including loans and other debt securities, made to or issued by large private U.S. borrowers, which ADS generally defines as companies with more than $75 million in EBITDA, as may be adjusted for market disruptions, mergers and acquisitions-related charges and synergies, and other items. While most of the Company’s investments will be in private U.S. companies (subject to compliance with BDC regulatory requirement to invest at least 70% of its assets in private U.S. companies), we also expect to invest from time to time in European and other non-U.S. companies. The investment portfolio may also include other interests such as corporate bonds, common stock, preferred stock, warrants or options, which generally would be obtained as part of providing a broader financing solution. Under normal circumstances, we will invest directly or indirectly at least 80% of our total assets (net assets plus borrowings for investment purposes) in debt instruments of varying maturities.

Note 2. Significant Accounting Policies

The following is a summary of the significant accounting and reporting policies used in preparing the consolidated financial statements.

Basis of Presentation

The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) pursuant to the requirements on Form 10-Q, ASC 946, Financial Services — Investment Companies (“ASC 946”), and Articles 6, 10 and 12 of Regulation S-X. In the opinion of management, all adjustments, which are of a normal recurring nature, considered necessary for the fair statement of the consolidated financial statements for the periods presented, have been included.

Under the 1940 Act, ASC 946, and the regulations pursuant to Article 6 of Regulation S-X, we are precluded from consolidating any entity other than another investment company or an operating company which provides substantially all of its services to benefit us. All intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of income, expenses, gains and losses during the reported periods. Changes in the economic environment, financial markets, credit worthiness of our portfolio companies and any other parameters used in determining these estimates could cause actual results to differ materially.

Consolidation

As provided under Regulation S-X and ASC 946, the Company will not consolidate its investment in a company other than an investment company subsidiary or a controlled operating company whose business consists of providing services to the Company. Accordingly, the Company consolidated the results of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiaries.

As of December 31, 2022, the Company's consolidated subsidiaries were Cardinal Funding LLC, Mallard Funding LLC, Grouse Funding LLC, ADS Alpine SPV LLC, ADS Jewel SPV LLC, ADS WW SPV LLC and ADS Zorro SPV LLC.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company defines cash equivalents as securities that are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and near maturity, that they present insignificant risk of changes in value because of changes in interest rates. Generally, only securities with a maturity of three months or less from the date of purchase would qualify, with limited exceptions. The Company deems that certain money market funds, U.S. Treasury bills, repurchase agreements, and other high-quality, short-term debt securities would qualify as cash equivalents.

100


Table of Contents

 

Cash and cash equivalents are carried at cost, which approximates fair value. Cash and cash equivalents held as of December 31, 2022 was $47,322. Cash held as of December 31, 2021 was $50.

Investments Transactions

Investments are recognized when we assume an obligation to acquire a financial instrument and assume the risks for gains and losses related to that instrument. Investments are derecognized when we assume an obligation to sell a financial instrument and forego the risks for gains or losses related to that instrument. Specifically, we record all security transactions on a trade date basis. Amounts for investments recognized or derecognized but not yet settled are reported as a receivable for investments sold and a payable for investments purchased, respectively, in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Fair Value Measurements

The Company follows guidance in ASC 820, Fair Value Measurement (“ASC 820”), where fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Fair value measurements are determined within a framework that establishes a three-tier hierarchy which maximizes the use of observable market data and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs to establish a classification of fair value measurements for disclosure purposes. Inputs refer broadly to the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including assumptions about risk, such as the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique used to measure fair value using a pricing model and/or the risk inherent in the inputs for the valuation technique. Inputs may be observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Company. Unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability based on the information available. The inputs or methodology used for valuing assets or liabilities may not be an indication of the risks associated with investing in those assets or liabilities.

ASC 820 classifies the inputs used to measure these fair values into the following hierarchy:


Level 1: Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities, accessible by us at the measurement date.


Level 2: Quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, or quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or other observable inputs other than quoted prices.


Level 3: Unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

In all cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement. Our assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment and considers factors specific to each investment. The level assigned to the investment valuations may not be indicative of the risk or liquidity associated with investing in such investments. Because of the inherent uncertainties of valuation, the values reflected in the consolidated financial statements may differ materially from the values that would be received upon an actual disposition of such investments.

Investment Valuation Process

The Board of Trustees has designated the Adviser as its "valuation designee" pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the 1940 Act, and in that role the Adviser is responsible for performing fair value determinations relating to all of the Company's investments, including periodically assessing and managing any material valuation risks and establishing and applying fair value methodologies, in accordance with valuation policies and procedures that have been approved by the Company's Board of Trustees. Even though the Company's Board of Trustees designated the Company's Adviser as "valuation designee," the Company's Board of Trustees continues to be responsible for overseeing the processes for determining fair valuation.

In calculating the value of our total assets, we value investments for which market quotations are readily available at such market quotations if they are deemed to represent fair value. Debt and equity securities that are not publicly traded or whose market price is not readily available or whose market quotations are not deemed to represent fair value are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by or under the direction of the Adviser. Market quotations may be deemed not to represent fair value in certain circumstances where the Adviser reasonably believes that facts and circumstances applicable to an issuer, a seller or purchaser or the market for a particular security causes current market quotes not to reflect the fair value of the security. Examples of these events could include cases in which material events are announced after the close of the market on which a security is primarily traded, when a security trades infrequently causing a quoted purchase or sale price to become stale or in the event of a “fire sale” by a distressed seller.

If and when market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, we typically utilize independent third party valuation firms to assist us in determining fair value. Accordingly, such investments go through our multi-step valuation process as described below. The Adviser engages multiple independent valuation firms based on a review of each firm’s expertise and relevant experience in valuing certain securities. In each case, our independent valuation firms consider observable market inputs together with significant unobservable inputs in arriving at their valuation recommendations for such Level 3 categorized assets.

 

101


Table of Contents

 

With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available or when such market quotations are deemed not to represent fair value, our Adviser undertakes a multi-step valuation process each quarter, as described below:

(1)
Independent valuation firms engaged conduct independent appraisals and assessments for all the investments they have been engaged to review. If an independent valuation firm is not engaged during a particular quarter, the valuation may be conducted by the Adviser;
(2)
At least each quarter, the valuation will be reassessed and updated by the Adviser or an independent valuation firm to reflect company specific events and latest market data;
(3)
Preliminary valuation conclusions are then documented and discussed with senior management of our Adviser;
(4)
The Adviser discusses valuations and determines in good faith the fair value of each investment in our portfolio based on the input of the applicable independent valuation firm; and
(5)
For Level 3 investments entered into within the current quarter, the cost (purchase price adjusted for accreted original issue discount/amortized premium) or any recent comparable trade activity on the security investment shall be considered to reasonably approximate the fair value of the investment, provided that no material change has since occurred in the issuer’s business, significant inputs or the relevant environment.

Investments are valued utilizing a market approach, an income approach, or both approaches, as appropriate. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities (including a business). The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts (for example, cash flows or earnings) to a single present amount (discounted). The measurement is based on the value indicated by current market expectations about those future amounts. During the year ended December 31, 2022, there were no significant changes to the Company’s valuation techniques and related inputs considered in the valuation process.

Derivative Instruments

The Company recognizes all derivative instruments as assets or liabilities at fair value in its consolidated financial statements. Derivative instruments are measured in terms of the notional contract amount and derive their value based upon one or more underlying instruments. Derivative instruments are subject to various risks similar to non-derivative instruments including market, credit, liquidity, and operational risks. The Company manages these risks on an aggregate basis as part of its risk management process. The derivatives may require the Company to pay or receive an upfront fee or premium. These upfront fees or premiums are carried forward as cost or proceeds to the derivatives.

Foreign Currency Forward Contracts

The Company uses foreign currency forward contracts to reduce the Company's exposure to fluctuations in the value of foreign currencies. In a foreign currency forward contract, the Company agrees to receive or deliver a fixed quantity of one currency for another at a pre-determined price at a future date. Foreign currency forward contracts are marked-to-market at the applicable forward rate. Unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on foreign currency forward contracts are recorded within derivative assets or derivative liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities by counterparty on a net basis, not taking into account collateral posted which is recorded separately, if applicable. Purchases and settlements of foreign currency forward contracts having the same settlement date and counterparty are generally settled net and any realized gains or losses are recognized on the settlement date. The Company does not utilize hedge accounting with respect to foreign currency forward contracts and as such, the Company recognizes its foreign currency forward contracts at fair value with changes included in the net unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

Interest Rate Swaps

The Company uses interest rate swaps to hedge some or all of the Company's fixed rate debt. The Company designated the interest rate swaps as the hedging instrument in an effective hedge accounting relationship, and therefore the periodic payments and receipts are recognized as components of interest expense in the Consolidated Statement of Operations. Depending on the nature of the balance at period end, the fair value of the interest rate swap is either included as a derivative asset or derivative liability on the Company's Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. The change in fair value of the interest rate swap is offset by a change in the carrying value of the fixed rate debt. Any amounts paid to the counterparty to cover collateral obligations under the terms of the interest rate swap agreement are included in due from broker on the Company's Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Offsetting Assets and Liabilities

The Company has elected to offset cash collateral against the fair value of derivative contracts. The fair values of these derivatives are presented on a net basis in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities when, and only when, they are with the same counterparty, the Company has the legal right to offset the recognized amounts, and it intends to either settle on a net basis or realize the asset and settle the liability simultaneously.

Valuation of Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities

ASC 825, Financial Instruments, permits an entity to choose, at specified election dates, to measure certain assets and liabilities at fair value (the “Fair Value Option”). We have not elected the Fair Value Option to report selected financial assets and financial liabilities. Debt issued by the Company is reported at amortized cost (see Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements). The carrying value of all other financial assets and liabilities approximates fair value due to their short maturities or their close proximity of the originations to the measurement date.

102


Table of Contents

 

Realized Gains or Losses

Security transactions are accounted for on a trade date basis. Realized gains or losses on investments are calculated by using the specific identification method. Securities that have been called by the issuer are recorded at the call price on the call effective date.

Investment Income Recognition

Interest Income

Interest income is recorded on an accrual basis and includes the accretion of discounts and amortizations of premiums. Discounts from and premiums to par value on debt investments purchased are accreted/amortized into interest income over the life of the respective security using the effective interest method. The amortized cost of debt investments represents the original cost, including loan origination fees and upfront fees received that are deemed to be an adjustment to yield, adjusted for the accretion of discounts and amortization of premiums, if any. Upon prepayment of a loan or debt security, any prepayment premiums, unamortized upfront loan origination fees and unamortized discounts are recorded as interest income in the current period.

PIK Income

The Company may have loans in its portfolio that contain PIK provisions. PIK represents interest that is accrued and recorded as interest income at the contractual rates, increases the loan principal on the respective capitalization dates, and is generally due at maturity. Such income is included in interest income in the Company’s statement of operations. If at any point the Company believes PIK is not expected to be realized, the investment generating PIK will be placed on non-accrual status. When a PIK investment is placed on non-accrual status, the accrued, uncapitalized interest is generally reversed through interest income. To maintain the Company’s status as a RIC, this non-cash source of income must be paid out to shareholders in the form of dividends, even though the Company has not yet collected cash.

Dividend Income

Dividend income on preferred equity securities is recorded on the accrual basis to the extent that such amounts are payable by the portfolio company and are expected to be collected. Dividend income on common equity securities is recorded on the record date for private portfolio companies or on the ex-dividend date for publicly-traded portfolio companies.

Fee Income

The Company may receive various fees in the ordinary course of business such as structuring, consent, waiver, amendment, syndication fees as well as fees for managerial assistance rendered by the Company to the portfolio companies. Such fees are recognized as income when earned or the services are rendered.

Non-Accrual Income

Loans are generally placed on non-accrual status when there is reasonable doubt that principal or interest will be collected in full. Accrued interest is generally reversed when a loan is placed on non-accrual status. Additionally, any original issue discount and market discount are no longer accreted to interest income as of the date the loan is placed on non-accrual status. Interest payments received on non-accrual loans may be recognized as income or applied to principal depending upon management’s judgment regarding collectability. Non-accrual loans are restored to accrual status when past due principal and interest is paid current and, in management’s judgment, are likely to remain current. Management may make exceptions to this treatment and determine to not place a loan on non-accrual status if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection.

 

103


Table of Contents

 

Expenses

Expenses include management fees, performance-based incentive fees, interest expense, insurance expenses, administrative service fees, legal fees, trustees’ fees, audit and tax service expenses, third-party valuation fees and other general and administrative expenses. Expenses are recognized on an accrual basis.

Organization Expenses

Costs associated with the organization of the Company were expensed as incurred. These expenses consisted primarily of legal fees and other costs of organizing the Company.

Offering Expenses

Costs associated with the offering of the Company’s shares are capitalized as “deferred offering costs” on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities and amortized over a twelve-month period from incurrence. These expenses consist primarily of legal fees and other costs incurred in connection with the Company’s continuous offering.

Deferred Financing Costs and Debt Issuance Costs

Deferred financing and debt issuance costs represent fees and other direct incremental costs incurred in connection with the Company’s borrowings. These expenses are deferred and amortized into interest expense over the life of the related debt instrument using the straight-line method. Deferred financing costs related to revolving credit facilities are presented separately as an asset on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. Debt issuance costs related to any issuance of installment debt or notes are presented net against the outstanding debt balance of the related security.

Foreign Currency Translations

The accounting records of the Company are maintained in U.S. dollars. All assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated into U.S. dollars based on the foreign exchange rate on the date of valuation. The Company does not isolate that portion of the results of operations resulting from changes in foreign exchange rates on investments from the fluctuations arising from changes in market prices of securities held. The Company’s investments in foreign securities may involve certain risks, including without limitation: foreign exchange restrictions, expropriation, taxation or other political, social or economic risks, all of which could affect the market and/or credit risk of the investment. In addition, changes in the relationship of foreign currencies to the U.S. dollar can significantly affect the value of these investments and therefore the earnings of the Company.

Allocation of Income, Expenses, Gains and Losses

Income, expenses (other than those attributable to a specific class), gains and losses are allocated to each class of shares based upon the relative proportion of net assets represented by such class. Operating expenses directly attributable to a specific class are charged against the operations of that class.

Distributions

Distributions to common shareholders are recorded on the record date. The amount to be paid out as a distribution is determined by the Board of Trustees and will depend on the Company's earnings, financial condition, maintenance of our tax treatment as a RIC, compliance with applicable BDC regulations and such factors as the Board may deem relevant from time to time. Although the gross distribution per share is generally equivalent for each share class, the net distribution for each share class is reduced for any class specific expenses, including distribution and servicing fees, if any.

Share Repurchases

In connection with the Company’s share repurchase programs, the cost of shares repurchased is charged to net assets on the trade date.

 

104


Table of Contents

 

Federal and State Income Taxes

We have elected to be treated as a RIC under the Code and operate in a manner so as to qualify for the tax treatment applicable to RICs. To qualify as a RIC, the Company must (among other requirements) meet certain source-of-income and asset diversification requirements and timely distribute to its stockholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income as defined by the Code, for each year. The Company (among other requirements) has made and intends to continue to make the requisite distributions to its stockholders, which will generally relieve the Company from corporate-level income taxes. For income tax purposes, distributions made to stockholders are reported as ordinary income, capital gains, non-taxable return of capital, or a combination thereof. The tax character of distributions paid to stockholders through December 31, 2022 may include return of capital, however, the exact amount cannot be determined at this point. The final determination of the tax character of distributions will not be made until we file Form 1099s for the tax year ending December 31, 2022. The character of income and gains that we will distribute is determined in accordance with income tax regulations that may differ from GAAP. Book and tax basis differences relating to stockholder dividend and distributions and other permanent book and tax difference are reclassified to paid-in capital.

If we do not distribute (or are not deemed to have distributed) at least 98% of our annual ordinary income and 98.2% of our capital gain net income for the 1-year period ending on October 31 of such calendar year, we will generally be required to pay excise tax equal to 4% of the amount by which 98% of our annual ordinary income and 98.2% of our capital gains exceed the distributions from such taxable income for the year. To the extent that we determine that our estimated current year annual taxable income will be in excess of estimated current year dividend distributions from such taxable income, we accrue excise taxes, if any, on estimated undistributed taxable income.

If we fail to satisfy the annual distribution requirement or otherwise fail to qualify as a RIC in any taxable year, we would be subject to tax on all of our taxable income at regular corporate rates. Distribution would generally be taxable to our individual and other non-corporate taxable stockholders as ordinary dividend income eligible for the reduced maximum rate applicable to qualified dividend income to the extent of our current and accumulated earnings and profits provided certain holding period and other requirements are met. Subject to certain limitation under the Code, corporate distributions would be eligible for the dividend-received deduction. To qualify again to be taxed as a RIC in a subsequent year, we would be required to distribute to our stockholders our accumulated earnings and profits attributable to non RIC years. In addition, if we failed to qualify as a RIC for a period greater than two taxable years, then, in order to qualify as a RIC in a subsequent year, we would be required to elect to recognize and pay tax on any net built-in gain (the excess of aggregate gain, including items of income, over aggregate loss that would have been realized if we had been liquidated) or, alternatively, be subject to taxation on such built-in gain recognized for a period of five years.

We follow ASC 740, Income Taxes (“ASC 740”). ASC 740 provides guidance for how uncertain tax positions should be recognized, measured, presented, and disclosed in the consolidated financial statements. ASC 740 requires the evaluation of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in the course of preparing our tax returns to determine whether the tax positions are “more-likely-than-not” of being sustained by the applicable tax authority. Tax positions not deemed to meet the more-likely-than-not threshold are recorded as a tax benefit or expense in the current year. Penalties or interest, if applicable, that may be assessed relating to income taxes would be classified as other operating expenses in the consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2022, there were no uncertain tax positions and no amounts accrued for interest or penalties. Management’s determinations regarding ASC 740 may be subject to review and adjustment at a later date based upon factors including, but not limited to, an on-going analysis of tax laws, regulations and interpretations thereof. Although we file both federal and state income tax returns, our major tax jurisdiction is federal.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In March 2020, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Accounting Standards Update 2020-04, Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848) – Facilitation of the Effects of Reference Rate Reform on Financial Reporting (“ASU 2020-04”). The guidance provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying GAAP to contracts, hedging relationships, and other transactions, subject to meeting certain criteria, that reference London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) or another reference rate expected to be discontinued because of reference rate reform. ASU 2020-04 was effective for all entities as of March 12, 2020 through December 31, 2022. The FASB issued Accounting Standards Update 2022-06 - Deferral of the Sunset Date of Topic 848 (“ASU 2022-06”) to formally address the new intended cessation date to June 30, 2023. ASU 2022-06 extends the grace period for the completion of the adoption of ASU 2020-04 to December 31, 2024. Management continues to assess the impact that the adoption of this guidance will have on the Company.

 

105


Table of Contents

 

Investment Advisory Agreement

On July 22, 2021, the Company entered into an Investment Advisory Agreement (the “Advisory Agreement”) with the Adviser, pursuant to which the Adviser will manage the Company on a day-to-day basis. The Adviser is responsible for originating prospective investments, conducting research and due diligence investigations on potential investments, analyzing investment opportunities, negotiating and structuring the Company’s investments and monitoring its investments and portfolio companies on an ongoing basis.

The Advisory Agreement is effective for an initial two-year term and thereafter will continue for successive annual periods provided that such continuance is specifically approved annually by a majority of the Board or by the holders of a majority of the Company’s outstanding voting securities and, in each case, a majority of the independent trustees. The Company may terminate the Advisory Agreement, without payment of any penalty, upon 60 days’ written notice. The Investment Advisory Agreement will automatically terminate in the event of its assignment within the meaning of the 1940 Act and related SEC guidance and interpretations.

The Company pays the Adviser a fee for its services under the Advisory Agreement consisting of two components, a base management fee and an incentive fee. The cost of both the base management fee and the incentive fee will ultimately be borne by the shareholders. Substantial additional fees and expenses may also be charged by the Administrator to the Company, which is an affiliate of the Adviser. The Adviser agreed to waive the management fee and incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022.

Base Management Fee

The base management fee is payable monthly in arrears at an annual rate of 1.25% of the value of the Company’s net assets as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the applicable month. For purposes of the Advisory Agreement, net assets means our total assets less liabilities determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP. For the first calendar month in which the Company had operations, net assets was measured as the beginning net assets as of the date on which the Company broke escrow for the initial offering. The Adviser agreed to waive the management fee and incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022.

Incentive Fee

The incentive fee consists of two components that are independent of each other, with the result that one component may be payable even if the other is not. A portion of the incentive fee is based on a percentage of our income and a portion is based on a percentage of our capital gains, each as described below.

A. Incentive Fee based on Income

The portion based on our income is based on Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns. “Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns” means, as the context requires, either the dollar value of, or percentage rate of return on the value of net assets at the end of the immediate preceding quarter from, interest income, dividend income and any other income (including any other fees (other than fees for providing managerial assistance), such as commitment, origination, structuring, diligence and consulting fees or other fees that are received from portfolio companies) accrued during the calendar quarter, minus operating expenses accrued for the quarter (including the base management fee, expenses payable under the Administration Agreement entered into between the Company and the Administrator, and any interest expense or fees on any credit facilities or outstanding debt and dividends paid on any issued and outstanding preferred shares, but excluding the incentive fee and any distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees).

Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns include, in the case of investments with a deferred interest feature (such as original issue discount, debt instruments with PIK interest and zero coupon securities), accrued income that has not yet been received in cash. Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns do not include any realized capital gains, realized capital losses or unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation. The impact of expense support payments and recoupments are also excluded from Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns.

Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, expressed as a rate of return on the value of the Company’s net assets at the end of the immediate preceding quarter, is compared to a “hurdle rate” of return of 1.25% per quarter (5.0% annualized).

The Company pays its Adviser an income based incentive fee with respect to the Company’s Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns in each calendar quarter as follows:

No incentive fee based on Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns in any calendar quarter in which Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns do not exceed the hurdle rate of 1.25% per quarter (5.0% annualized);
100% of the dollar amount of Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns with respect to that portion of such Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, if any, that exceeds the hurdle rate but is less than a rate of return of 1.43% (5.72% annualized). This “catch-up” portion is meant to provide the Adviser with approximately 12.5% of Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns as if a hurdle rate did not apply if this net investment income exceeds 1.43% in any calendar quarter; and
12.5% of the dollar amount of Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns, if any, that exceed a rate of return of 1.43% (5.72% annualized). This reflects that once the hurdle rate is reached and the catch-up is achieved, 12.5% of all Pre-Incentive Fee Net Investment Income Returns thereafter are allocated to the Adviser.

106


Table of Contents

 

These calculations are pro-rated for any period of less than three months and adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the relevant quarter. The Adviser agreed to waive the incentive fee based on income through July 7, 2022.

B. Incentive Fee based on Cumulative Net Realized Gains

The second part of the incentive fee is determined and payable in arrears as of the end of each calendar year in an amount equal to 12.5% of realized capital gains, if any, on a cumulative basis from inception through the end of each calendar year. Fees are computed net of all realized capital losses and unrealized capital depreciation on a cumulative basis, less the aggregate amount of any previously paid capital gain incentive fees.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company recognized $20,929 of management fees, and $18,760 of incentive fees before impact of waived fees. For the year ended December 31, 2022, $8,596 of management fees were waived, and $5,127 of incentive fees were waived.

As of December 31, 2022, management and incentive fees payable were $10,451.

Fees From Affiliates

From time-to-time various affiliates of Adviser are involved in transactions whereby certain fees, including but not limited to, structuring, underwriting, arrangement, placement, syndication, advisory or similar services (collectively, “Capital Solution” services) are earned and rebated back to the funds. For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company received fee rebates from certain affiliates in the amount of $5,767.

Administration Agreement

On July 22, 2021, the Company entered into an Administration Agreement (the “Administration Agreement”) with the Administrator. Under the terms of the Administration Agreement, the Administrator will provide, or oversee the performance of, administrative and compliance services, including, but not limited to, maintaining financial records, overseeing the calculation of net asset value (“NAV”), compliance monitoring (including diligence and oversight of other service providers), preparing reports to shareholders and reports filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), preparing materials and coordinating meetings of the Company’s Board of Trustees, managing the payment of expenses and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered by others and providing office space, equipment and office services. The Company will reimburse the Administrator for the costs and expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its obligations under the Administration Agreement. Such reimbursement will include the Company’s allocable portion of compensation, overhead (including rent, office equipment and utilities) and other expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its administrative obligations under the Administration Agreement, including but not limited to: (i) the Company’s chief compliance officer, chief financial officer and their respective staffs; (ii) investor relations, legal, operations and other non-investment professionals at the Administrator that perform duties for the Company; and (iii) any internal audit group personnel of AGM or any of its affiliates, subject to the limitations described in Advisory and Administration Agreements. In addition, pursuant to the terms of the Administration Agreement, the Administrator may delegate its obligations under the Administration Agreement to an affiliate or to a third party and the Company will reimburse the Administrator for any services performed by such affiliate or third party. The Administrator hired a sub-administrator to assist in the provision of administrative services. The sub-administrator will receive compensation for its sub-administrative services under a sub-administration agreement.

Sub-Administration Agreement

On January 6, 2022, the Administrator entered into a sub-administration agreement (the “Sub-Administration Agreement”) with State Street Bank and Trust Company. The sub-administrator will receive compensation for its sub-administrative services under the Sub-Administration Agreement.

Intermediary Manager Agreement

On November 10, 2021, the Company entered into an Intermediary Manager Agreement (the “Intermediary Manager Agreement”) with Apollo Global Securities, LLC. (the “Intermediary Manager”), an affiliate of the Adviser, which is a broker-dealer registered with the SEC and a member of Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (“FINRA”). Under the terms of the Intermediary Manager Agreement, the Intermediary Manager will serve as the intermediary manager for the Company’s public offering of its common shares. The Intermediary Manager will be entitled to receive distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees monthly in arrears at an annual rate of 0.85% of the value of the Company’s net assets attributable to Class S shares as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month. The Intermediary Manager will be entitled to receive distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees monthly in arrears at an annual rate of 0.25% of the value of the Company’s net assets attributable to Class D shares as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month. No distribution and/or shareholding servicing fees will be paid with respect to Class I. The distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees will be payable to the Intermediary Manager, but the Intermediary Manager anticipates that all or a portion of the shareholder servicing fees will be retained by, or reallowed (paid) to, participating broker-dealers.

The Company will cease paying the distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees on the Class S shares and Class D shares on the earlier to occur of the following: (i) a listing of Class I shares, (ii) a merger or consolidation with or into another entity, or the sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets or (iii) the date following the completion of the primary portion of our offering on which, in the aggregate, underwriting compensation from all sources in connection with the offering, including the distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees and other underwriting compensation, is equal to 10% of the gross proceeds from the primary offering. In addition, the Company will cease paying the distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees on any Class S share and Class D share in a shareholder’s account at the end of the month in which the Intermediary Manager in conjunction with the transfer agent determines that total brokerage commissions and distribution and/or shareholder servicing fees paid with respect to any such share held by such shareholder within such account would exceed, in the aggregate, 10% of the gross proceeds from the sale of such share. At the end of such month, each such Class S share or Class D share will convert into a number of Class I shares (including any fractional shares), with an equivalent aggregate NAV as such share.

107


Table of Contents

 

The Intermediary Manager is a broker-dealer registered with the SEC is a member of FINRA.

The Intermediary Manager Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment of any penalty, by vote of a majority of the Company’s trustees who are not “interested persons”, as defined in the 1940 Act, of the Company and who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the Company’s distribution plan or the Intermediary Manager Agreement or by vote a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Company, on not more than 60 days’ written notice to the Intermediary Manager or the Adviser. The Intermediary Manager Agreement will automatically terminate in the event of its assignment, as defined in the 1940 Act.

Distribution and Servicing Plan

On July 22, 2021, the Board approved a distribution and servicing plan (the “Distribution and Servicing Plan”). On November 14, 2022, the Board approved amending the Distribution and Servicing Plan to update the effective date to October 29, 2021, the Registration Statement effective date. The following table shows the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees the Company will pay the Intermediary Manager with respect to the Class S, Class D and Class I on an annualized basis as a percentage of the Company’s NAV for such class. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution monthly in arrears, calculated using the NAV of the applicable class as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month.

Subject to FINRA and other limitations on underwriting compensation, the Company will pay a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.85% per annum of the Company’s net assets attributable to Class S shares as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month and a shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee equal to 0.25% per annum of the Company’s net assets attributable to Class D shares as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month.

 

 

 

Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution
Fee as a % of NAV

 

Class S shares

 

 

0.85

%

Class D shares

 

 

0.25

%

Class I shares

 

 

0.00

%

 

The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees is paid monthly in arrears, calculated using the NAV of the applicable class as of the beginning of the first calendar day of the month and subject to FINRA and other limitations on underwriting compensation. For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company accrued distribution and shareholder servicing fees of $1,172, $2, and $0 for Class S, Class D and Class I shares, respectively.

The Intermediary Manager will reallow (pay) all or a portion of the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to participating brokers and servicing brokers for ongoing shareholder services performed by such brokers, and will waive shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees to the extent a broker is not eligible to receive it for failure to provide such services. Because the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees with respect to Class S shares and Class D shares are calculated based on the aggregate NAV for all of the outstanding shares of each such class, it reduces the NAV with respect to all shares of each such class, including shares issued under the Company’s distribution reinvestment plan.

Eligibility to receive the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee is conditioned on a broker providing the following ongoing services with respect to the Class S or Class D shares: assistance with recordkeeping, answering investor inquiries regarding us, including regarding distribution payments and reinvestments, helping investors understand their investments upon their request, and assistance with share repurchase requests. If the applicable broker is not eligible to receive the shareholder servicing and/or distribution fee due to failure to provide these services, the Intermediary Manager will waive the shareholder servicing fee and/or distribution that broker would have otherwise been eligible to receive. The shareholder servicing and/or distribution fees are ongoing fees that are not paid at the time of purchase.

Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement

The Company entered into an expense support and conditional reimbursement agreement (the “Expense Support Agreement”) with the Adviser. The Adviser may elect to pay certain expenses (each, an “Expense Payment”), provided that no portion of the payment will be used to pay any interest or distributions and/or shareholder servicing fees of the Company. Any Expense Payment that the Adviser has committed to pay must be paid by the Adviser to the Company in any combination of cash or other immediately available funds no later than forty-five days after such commitment was made in writing, and/or offset against amounts due from the Company to the Adviser or its affiliates.

Following any calendar month in which Available Operating Funds (as defined below) exceed the cumulative distributions accrued to the Company’s shareholders based on distributions declared with respect to record dates occurring in such calendar month (the amount of such excess being hereinafter referred to as “Excess Operating Funds”), the Company shall pay such Excess Operating Funds, or a portion thereof, to the Adviser until such time as all Expense Payments made by the Adviser to the Company within three years prior to the last business day of such calendar month have been reimbursed. Any payments required to be made by the Company shall be referred to herein as a “Reimbursement Payment”. “Available Operating Funds” means the sum of (i) net investment company taxable income (including net short-term capital gains reduced by net long-term capital losses), (ii) net capital gains (including the excess of net long-term capital gains over net short-term capital losses) and (iii) dividends and other distributions paid on account of investments in portfolio companies (to the extent such amounts listed in clause (iii) are not included under clauses (i) and (ii) above).

 

108


Table of Contents

 

No Reimbursement Payment for any month will be made if: (1) the “Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share” (as defined below) declared by the Company at the time of such Reimbursement Payment is less than the Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share at the time the Expense Payment was made to which such Reimbursement Payment relates, or (2) our “Operating Expense Ratio” (as defined below) at the time of such Reimbursement Payment is greater than the Operating Expense Ratio at the time the Expense Payment was made to which such Reimbursement Payment relates. Pursuant to the Expense Support Agreement, “Effective Rate of Distributions Per Share” means the annualized rate (based on a 365 day year) of regular cash distributions per share exclusive of returns of capital, distribution rate reductions due to distribution and shareholder fees, and declared special dividends or special distributions, if any. The “Operating Expense Ratio” is calculated by dividing Operating Expenses, less organizational and offering expenses, base management and incentive fees owed to Adviser, and interest expense, by our net assets.

The Company’s obligation to make a Reimbursement Payment shall automatically become a liability of the Company on the last business day of the applicable calendar month, except to the extent the Adviser has waived its right to receive such payment for the applicable month.

The following table presents a summary of all expenses supported, and recouped, by the Adviser:

 

For the Month Ended

 

Amount of Expense Support

 

 

Recoupment of Expense Support

 

 

Unreimbursed Expense Support

 

 

Reimbursement Eligibility Expiration

 

Effective Rate of Distribution per Share

 

Operating Expense Ratio

January 31, 2022

 

$

 

1,677

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

1,677

 

 

January 31, 2025

 

5.12%

 

1.36%

February 28, 2022

 

 

 

867

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

867

 

 

February 28, 2025

 

7.42%

 

0.86%

March 31, 2022

 

 

 

111

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

111

 

 

March 31, 2025

 

6.71%

 

0.68%

April 30, 2022

 

 

 

1,778

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,778

 

 

April 30, 2025

 

6.96%

 

0.60%

 

 

$

 

4,433

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

4,433

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Adviser made Expense Payments in the amount of $4,433. For the year ended December 31, 2022, there were no Reimbursement Payments made to the Adviser.

Co-Investment Activity

We may co-invest on a concurrent basis with affiliates of ours, subject to compliance with applicable regulations and our allocation procedures. Certain types of negotiated co-investments may be made only in accordance with the Order from the SEC permitting us to do so. Under the terms of the Order, a “required majority” (as defined in Section 57(o) of the 1940 Act) of our independent trustees must be able to reach certain conclusions in connection with a co-investment transaction, including that (1) the terms of the proposed transaction are reasonable and fair to us and our shareholders and do not involve overreaching of us or our shareholders on the part of any person concerned, and (2) the transaction is consistent with the interests of our shareholders and is consistent with our Board of Trustees’ approved criteria. In certain situations where co-investment with one or more funds managed by the Adviser or its affiliates is not covered by the Order, the personnel of the Adviser or its affiliates will need to decide which fund will proceed with the investment. Such personnel will make these determinations based on allocation policies and procedures, which are designed to reasonably ensure that investment opportunities are allocated fairly and equitably among affiliated funds over time and in a manner that is consistent with applicable laws, rules and regulations. The Order is subject to certain terms and conditions so there can be no assurance that we will be permitted to co-invest with certain of our affiliates other than in the circumstances currently permitted by regulatory guidance and the Order.

As of December 31, 2022, the Company’s co-investment holdings were 39.1% of the portfolio or $4,308,895, measured at fair value. On a cost basis, 37.8% of the portfolio or $4,427,513 were co-investments. As of December 31, 2021, the Company did not own any investments.

Escrow Agreement

On October 14, 2021, the Company entered into an escrow agreement (the “Escrow Agreement”) with UMB Bank, N.A. The Company received purchase orders and held investors’ funds in an interest-bearing escrow account until it received purchase orders for at least $100 million (excluding any shares purchased by the Adviser, its affiliates and the Company’s trustees and officers but including any shares purchased in any private offerings), and the Board authorized the release of the escrowed purchase order proceeds to the Company, which occurred on January 7, 2022.

 

109


Table of Contents

 

Note 4. Investments


Fair Value Measurement and Disclosures

The following table shows the composition of our investment as of December 31, 2022, with the fair value disaggregated into the three levels of the fair value hierarchy in accordance with ASC 820:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Hierarchy

 

 

 

Cost

 

 

Fair Value

 

 

Level 1

 

 

Level 2

 

 

Level 3

 

First Lien Secured Debt

 

$

 

4,357,934

 

 

$

 

4,266,966

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

1,436,996

 

 

$

 

2,829,970

 

Unsecured Debt

 

 

 

69,276

 

 

 

 

41,665

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

41,665

 

 

 

 

 

Common Equity/Interests

 

 

 

200

 

 

 

 

205

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

205

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

56

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

56

 

Total Investments before Cash Equivalents

 

$

 

4,427,510

 

 

$

 

4,308,892

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

1,478,661

 

 

$

 

2,830,231

 

Money Market Fund

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

Total Cash Equivalents

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

Total Investments after Cash Equivalents

 

$

 

4,427,514

 

 

$

 

4,308,896

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

1,478,661

 

 

$

 

2,830,231

 

Interest rate swaps

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

(460

)

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

(460

)

 

$

 

 

Foreign currency forward transactions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

249

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

249

 

 

 

 

 

Total Assets and Liabilities at Fair Value

 

$

 

4,427,514

 

 

$

 

4,308,685

 

 

$

 

4

 

 

$

 

1,478,450

 

 

$

 

2,830,231

 

The following tables shows changes in the fair value of our Level 3 investments during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2022

 

 

 

First Lien
Secured Debt

 

 

Unsecured
Debt

 

 

Common Equity/Interests

 

 

Preferred Equity

 

 

Total

 

Fair value as of December 31, 2021

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

Net realized gains (losses)

 

 

 

4,760

 

 

 

 

182

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,942

 

Net change in unrealized gains (losses)

 

 

 

(4,283

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5

 

 

 

 

(43

)

 

 

 

(4,321

)

Net amortization on investments

 

 

 

4,293

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,293

 

Purchases, including capitalized PIK (2)

 

 

 

3,251,033

 

 

 

 

19,958

 

 

 

 

200

 

 

 

 

99

 

 

 

 

3,271,290

 

Sales

 

 

 

(425,833

)

 

 

 

(20,140

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(445,973

)

Transfers out of Level 3 (1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Transfers into Level 3 (1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value as of December 31, 2022

 

$

 

2,829,970

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

205

 

 

$

 

56

 

 

$

 

2,830,231

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on Level 3 investments still held as of December 31, 2022

 

$

 

(4,283

)

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

5

 

 

$

 

(43

)

 

$

 

(4,321

)

(1)
Transfers out (if any) of Level 3 are due to an increase in the quantity and reliability of broker quotes obtained and transfers into (if any) Level 3 are due to a decrease in the quantity and reliability of broker quotes obtained as assessed by the Investment Adviser. Transfers are assumed to have occurred at the end of the period. There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements during the periods shown.
(2)
Includes unfunded commitments measured at fair value of $(5,149).

 

 

110


Table of Contents

 

The following table summarizes the significant unobservable inputs the Company used to value its investments categorized within Level 3 as of December 31, 2022. In addition to the techniques and inputs noted in the tables below, according to our valuation policy we may also use other valuation techniques and methodologies when determining our fair value measurements. The below table is not intended to be all-inclusive, but rather provide information on the significant unobservable inputs as they relate to the Company’s determination of fair values.

The unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of our Level 3 investments as of December 31, 2022 were as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements

Asset Category

 

Fair Value

 

 

Valuation Techniques/Methodologies

Unobservable Input

Range

Weighted Average (1)

First Lien Secured Debt

$

 

2,279,041

 

 

Discounted Cash Flow

Discount Rate

8.7%

-

14.5%

10.7%

 

 

 

550,929

 

 

Transactional Value

Cost

N/A

 

N/A

N/A

Common Equity/Interests

 

 

205

 

 

Recent Transaction

Recent Transaction

N/A

 

N/A

N/A

Preferred Equity

 

 

56

 

 

Recent Transaction

Recent Transaction

N/A

 

N/A

N/A

Total Level 3 Investments

$

 

2,830,231

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)
The weighted average information is generally derived by assigning each disclosed unobservable input a proportionate weight based on the fair value of the related investment. For the commodity price unobservable input, the weighted average price is an undiscounted price based upon the estimated production level from the underlying reserves.

The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of the Company’s debt and equity securities are primarily earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”) comparable multiples and market discount rates. The Company typically uses EBITDA comparable multiples on its equity securities to determine the fair value of investments. The Company uses market discount rates for debt securities to determine if the effective yield on a debt security is commensurate with the market yields for that type of debt security. If a debt security’s effective yield is significantly less than the market yield for a similar debt security with a similar credit profile, the resulting fair value of the debt security may be lower. For certain investments where fair value is derived based on a recovery analysis, the Company uses underlying commodity prices from third party market pricing services to determine the fair value and/or recoverable amount, which represents the proceeds expected to be collected through asset sales or liquidation. Further, for certain investments, the Company also considered the probability of future events which are not in management’s control. Significant increases or decreases in any of these inputs in isolation would result in a significantly lower or higher fair value measurement. The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of the structured products include the discount rate applied in the valuation models in addition to default and recovery rates applied to projected cash flows in the valuation models. Specifically, when a discounted cash flow model is used to determine fair value, the significant input used in the valuation model is the discount rate applied to present value the projected cash flows. Increases in the discount rate can significantly lower the fair value of an investment; conversely decreases in the discount rate can significantly increase the fair value of an investment. The discount rate is determined based on the market rates an investor would expect for a similar investment with similar risks.

Investment Transactions

For the year ended December 31, 2022, purchases of investments on a trade date basis were $6,606,772. For the year ended December 31, 2022, sales and repayments (including prepayments and unamortized fees) of investments on a trade date basis were $2,170,237.

PIK Income

The Company holds loans and other investments, including certain preferred equity investments, that have contractual PIK income. PIK income computed at the contractual rate is accrued into income and reflected as receivable up to the capitalization date. During the year ended December 31, 2022, PIK income earned was $5,467.

The following table shows the change in capitalized PIK balance for the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

PIK balance at beginning of period

$

 

 

PIK income capitalized

 

 

5,333

 

Adjustments due to investments exited or written off

 

 

 

PIK income received in cash

 

 

 

PIK balance at end of period

$

 

5,333

 

 

 

111


Table of Contents

 

 

Note 5. Derivative Instruments

 

In the normal course of business, the Company enters into derivative financial instruments in the normal course of business to achieve certain risk management objectives, including managing its interest rate and foreign currency risk exposures.

 

Certain information related to the Company’s foreign currency forward contracts is presented below as of December 31, 2022.

Counterparty

 

Notional amount to be purchased

 

 

Notional amount to be sold

 

 

Settlement Date

 

Fair Value

 

 

Balance Sheet Location of Net Amounts

State Street Bank and Trust Company

$

 

3,440

 

 

 ₣

 

3,160

 

 

3/15/2023

 

$

 

(5

)

 

Unrealized appreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

State Street Bank and Trust Company

 

 

1,903

 

 

 €

 

1,790

 

 

3/15/2023

 

 

 

(8

)

 

Unrealized appreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

State Street Bank and Trust Company

 

 

10,562

 

 

 €

 

9,820

 

 

3/31/2023

 

 

 

(22

)

 

Unrealized appreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

State Street Bank and Trust Company

 

 

14,813

 

 

 £

 

12,010

 

 

3/15/2023

 

 

 

283

 

 

Unrealized appreciation on foreign currency forward contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

249

 

 

 

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

Certain information related to the Company’s interest rate swaps is presented below as of December 31, 2022.

 

Counterparty

 

Notional Amount

 

 

Maturity Date

 

Fair Value

 

 

Financial Statement Location of Net Amounts

Goldman Sachs International

$

 

62,000

 

 

12/21/2025

 

$

 

(36

)

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

Goldman Sachs International

 

 

 

38,000

 

 

1/19/2026

 

 

 

(105

)

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

Goldman Sachs International

 

 

 

82,000

 

 

12/21/2027

 

 

 

(231

)

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

Goldman Sachs International

 

 

 

18,000

 

 

1/19/2028

 

 

 

(88

)

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 $

 

(460

)

 

 

 

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

 

112


Table of Contents

 

The Company’s foreign currency forward contracts are not designated in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship. Net realized and unrealized gains and losses for the year ended December 31, 2022, for the Company’s foreign currency forward contracts, are in the following locations in the Consolidated Statement of Operations:

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

Derivative Instrument

 

Financial Statement Location

 

2022

 

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

Net realized gain(loss) on foreign currency forward contracts

 

$

 

489

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

489

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

Derivative Instrument

 

Financial Statement Location

 

2022

 

Foreign currency forward contracts

 

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on foreign currency forward contracts

 

$

 

249

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

249

 

 

The Company’s interest rate swaps have been designated in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship. Net realized and unrealized gains and losses for the year ended December 31, 2022, for the Company’s interest rate swaps, are in the following locations in the Consolidated Statement of Operations:

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

Financial Statement Location

 

 

2022

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

$

 

506

 

 

Interest and other debt expenses

Hedged items

 

 

 

(460

)

 

Interest and other debt expenses

 

Offsetting of Derivative Instruments

 

The Company has derivative instruments that are subject to master netting agreements. These agreements include provisions to offset positions with the same counterparty in the event of default by one of the parties. The Company’s unrealized appreciation and depreciation on derivative instruments are reported net in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. The Company does not have any collateral available for netting as of December 31, 2022.

 

113


Table of Contents

 

 

Note 6. Debt and Foreign Currency Transactions and Translations

In accordance with the 1940 Act, with certain limitations, the Company is allowed to borrow amounts such that its asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, is at least 150% after such borrowing. As of December 31, 2022, the Company’s asset coverage was 199.2%.

The Company’s outstanding debt obligations were as follows:

 

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

 

Aggregate Principal Committed

 

 

Outstanding Principal

 

 

Carrying Value (4)

 

 

Fair
Value
(3)

 

 

Unused
Portion
(1)

 

 

Amount
Available
 (2)

 

Revolving Credit Facility

 

$

 

2,085,000

 

 

 

 

976,462

 

 

 

 

976,462

 

 

 

 

971,776

 

 

 

 

1,108,538

 

 

 

 

722,012

 

Cardinal Funding LLC

 

 

 

800,000

 

 

 

 

498,731

 

 

 

 

498,731

 

 

 

 

495,510

 

 

 

 

301,269

 

 

 

 

163,459

 

Mallard Funding LLC

 

 

 

500,000

 

 

 

 

416,395

 

 

 

 

416,395

 

 

 

 

416,012

 

 

 

 

83,605

 

 

 

 

82,813

 

Grouse Funding LLC

 

 

 

250,000

 

 

 

 

158,000

 

 

 

 

158,000

 

 

 

 

158,000

 

 

 

 

92,000

 

 

 

 

42,157

 

2025 Notes

 

 

 

62,000

 

 

 

 

62,000

 

 

 

 

61,964

 

 

 

 

61,964

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2026 Notes

 

 

 

38,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(105

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

38,000

 

 

 

 

 

2027 Notes

 

 

 

82,000

 

 

 

 

82,000

 

 

 

 

81,769

 

 

 

 

81,769

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2028 Notes

 

 

 

18,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(88

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

18,000

 

 

 

 

 

Total Debt Obligations

 

$

 

3,835,000

 

 

 $

 

2,193,588

 

 

 $

 

2,193,128

 

 

 $

 

2,185,031

 

 

 $

 

1,641,412

 

 

 $

 

1,010,441

 

Deferred Financing Costs and Debt Discount

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(20,508

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Debt Obligations, net of Deferred
Financing Cost and Debt Discount

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,172,620

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)
The unused portion is the amount upon which commitment fees, if any, are based.
(2)
The amount available reflects any limitations related to each respective credit facility’s borrowing base.
(3)
The fair value of these debt obligations would be categorized as Level 3 under ASC 820 as of December 31, 2022. The valuation is based on a yield analysis and discount rate commensurate with the market yields for similar types of debt.
(4)
Negative values represent adjustments to debt valuation in connection with gain/losses on interest rate swap valuation on qualifying hedge accounting relationships. Please see Note 5 for additional details.

The following table summarizes the average and maximum debt outstanding, and the interest and debt issuance cost for the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2022

 

Average debt outstanding

 

$

 

1,454,755

 

Maximum amount of debt outstanding

 

 

 

2,426,186

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average annualized interest cost (1)

 

 

 

4.57

%

Annualized amortized debt issuance cost

 

 

 

0.27

%

Total annualized interest cost

 

 

 

4.84

%

 

 

 

 

 

Average 1-month SOFR rate

 

 

 

2.36

%

 

(1)
Includes the stated interest expense and commitment fees on the unused portion of the Senior Secured Facility. Commitment fees for the year ended December 31, 2022 were $6,746.

 

114


Table of Contents

 

The components of interest expense were as follows:

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

Borrowing interest expense

$

 

58,951

 

Facility unused fees

 

 

6,746

 

Amortization of financing costs and debt issuance costs

 

 

3,907

 

Gain (loss) from interest rate swaps accounted for as hedges and the related hedged items

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

 

506

 

Hedged items

 

 

(460

)

Total interest expense

$

 

69,650

 

 

Senior Secured Facility

On March 11, 2022, the Company entered into a senior secured, multi-currency, revolving credit facility (the “Senior Secured Facility”) with J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, N.A. The aggregate lender commitments under the Senior Secured Facility on March 11, 2022 were $1.835 billion. On June 7, 2022, the Company entered into an amendment to its Senior Secured Facility to increase the multicurrency commitments from $1.835 billion to $2.085 billion. The Company may seek additional commitments from new and existing lenders in the future, up to an aggregate facility size not to exceed approximately $2.753 billion. The scheduled maturity date of the Facility is March 11, 2027.

Loans under the Facility denominated in US dollars will bear interest, at the Company’s option, at the base rate plus a spread of 0.75% to 0.875% or the term SOFR rate plus a credit spread adjustment of 0.10% and spread of 1.75% to 1.875%, in each case, with such spread being determined based on the total amount of the Gross Borrowing Base relative to the total Covered Debt Amount, as of the date of determination. Loans under the Facility denominated in currencies other than US dollars will bear interest at certain local rates consistent with market standards. Interest is due and payable in arrears quarterly for loans bearing interest at the base rate and at the end of the applicable interest period in the case of loans bearing interest at the term SOFR rate (or at each three month interval in the case of loans with interest periods greater than three months). The Company is also obligated to pay other customary closing fees, arrangement fees, administration fees, commitment fees and letter of credit fees for a credit facility of this size and type.

The Company’s obligations to the lenders under the Revolving Credit Facility are secured by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the Company’s assets.

In connection with the Revolving Credit Facility, the Company has made certain customary representations and warranties and is required to comply with various covenants, reporting requirements and other customary requirements for similar facilities. In addition, the Company must comply with the following financial covenants: (a) the Company must maintain a minimum shareholders’ equity, measured as of each fiscal quarter end; and (b) the Company must maintain at all times a 150% asset coverage ratio.

The Revolving Credit Facility contains customary events of default for similar financing transactions. Upon the occurrence and during the continuation of an event of default, J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, N.A. may terminate the commitments and declare the outstanding advances and all other obligations under the Revolving Credit Facility immediately due and payable.

As of December 31, 2022, the Company was in compliance with all covenants and other requirements of the Revolving Credit Facility.

SPV Financing Facilities

The following wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company have entered into secured financing facilities, as described below: Cardinal Funding LLC, Mallard Funding LLC, and Grouse Funding LLC, which are collectively referred to as the “SPVs”, and the secured financing facilities described below are collectively referred to as the “SPV Financing Facilities”.

 

The obligations of each SPV to the lenders under the applicable SPV Financing Facility are secured by a first priority security interest in all of the applicable SPV’s portfolio investments and cash. The obligations of each SPV under the applicable SPV Financing Facility are non-recourse to the Company, and the Company’s exposure to the credit facility is limited to the value of its investment in the applicable SPV.

 

In connection with the SPV Financing Facilities, the applicable SPV has made certain customary representations and warranties and is required to comply with various covenants, reporting requirements and other customary requirements for similar facilities. Each SPV Financing Facility contains customary events of default for similar financing transactions, including if a change of control of the applicable SPV occurs. Upon the occurrence and during the continuation of an event of default, the lenders under the applicable SPV Financing Facility may declare the outstanding advances and all other obligations under the applicable SPV Financing Facility immediately due and payable. The occurrence of an event of default (as described above) triggers a requirement that the applicable SPV obtain the consent of the lenders under the applicable SPV Financing Facility prior to entering into any sale or disposition with respect to portfolio investments.

As of December 31, 2022, the Company was in compliance with all covenants and other requirements of the SPV Financing Facilities.

 

115


Table of Contents

 

Cardinal Funding LLC

On January 7, 2022, Cardinal Funding LLC (“Cardinal Funding”), a Delaware limited liability company and newly formed subsidiary of the Company, entered into a Credit and Security Agreement (the “Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility”), with Cardinal Funding, as borrower, the Company, in its capacity as collateral manager and in its capacity as equity holder, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent, and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as collateral agent, custodian and collateral administrator.

The maximum principal amount of the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility as of the Closing Date is $500 million, which can be drawn in multiple currencies subject to certain conditions; the availability of this amount is subject to the borrowing base, which is determined on the basis of the value and types of Cardinal Funding’s assets from time to time, and satisfaction of certain conditions, including certain concentration limits. Amounts drawn under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility, will bear interest at the Term SOFR Reference Rate, the CDOR Rate, SONIA or the EURIBOR Rate (the “Applicable Reference Rate”), in each case, plus a margin. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of broadly syndicated loans under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 1.70%. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of private credit loans under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 2.20%. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of any other eligible loans under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 2.45%. After the expiration of a three-year reinvestment period, the applicable margin on outstanding advances will be increased by 0.50% per annum. All amounts outstanding under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility must be repaid by the date that is five years after the closing date of the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility. The contractual maturity date of the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility is January 7, 2027.

On April 7, 2022, Cardinal Funding, entered into Amendment No. 1 (the “First Cardinal Funding Amendment”), by and among Cardinal Funding, as borrower, the Company, in its capacity as collateral manager and in its capacity as equity holder, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent, and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as collateral agent, custodian and collateral administrator.

The First Cardinal Funding Amendment amends the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility to (i) increase the additional aggregate commitment size which Cardinal Funding can request from the lenders under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility from $750,000,000 to $1,350,000,000, (ii) add a new revolving lender to the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility and (iii) allow Cardinal Funding to finance bonds under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility. Advances used to finance bonds under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 2.0%.

On December 9, 2022, Cardinal Funding entered into Amendment No. 4 (the “Forth Cardinal Funding Amendment”) by and among Cardinal Funding, as borrower, the Company, in its capacity as collateral manager and in its capacity as equity holder, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent, and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as collateral agent, custodian and collateral administrator.

The Fourth Cardinal Funding Amendment amends the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility to (i) increase the aggregate commitment under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility from $500,000,000 to $800,000,000 and (ii) modify the interest rate charged under the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility. Advances made with respect to “Private Credit Loans” (as defined in the Cardinal Funding Secured Credit Facility) will, prior to the Commitment Termination Date, bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 2.75% and, following the Commitment Termination Date, bear interest at the Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of 3.25%.

Mallard Funding LLC

On January 7, 2022, Mallard Funding LLC (“Mallard Funding”), a Delaware limited liability company and newly formed subsidiary of the Company, entered into a Loan and Servicing Agreement (the “Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement”), with Mallard Funding, as borrower, the Company, in its capacity as servicer and in its capacity as transferor, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., as administrative agent, and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as collateral agent, account bank and collateral custodian.

The maximum principal amount of the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement as of the Closing Date is $500 million, which can be drawn in multiple currencies subject to certain conditions; the availability of this amount is subject to the borrowing base, which is determined on the basis of the value and types of Mallard Funding’s assets from time to time, and satisfaction of certain conditions, including certain concentration limits. Under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement, Mallard Funding is permitted to borrow amounts in U.S. dollars or certain other permitted currencies. Amounts drawn under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement, will bear interest at Adjusted Term SOFR, the CDOR Rate, Daily Simple SONIA or the EURIBOR Rate (the “Mallard Funding Applicable Reference Rate”), in each case, plus a margin. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of broadly syndicated loans under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement bear interest at the Mallard Funding Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of (x) during the nine months subsequent to the Closing Date (the "Ramp-Up Period"), 1.60%, (y) after the end of the Ramp-Up Period and prior to the Mallard Funding Commitment Termination Date (as defined by the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement), 2.00% and (z) after the Mallard Funding Commitment Termination Date, 2.25%. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of middle market loans under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement initially bear interest at the Mallard Funding Applicable Reference Rate plus a spread of (x) prior to the Mallard Funding Commitment Termination Date, 2.00% and (y) after the Mallard Funding Commitment Termination Date, 2.25%. All amounts outstanding under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement must be repaid by the date that is five years after the closing date of the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement. The contractual maturity date under the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement is January 7, 2027.

116


Table of Contents

 

On March 18, 2022, Mallard Funding entered into Amendment No. 1 (the “First Mallard Funding Amendment”), by and among Mallard Funding, as borrower, the Company, in its capacity as servicer and as transferor, each lender party thereto, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., as administrative agent, and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as collateral agent, account bank and collateral custodian. The First Mallard Funding Amendment amends the Mallard Funding Loan and Servicing Agreement to (i) allow Mallard Funding to borrow amounts in Australian dollars and (ii) allow amounts drawn to bear interest at the BBSY Rate.

Grouse Funding LLC

On July 7, 2022 (the “Closing Date”), Grouse Funding LLC (“Grouse Funding”), a Delaware limited liability company and newly formed subsidiary of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, a Delaware statutory trust (the “Company” or “us”), entered into a Credit Agreement (the “Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility”), with Grouse Funding, as borrower, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Goldman Sachs Bank USA, as syndication agent and administrative agent, State Street Bank and Trust Company, as collateral agent and collateral custodian, and Virtus Group, LP, as collateral administrator.

 

From time to time, the Company expects to sell and contribute certain investments to Grouse Funding pursuant to a Sale and Contribution Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, by and between the Company and Grouse Funding. No gain or loss will be recognized as a result of the contribution. Proceeds from the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility will be used to finance the origination and acquisition of eligible assets by Grouse Funding, including the purchase of such assets from the Company. We retain a residual interest in assets contributed to or acquired by Grouse Funding through our ownership of Grouse Funding. The maximum principal amount of the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility as of the Closing Date is $250 million, which can be drawn in U.S. Dollars subject to certain conditions; the availability of this amount is subject to the borrowing base, which is determined on the basis of the value and types of Grouse Funding’s assets from time to time, and satisfaction of certain conditions, including certain concentration limits.

 

The Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility provides for the ability to draw and redraw revolving loans under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility for a period of up to three years after the Closing Date unless the commitments are terminated sooner as provided in the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility (the “Commitment Termination Date”). Unless otherwise terminated, the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility will mature on the date which is five years after the Closing Date (the “Final Maturity Date”). Prior to the Commitment Termination Date, proceeds received by Grouse Funding from principal and interest, dividends, or fees on assets must be used to pay fees, expenses and interest on outstanding borrowings, and the excess may be returned to the Company, subject to certain conditions. Following the Commitment Termination Date but prior to the Final Maturity Date, proceeds received by Grouse Funding from principal and interest, dividends, or fees on assets must be used to pay fees, expenses and interest on outstanding borrowings, as well as principal on outstanding borrowings in accordance with the terms of the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility, and the excess may be returned to the Company, subject to certain conditions. On the Final Maturity Date, Grouse Funding must pay in full all outstanding fees and expenses and all principal and interest on outstanding borrowings, and the excess may be returned to the Company.

 

Under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility, Grouse Funding is permitted to borrow amounts in U.S. dollars. Amounts drawn under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility will bear interest at Term SOFR plus a margin. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of broadly syndicated loans under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at Term SOFR plus a spread of 2.40%, except that following the application of a rebate amount the spread on broadly syndicated loans shall be 1.85%. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of bonds or loans that are not broadly syndicated loans, that in either case have an EBITDA of $100 million or above, under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at Term SOFR plus a spread of 2.15%. Advances used to finance the purchase or origination of any other eligible loans or bonds under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility initially bear interest at Term SOFR plus a spread of 2.40%. The Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility contains customary covenants, including certain limitations on the activities of Grouse Funding, including limitations on incurrence of incremental indebtedness, and customary events of default. The Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility is secured by a perfected first priority security interest in the assets of Grouse Funding and on any payments received by Grouse Funding in respect of those assets. Assets pledged to the lenders under the Grouse Funding Secured Credit Facility will not be available to pay the debts of the Company.

 

 

117


Table of Contents

 

Private Placement Bonds

 

On November 15, 2022, the Company priced an offering of $200 million in aggregate principal amount of Senior Unsecured Notes (the “Notes”) to institutional investors in a private placement. The Notes are comprised of $62 million Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025 (the “2025 Notes”), $38 million Senior Unsecured Notes due 2026 (the “2026 Notes”), $82 million Senior Unsecured Notes due 2027 (the “2027 Notes”), and $18 million Senior Unsecured Notes due 2028 (the “2028 Notes”). The issuances of the Notes are expected to close in two installments on December 21, 2022 and January 19, 2023. The 2025 and 2026 Notes have a fixed interest rate of 8.21% per annum and are due on December 21, 2025 or January 19, 2026, respectively. The 2027 and 2028 Notes have a fixed interest rate of 8.31% per annum and are due on December 21, 2027 or January 19, 2028, respectively. Interest on the Notes is due and payable semiannually. These interest rates are subject to increase (up to a maximum increase of 1.00% above the stated rate for each of the 2025 Notes, 2026 Notes, 2027 Notes and the 2028 Notes) in the event that, subject to certain exceptions, the Notes cease to have an investment grade rating. There is no guarantee of the successful placement of the Notes or that the closing of the Notes will occur as anticipated.

 

In connection with the Notes, the Company entered into interest rate swaps to more closely align the interest rates of the Company’s liabilities with the Company’s investment portfolio, which consists of predominately floating rate loans.

 

Under the interest rate swap agreement related to the 2025 Notes, the Company receives a fixed interest rate of 4.02% per annum and pays a floating interest rate at a rate determined by three-month SOFR per annum on $62 million of the 2025 Notes.

 

Under the interest rate swap agreement related to the 2026 Notes, the Company receives a fixed interest rate of 3.97% per annum and pays a floating interest rate at a rate determined by three-month SOFR per annum on $38 million of the 2026 Notes.

 

Under the interest rate swap agreement related to the 2027 Notes, the Company receives a fixed interest rate of 3.67% per annum and pays a floating interest rate at a rate determined by three-month SOFR per annum on $82 million of the 2027 Notes.

 

Under the interest rate swap agreement related to the 2028 Notes, the Company receives a fixed interest rate of 3.65% per annum and pays a floating interest rate at a rate determined by three-month SOFR per annum on $18 million of the 2028 Notes.

 

The Company designated each interest rate swap as the hedging instrument in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship.

Foreign Currency Transactions and Translations

The Company had the following foreign-denominated debt obligations outstanding on its Senior Secured Facility and SPV Financing Facilities as of December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

Original Principal Amount (Local)

 

 

Original Principal Amount (USD)

 

 

Principal Amount Outstanding

 

 

Unrealized Gain/(Loss)

 

 

Reset Date

British Pound

 

£

 

76,000

 

 

 

 

92,180

 

 

 

 

91,880

 

 

 

 

300

 

 

 

1/31/2023

British Pound

 

£

 

6,200

 

 

 

 

8,408

 

 

 

 

7,495

 

 

 

 

913

 

 

 

2/1/2023

British Pound

 

£

 

3,500

 

 

 

 

4,747

 

 

 

 

4,231

 

 

 

 

516

 

 

 

1/31/2023

Australian Dollar

 

A$

 

10,000

 

 

 

 

7,402

 

 

 

 

6,809

 

 

 

 

593

 

 

 

1/31/2023

European Euro

 

 

277,000

 

 

 

 

282,015

 

 

 

 

296,515

 

 

 

 

(14,500

)

 

 

1/31/2023

Swedish Krona

 

kr

 

34,000

 

 

 

 

3,237

 

 

 

 

3,258

 

 

 

 

(21

)

 

 

1/31/2023

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

397,989

 

 

 

 

410,188

 

 

 

 

(12,199

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

118


Table of Contents

 

Note 7. Net Assets

The Company has the authority to issue an unlimited number of common shares of beneficial interest at $0.01 per share par value.

On July 22, 2021, an affiliate of the Adviser purchased 2,000 shares of the Company’s Class I common shares at $25.00 per share.

On January 7, 2022, the Company had satisfied the minimum offering requirement, and the Company’s Board authorized the release of proceeds from escrow. As of such date, the Company issued and sold 26,258,912 shares (consisting all of Class I shares at an offering price of $25.00 per share; no Class S or Class D shares were issued or sold as of such date), and the escrow agent released net proceeds of approximately $656,473 to the Company as payment for such shares.

The following table summarizes transactions in common shares of beneficial interest during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2022

 

 

Shares

 

 

Amount

 

Class S:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

 

 

10,647,136

 

 

$

 

254,686

 

Repurchase of common shares

 

 

(10,696

)

 

 

 

(246

)

Early repurchase deduction

 

 

 

 

 

 

5

 

Distributions reinvested

 

 

191,299

 

 

 

 

4,463

 

Net increase (decrease)

 

 

10,827,739

 

 

$

 

258,908

 

Class D:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

 

 

106,799

 

 

$

 

2,495

 

Repurchase of common shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Early repurchase deduction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Distributions reinvested

 

 

144

 

 

 

 

3

 

Net increase (decrease)

 

 

106,943

 

 

$

 

2,498

 

Class I:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from shares sold

 

 

82,003,196

 

 

$

 

2,012,264

 

Repurchase of common shares

 

 

(2,103,502

)

 

 

 

(48,721

)

Early repurchase deduction

 

 

 

 

 

 

587

 

Distributions reinvested

 

 

2,041,377

 

 

 

 

48,127

 

Net increase (decrease)

 

 

81,941,071

 

 

$

 

2,012,257

 

Total net increase (decrease)

 

 

92,875,753

 

 

$

 

2,273,663

 

 

119


Table of Contents

 

Net Asset Value per Share and Offering Price

The Company determines NAV for each class of shares as of the last day of each calendar month. Share issuances related to monthly subscriptions are effective the first calendar day of each month. Shares are issued at an offering price equivalent to the most recent NAV per share available for each share class, which will be the prior calendar day NAV per share (i.e. the prior month-end NAV). The following table summarizes each month-end NAV per share for Class S, Class D and Class I common shares during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

NAV Per Share

 

For the Month Ended

 

Class S

 

 

Class D

 

 

Class I

 

January 31, 2022

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

25.04

 

February 28, 2022

 

 

 

24.74

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.74

 

March 31, 2022

 

 

 

24.71

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.71

 

April 30, 2022

 

 

 

24.63

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

24.63

 

May 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.72

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

23.72

 

June 30, 2022

 

 

 

22.87

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22.87

 

July 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.43

 

 

 

 

23.43

 

 

 

 

23.43

 

August 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.55

 

 

 

 

23.55

 

 

 

 

23.55

 

September 30, 2022

 

 

 

22.97

 

 

 

 

22.97

 

 

 

 

22.97

 

October 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.07

 

 

 

 

23.07

 

 

 

 

23.07

 

November 30, 2022

 

 

 

23.13

 

 

 

 

23.13

 

 

 

 

23.13

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

 

23.20

 

 

 

 

23.20

 

 

 

 

23.20

 

 

Distributions

The Board authorizes and declares monthly distribution amounts per share of Class S, Class D and Class I common shares. The following table presents distributions that were declared during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class S Distributions

 

 

Class D Distributions

 

 

Class I Distributions

 

Declaration Date

 

Record Date

 

Payment Date

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount*

 

January 31, 2022

 

January 31, 2022

 

March 7, 2022

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

 

 

$

 

0.1045

 

 

$

 

2,744

 

February 28, 2022

 

February 28, 2022

 

April 1, 2022

 

 

 

0.1245

 

 

 

 

22

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

6,096

 

March 29, 2022

 

March 29, 2022

 

April 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1229

 

 

 

 

225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

7,472

 

April 21, 2022

 

April 30, 2022

 

May 26, 2022

 

 

 

0.1235

 

 

 

 

426

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

8,388

 

May 20, 2022

 

May 31, 2022

 

June 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1230

 

 

 

 

576

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,105

 

June 22, 2022

 

June 30, 2022

 

July 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

717

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

9,404

 

July 25, 2022

 

July 29, 2022

 

August 29, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

842

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,013

 

August 23, 2022

 

August 31, 2022

 

September 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1239

 

 

 

 

955

 

 

 

 

0.1358

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,373

 

September 22, 2022

 

September 30, 2022

 

October 28, 2022

 

 

 

0.1243

 

 

 

 

1,119

 

 

 

 

0.1360

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

10,767

 

October 21, 2022

 

October 31, 2022

 

November 25, 2022

 

 

 

0.1242

 

 

 

 

1,214

 

 

 

 

0.1359

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

 

0.1408

 

 

 

 

11,435

 

November 16, 2022

 

November 30, 2022

 

December 27, 2022

 

 

 

0.1439

 

 

 

 

1,473

 

 

 

 

0.1553

 

 

 

 

13

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,174

 

December 15, 2022

 

December 30, 2022

 

January 27, 2023

 

 

 

0.1433

 

 

 

 

1,552

 

 

 

 

0.1551

 

 

 

 

16

 

 

 

 

0.1600

 

 

 

 

13,395

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

* Totals may not foot due to rounding.

 

120


Table of Contents

 

Distribution Reinvestment Plan

The Company has adopted a distribution reinvestment plan, pursuant to which the Company will reinvest all cash dividends declared by the Board on behalf of our shareholders who do not elect to receive their dividends in cash as provided below. As a result, if the Board authorizes, and the Company declares, a cash dividend or other distribution, then shareholders who have not opted out of our distribution reinvestment plan will have their cash distributions automatically reinvested in additional shares as described below, rather than receiving the cash dividend or other distribution. Distributions on fractional shares will be credited to each participating shareholder’s account to three decimal places.

Character of Distributions

The Company may fund its cash distributions to shareholders from any source of funds available to the Company, including but not limited to offering proceeds, net investment income from operations, capital gains proceeds from the sale of assets, dividends or other distributions paid to it on account of preferred and common equity investments in portfolio companies and expense support from the Adviser, which is subject to recoupment.

Through December 31, 2022, a portion of the Company’s distributions resulted from expense support from the Adviser, and future distributions may result from expense support from the Adviser, each of which is subject to repayment by the Company within three years from the date of payment. The purpose of this arrangement avoids distributions being characterized as a return of capital for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Shareholders should understand that any such distribution is not based solely on the Company’s investment performance, and can only be sustained if the Company achieves positive investment performance in future periods and/or the Adviser continues to provide expense support. Shareholders should also understand that the Company’s future repayments of expense support will reduce the distributions that they would otherwise receive. There can be no assurance that the Company will achieve the performance necessary to sustain these distributions, or be able to pay distributions at all.

Sources of distributions, other than net investment income and realized gains on a U.S. GAAP basis, include required adjustments to U.S. GAAP net investment income in the current period to determine taxable income available for distributions. The following table reflects the sources of cash distributions on a U.S. GAAP basis that the Company has declared on its shares of common stock during the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

 

Class S

 

 

Class D

 

 

Class I

 

Source of Distribution

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

 

Per Share

 

 

Amount

 

Net investment income

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

Net realized gains

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Distributions in excess of net investment income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

1.4021

 

 

$

 

9,121

 

 

$

 

0.8540

 

 

$

 

54

 

 

$

 

1.6917

 

 

$

 

112,366

 

Share Repurchase Program

At the discretion of our Board of Trustees, the Company has commenced a share repurchase program in which it intends to repurchase the Company’s common shares outstanding as of the close of the previous calendar quarter. The Board of Trustees may amend or suspend the share repurchase program if in its reasonable judgment it deems such action to be in the Company’s best interest and the best interest of our shareholders. As a result, share repurchases may not be available each quarter. Should the Board of Trustees suspend the share repurchase program, the Board of Trustees will consider whether the continued suspension of the program is in the best interests of the Company and shareholders on a quarterly basis. The Company intends to conduct such repurchase offers in accordance with the requirements of Rule 13e-4 promulgated under the Exchange Act and the 1940 Act. All shares purchased by the Company pursuant to the terms of each tender offer will be retired and thereafter will be authorized and unissued shares.

Under the share repurchase plan, to the extent the Company offers to repurchase shares in any particular quarter, it is expected to repurchase shares pursuant to tender offers on or around the last business day of that quarter using a purchase price equal to the NAV per share as of the last calendar day of the applicable quarter, except that shares that have not been outstanding for at least one year will be repurchased at 98% of such NAV (an “Early Repurchase Deduction”). The one-year holding period is measured as of the subscription closing date immediately following the prospective repurchase date. The Early Repurchase Deduction may be waived in the case of repurchase requests arising from the death, divorce or qualified disability of the holder. The Early Repurchase Deduction will be retained by the Company for the benefit of remaining shareholders.

 

121


Table of Contents

 

The following table further summarizes the share repurchases completed during the year ended December 31, 2022:

Repurchase Deadline Request

 

Percentage of Outstanding Shares the Company Offered to Repurchase

 

 

Price Paid Per Share

 

 

Repurchase Pricing Date

 

Amount Repurchased (all classes)

 

 

Number of Shares Repurchased (all classes)

 

 

Percentage of Outstanding Shares Repurchased

 

 

Maximum number of shares that were available for purchase under the repurchase plan

 

June 17, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

$

22.87

 

 

June 30, 2022

 

 

1,822

 

 

 

81,278

 

 

 

0.15

%

 

 

2,745,085

 

September 13, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

 

22.97

 

 

September 30, 2022

 

 

5,699

 

 

 

252,255

 

 

 

0.35

%

 

 

3,623,806

 

December 14, 2022

 

 

5.00

%

 

 

23.20

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

 

40,854

 

 

 

1,780,665

 

 

 

2.09

%

 

 

4,264,898

 

 

 

Note 8. Commitments and Contingencies

The Company has various commitments to fund various revolving and delayed draw senior secured and subordinated loans, including commitments to issue letters of credit through a financial intermediary on behalf of certain portfolio companies. As of December 31, 2022, the Company had the following unfunded commitments to its portfolio companies:

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2022

 

Unfunded revolver obligations, bridge loan and backstop commitments (1)

 

 

$

 

181,974

 

Standby letters of credit issued and outstanding (2)

 

 

 

 

880

 

Unfunded delayed draw loan commitments (3)

 

 

 

 

252,210

 

Total Unfunded Commitments (4)

 

 

$

 

435,064

 

 

(1)
The unfunded revolver obligations may or may not be funded to the borrowing party in the future. The amounts relate to loans with various maturity dates, but the entire amount was eligible for funding to the borrowers as of December 31, 2022, subject to the terms of each loan’s respective credit agreements which includes borrowing covenants that need to be met prior to funding. As of December 31, 2022, the bridge loan and backstop commitments included in the balances was $93,000.
(2)
For all these letters of credit issued and outstanding, the Company would be required to make payments to third parties if the portfolio companies were to default on their related payment obligations. None of the letters of credit issued and outstanding are recorded as a liability on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities as such letters of credit are considered in the valuation of the investments in the portfolio company.
(3)
The Company’s commitment to fund delayed draw loans is triggered upon the satisfaction of certain pre-negotiated terms and conditions which can include covenants to maintain specified leverage levels and other related borrowing base covenants. For commitments to fund delayed draw loans with performance thresholds, borrowers are required to meet certain performance requirements before the Company is obligated to fulfill these commitments.
(4)
Additionally, from time to time, the Adviser and its affiliates may commit to an investment on behalf of the funds it manages, including the Company. Certain terms of these investments are not finalized at the time of the commitment and each respective fund's allocation may change prior to the date of funding. In this regard, the Company may have to fund additional commitments in the future that it is currently not obligated to but may be at a future point in time.

 

Organizational and Offering Costs

The Adviser agreed to bear all of the Company’s organization and offering expenses through the date on which the Company broke escrow for the initial offering of its common shares. The Company is obligated to reimburse the Adviser for such expenses incurred upon breaking escrow for our offering. The total organization and offering costs incurred through December 31, 2022 were $2,901, which was recognized by the Company when it broke escrow for the initial offering of its common shares.

 

122


Table of Contents

 

Warehousing Transactions

The Company entered into a warehousing transaction whereby the Company agreed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase certain assets from parties unaffiliated with the Adviser. The warehousing transaction was designed to assist the Company in deploying capital upon receipt of subscription proceeds.

On February 22, 2021, the Company entered into a Facility Agreement (“Facility Agreement”), which was subsequently amended on August 17, 2021, with Goldman Sachs Bank USA (the “Financing Provider”). The Facility Agreement creates a forward obligation of the Financing Provider to sell, and a forward obligation of the Company, or its designee, to purchase certain investments (the “Portfolio Investments”) owned and held by the Financing Provider at the Company’s request. Pursuant to the Facility Agreement, the Company may request the Financing Provider to acquire Portfolio Investments as it designates from time to time, which the Financing Provider can approve or reject in its sole and absolute discretion. Prior to any sale to the Company, the Portfolio Investments will be owned and held solely for the account of the Financing Provider. ADS will have no obligation to purchase the Portfolio Investments under the Facility Agreement until such time the Company has received subscriptions for its shares of at least $600 million (the “Capital Condition”). After the Company has met the Capital Condition, it will be obligated to purchase the Portfolio Investments from the Financing Provider on or before February 22, 2022 (the “Facility End Date”). ADS may elect, but is not obligated to, purchase Portfolio Investments prior to the Facility End Date or prior to or without meeting the Capital Condition. In consideration for the forward arrangement provided by the Financing Provider (the amount of the arrangement will not exceed $250 million before May 22, 2021 and $500 million between such date and the Facility End Date (the “Financing Amount”), the Company has agreed to pay certain fees and expenses to the Financing Provider, including (i) a facility fee at an annual rate of LIBOR plus 1.77% multiplied by the cash amount paid by the Financing Provider (subject to adjustment for, among other things, cash amounts received by the Financing Provider) for such Portfolio Investment (the “Funded Amount”) while it is being held by the Financing Provider, (ii) an unused fee at an annual rate of 0.50% of the unused Financing Amount minus the greater of (A) the Minimum Utilization Amount and (B) the Funded Amount, and (iii) a minimum utilization fee at an annual rate of 1.77% of (the “Minimum Utilization Amount”) (A) prior to May 22, 2021, 50% of the Financing Amount at such time and (B) on or after May 22, 2021, and prior to the Facility End Date, 75% of the Financing Amount at such time. As a general matter, the price the Company would pay to purchase any Portfolio Investment from the Financing Provider equals the cash amount paid by the Financing Provider subject to adjustment for, among other things, principal repayments and interest amounts earned by the Financing Provider. Accordingly, shareholders will benefit from any interest paid or accrued on any Portfolio Investment purchased by the Company.

Effective January 7, 2022, the Company had a contractual obligation to acquire all assets under the Facility Agreement through forward purchase agreement on or before December 31, 2022. The mark-to-market gain/loss of all investments held by the Financing Provider, in addition to other economic rights and obligations held by the Company, are recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. These gains (losses) are realized at the time the Company settles on the purchases of each underlying asset from the Financing Provider.

For the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company purchased debt investments from the Financing Provider with an aggregate principal amount of $436 million (excluding unfunded revolvers and delayed draw positions of $0.2 million), at a purchase price of $412 million, resulting in an unrealized gain of approximately $3 million.

Other Commitments and Contingencies

From time to time, the Company may become a party to certain legal proceedings incidental to the normal course of its business. At December 31, 2022, management is not aware of any pending or threatened material litigation.

 

 

 

123


Table of Contents

 

Note 9. Income Taxes

For income tax purposes, distributions made to stockholders are reported as ordinary income, capital gains, non-taxable return of capital, or a combination thereof. The final determination of the tax character of distributions will not be made until we file our tax return for each tax year and the tax characteristics of all distributions will be reported to stockholders on Form 1099 after the end of each calendar year. The tax character of distributions paid to stockholders during the tax year ended December 31, 2022 was as follow:

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

2022

 

Ordinary income

 

$

 

121,540

 

Capital gains

 

 

 

 

Return of capital

 

 

 

 

Total distributions paid to stockholders

 

$

 

121,540

 

 

Taxable income generally differs from net increase in net assets resulting from operations for financial reporting purposes due to temporary and permanent differences in the recognition of income and expenses, and generally excludes net unrealized gains or losses, as unrealized gains or losses are generally not included in taxable income until they are realized.

 

The following table reconciles the net increase in net assets resulting from operations to taxable income for the tax year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

2022

 

Net increase (decrease) in net assets resulting from operations

 

$

 

2,761

 

Adjustments:

 

 

 

 

Net realized losses (gains)

 

 

 

14,894

 

Net change in unrealized losses (gains)

 

 

 

130,208

 

Income not currently taxable

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) recognized for tax but not book

 

 

 

190

 

Expenses not currently deductible

 

 

 

2,130

 

Expenses incurred for tax but not book

 

 

 

 

Realized gain/loss differences (1)

 

 

 

 

Taxable income before deductions for distributions

 

$

 

150,183

 

____________________

(1)
These pertain to book income/losses treated as capital gains/losses for tax purposes or book realized gains/losses treated as ordinary income/losses for tax purposes.

 

The following table shows the components of accumulated losses on a tax basis for the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

2022

 

Undistributed ordinary income

 

$

 

28,642

 

Capital loss carryforward

 

 

 

(18,256

)

Unrealized appreciation (depreciation)

 

 

 

(127,038

)

Total accumulated under-distributed (over-distributed) earnings

 

$

 

(116,652

)

 

On December 22, 2010, the Regulated Investment Company Modernization Act (the “Act”) was enacted which changed various technical rules governing the tax treatment of RICs. The changes are generally effective for taxable years beginning after the date of enactment. Under the Act, the Company will be permitted to carry forward capital losses incurred in taxable years beginning after the date of enactment for an unlimited period. However, any losses incurred during those future taxable years will be required to be utilized prior to the losses incurred in pre-enactment taxable years, which carry an expiration date. As a result of this ordering rule, pre-enactment capital loss carryforwards may be more likely to expire unused. Additionally, post-enactment capital losses that are carried forward will retain their character as either short-term or long-term losses rather than being considered all short-term as under previous law.

 

As of December 31, 2022, the Company had a post-enactment short-term capital loss carryforward of $18,256, and did not have any long-term capital loss carryforward. As of December 31, 2021, the Company did not have any post-enactment net capital loss carryforward.

 

As of December 31, 2022, the Company had no pre-enactment net capital loss carryforward. None of the pre-enactment net capital loss carryforwards were utilized in the past one year and none of the pre-enactment net capital loss carryforwards expired on December 31, 2022.

 

For tax purposes, the Company may elect to defer any portion of a post-October capital loss or late-year ordinary loss to the first day of the following fiscal year.

124


Table of Contents

 

 

As of December 31, 2022, the Company deferred no late-year ordinary losses which are deemed to arise on January 1, 2023. As of December 31, 2021, the Company deferred no late-year ordinary losses which are deemed to arise on January 1, 2022.

 

As of December 31, 2022, the Company did not defer any post-October capital loss deemed to arise on January 1, 2023. As of December 31, 2021, the Company deferred no post-October capital losses deemed to arise on January 1, 2022.

 

Management has analyzed the Company’s tax positions taken, or to be taken, on federal income tax returns for all open tax years, and has concluded that no provision for income tax is required in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Company’s federal tax returns are subject to examination by the Internal Revenue Service for a period of three fiscal years after they are filed.

 

In general, we may make certain reclassifications to the components of net assets as a result of permanent book-to-tax differences and book-to-tax differences relating to stockholder distributions. As of December 31, 2022, we adjusted accumulated net realized loss by ($4,516) to $32,968, under-distributed net investment income by $6,645 to ($19,411), and paid-in capital in excess of par by ($2,130) to $2,270,655. Total earnings and net asset value were not affected. As of December 31, 2021, we did not adjust accumulated net realized loss or overdistributed net investment income. Total earnings and net asset value were not affected.

 

To the extent that the Company determines that its estimated current year annual taxable income will exceed its estimated current year dividends from such taxable income, the Company accrues excise tax on estimated excess taxable income. For the year ended December 31, 2022, $783 was recorded for U.S. federal excise tax.

 

 

 

125


Table of Contents

 

Note 10. Financial Highlights

The following are the financial highlights for the year ended December 31, 2022:

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2022

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class S (6)

 

Class D (7)

 

Class I (8)

 

Per Share Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net asset value at beginning of period

$

 

25.04

 

 

 

$

 

22.87

 

 

 

$

 

25.00

 

Net investment income (1)

 

 

1.83

 

 

 

 

 

1.15

 

 

 

 

 

2.06

 

Net unrealized and realized gains (losses) (2)

 

 

(2.27

)

 

 

 

 

0.03

 

 

 

 

 

(2.17

)

Net increase (decrease) in net assets resulting from operations

 

 

(0.44

)

 

 

 

 

1.18

 

 

 

 

 

(0.11

)

Distribution declared (3)

 

 

(1.40

)

 

 

 

 

(0.85

)

 

 

 

 

(1.69

)

Net asset value at end of period

$

 

23.20

 

 

 

$

 

23.20

 

 

 

$

 

23.20

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total return (4)

 

 

(1.67

)%

 

 

 

 

5.23

%

 

 

 

 

(0.34

)%

Shares outstanding, end of period

 

 

10,827,739

 

 

 

 

 

106,943

 

 

 

 

 

81,943,071

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

 

 

6,431,670

 

 

 

 

 

61,570

 

 

 

 

 

65,940,873

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ratio/Supplemental Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net assets at end of period

$

 

251,223

 

 

 

$

 

2,481

 

 

 

$

 

1,901,229

 

Annualized ratio of net expenses to average net assets (5)

 

 

8.14

%

 

 

 

 

9.19

%

 

 

 

 

6.06

%

Annualized ratio of net investment income to average net assets (5)

 

 

8.54

%

 

 

 

 

9.86

%

 

 

 

 

8.85

%

Portfolio turnover rate

 

 

48.93

%

 

 

 

 

48.93

%

 

 

 

 

48.93

%

Asset coverage per unit (9)

 

 

1,992

 

 

 

 

 

1,992

 

 

 

 

 

1,992

 

(1)
The per share data was derived by using the weighted average shares outstanding during the period.
(2)
The amount shown at this caption is the balancing amount derived from the other figures in the schedule. The amount shown at this caption for a share outstanding throughout the period may not agree with the change in the aggregate gains and losses in portfolio securities for the period because of the timing of sales of the Company’s shares in relation to fluctuating market values for the portfolio.
(3)
The per share data for distributions was derived by using the actual shares outstanding at the date of the relevant transactions (refer to Note 7).
(4)
An investment in the Company is subject to maximum upfront sales load of 3.5% and 1.5% for Class S and Class D shares, respectively, of the offering price, which will reduce the amount of capital available for investment. Class I shares is not subject to upfront sales load.
(5)
For the year ended December 31, 2022, amounts are annualized except for organizational costs and management fee and income based incentive fee waivers by the Adviser. For the year ended December 31, 2022, the total operating expenses to average net assets were 8.04%, 4.69%, and 7.07%, for Class S, Class D and Class I shares, respectively, prior to management fee waivers and expense support provided by the Adviser. Past performance is not a guarantee of future results. Operating expenses may vary in the future based on the amount of capital raised, the Adviser’s election to continue expense support, and other unpredictable variables.
(6)
Class S shares were first issued on February 1, 2022.
(7)
Class D shares were first issued on July 1, 2022.
(8)
Class I shares were first issued on January 7, 2022 (commencement of operations).
(9)
The asset coverage ratio for a class of senior securities representing indebtedness is calculated as our total assets, less all liabilities and indebtedness not represented by senior securities, divided by senior securities representing indebtedness. This asset coverage ratio is multiplied by one thousand to determine the asset coverage per unit.

 

 

 

 

126


Table of Contents

 

Note 11. Subsequent Events

Management has evaluated subsequent events through the date of issuance of these consolidated financial statements and has determined that there are no subsequent events outside the ordinary scope of business that require adjustment to, or disclosure in, the consolidated financial statements other than those disclosed below.

January Financial Update and Dividend Declaration

On January 1, 2023, the Company issued and sold 2,203,298 shares (consisting of 512,110 Class S shares, 7,543 Class D shares, and 1,683,645 Class I shares at an offering price of $23.20 per share for the Class S, Class D, and Class I shares), and the Company received approximately $51.1 million as payment for such shares.

On January 20, 2023, the Company’s Board declared distributions of $0.1433 per Class S share, $0.1551 per Class D share, and $0.1600 per Class I share which is payable on February 24, 2023 to shareholders of record as of January 31, 2022.

 

February Financial Update and Dividend Declaration

 

On February 1, 2023, the Company issued and sold 1,705,835 shares (consisting of 357,215 Class S shares, 2,327 Class D shares, and 1,346,293 Class I shares at an offering price of $23.64 per share for the Class S, Class D, and Class I shares), and the Company received approximately $40.3 million as payment for such shares.

 

On February 17, 2023, the Company’s Board declared distributions of $0.1446 per Class S share, $0.1555 per Class D share, and $0.1600 per Class I share which is payable on or about March 29, 2023 to shareholders of record as of February 28, 2023.

 

In addition to the regular distributions discussed above, on January 20, 2023, the Company announced that its Board of Trustees declared special distributions totaling $0.06 per share to be distributed in three consecutive monthly payments of $0.02 per share. Payments will be made on or around March 29, 2023, April 26, 2023 and May 26, 2023 for shareholders of record as of February 28, 2023, March 31, 2023 and April 28, 2023, respectively.

March Subscriptions

The Company received approximately $89.7 million of net proceeds relating to the issuance of Class S shares, Class D shares, and Class I shares for subscriptions effective March 1, 2023.

 

127


Table of Contents

 

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Not applicable.

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

As of December 31, 2022 (the end of the period covered by this report), we, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) of the 1934 Act). Based on that evaluation, our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective and provided reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed in our periodic SEC filings is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. However, in evaluating the disclosure controls and procedures, management recognized that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control objectives, and management necessarily was required to apply its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of such possible controls and procedures.

This annual report does not include a report of management’s assessment regarding internal control over financial reporting or an attestation report of the company’s registered public accounting firm due to a transition period established by rules of the SEC.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act). Under the supervision and with the participation of management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2022 based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 COSO Framework). Based on this evaluation under the framework in Internal Control—Integrated Framework, management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2022.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Changes in Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting

Management has not identified any change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during our most recently completed fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Item 9B. Other Information

None.

128


Table of Contents

 

PART III

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Information required by this item will be contained in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for its 2023 Annual Shareholder Meeting, to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after December 31, 2022, and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11. Executive Compensation

Information required by this item will be contained in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for its 2023 Annual Shareholder Meeting, to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after December 31, 2022, and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Information required by this item will be contained in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for its 2023 Annual Shareholder Meeting, to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after December 31, 2022, and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Information required by this item will be contained in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for its 2023 Annual Shareholder Meeting, to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after December 31, 2022, and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

Information required by this item will be contained in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for its 2023 Annual Shareholder Meeting, to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after December 31, 2022, and is incorporated herein by reference.

129


Table of Contents

 

PART IV

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

The following documents are filed as part of this annual report:

(1)
Financial Statements—Financial statements are included in Item 8. See the Index to the consolidated financial statements on page 72 of this annual report on Form 10-K.
(2)
Financial Statement Schedules—None. We have omitted financial statement schedules because they are not required or are not applicable, or the required information is shown in the statements or notes to the consolidated financial statements.
(3)
Exhibits—The following is a list of all exhibits filed as a part of this annual report on Form 10-K, including those incorporated by reference

 

Exhibit

Number

Description of Exhibits

  3.1

Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (1)

  3.2

First Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (2)

  3.3

Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (3)

  3.4

Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (4)

  3.5

Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (5)

  3.6

Second Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust of the Registrant (6)

  3.7

Bylaws of the Registrant (7)

  4.1

Form of Subscription Agreement (8)

  4.3

Description of Common Shares of Beneficial Interest (9)

10.1

Investment Advisory Agreement between the Company and the Adviser, dated October 29, 2021 (10)

10.2

Intermediary Manager Agreement between the Company and the Intermediary Manager, dated November 10, 2021 (11)

10.3

Form of Selected Intermediary Agreement (12)

10.4

Amended and Restated Distribution and Shareholder Servicing Plan of the Registrant, dated November 14, 2021.*

10.5

Custodian Agreement between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust Company, dated November 3, 2021 (13)

10.6

Administration Agreement between the Company and the Administrator, dated October 29, 2021 (14)

10.7

Escrow Agreement by and among the Company, Apollo Global Securities, LLC, and UMB Bank, N.A., dated October 14, 2021 (15)

10.8

Agency Agreement between the Company and DST Systems, Inc., dated September 29, 2021 (16)

10.9

Expense Support and Conditional Reimbursement Agreement by and among the Registrant and Adviser, dated October 29, 2021 (17)

10.10

Subscription Agreement for Seed Capital (18)

10.11

Facility Agreement between the Company and Goldman Sachs Bank USA (19)

10.12

Multi-Class Plan, dated July 22, 2021 (20)

10.13

Distribution Reinvestment Plan, dated July 22, 2021 (21)

10.14

Loan and Servicing Agreement, dated as of January 7, 2022, by and between Mallard Funding LLC, a subsidiary of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, with Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., as administrative agent (24)

10.15

Purchase and Sale Agreement, dated as of January 7, 2022, by and between Mallard Funding LLC and Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (25)

10.16

Credit and Security Agreement, dated as of January 7, 2022, by and between Cardinal Funding LLC, a subsidiary of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, with Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent (26)

10.17

Sale and Contribution Agreement, dated January 7, 2022, by and between Cardinal Funding LLC and Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (27)

10.18

Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between Apollo Debt Solutions, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, dated March 11, 2022 (28)

10.19

Amendment No. 1 to the Credit and Security Agreement, dated as of April 7, 2022, by and between Cardinal Funding LLC, a subsidiary of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, with Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent (29)

10.20

Senior Credit Facility Agreement dated July 7, 2022, between Grouse Funding LLC, as borrower, the lenders from time to time parties thereto, Goldman Sachs Bank USA, as syndication agent and administrative agent, State Street Bank and Trust Company, as collateral agent and collateral custodian, and Virtus Group, LP, as collateral administrator. (30)

10.21

Sale and Contribution Agreement dated July 7, 2022, between Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, as seller, and Grouse Funding LLC, as purchaser. (31)

10.22

Non-Recourse Carveout Guaranty Agreement dated July 7, 2022, by Apollo Debt Solutions BDC in favor of (a) State Street Bank and Trust Company as collateral agent for and on behalf of the Secured Parties and (b) Goldman Sachs Bank USA as lender, administrative agent and calculation agent. (32)

130


Table of Contents

 

10.23

Amendment No. 4 to the Credit and Security Agreement, dated as of December 9, 2022, by and between Cardinal Funding LLC, a subsidiary of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, with Citibank, N.A., as administrative agent. (33)

14.1

Code of Ethics (22)

21.1

Subsidiaries*

31.1

Certification of Principal Executive Officer Pursuant to Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.*

31.2

Certification of Principal Financial Officer Pursuant to Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.*

32.1

Certification of Principal Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.*

32.2

Certification of Principal Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.*

 

* Filed herewith

___________________

 

(1)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(1) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(2)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(2) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(3)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(3) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(4)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(4) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(5)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(5) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on October 26, 2021.
(6)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 814-01424), filed on December 21, 2021.
(7)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (b) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(8)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (d) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(9)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(10)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(11)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(12)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (h)(2) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(13)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(14)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(15)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(16)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(17)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(18)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (p) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on October 26, 2021.
(19)
Incorporated by references to Exhibit (k)(6) to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 (File No. 333-258155), filed on July 23, 2021.
(20)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022
(21)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(22)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 14.1 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(23)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 21.1 to the Company’s Form 10-K (File No. 814-01424), for the year ended December 31, 2021, filed on March 30, 2022.
(24)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on January 11, 2022.
(25)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on January 11, 2022.
(26)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on January 11, 2022.
(27)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on January 11, 2022.
(28)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on March 15, 2022.
(29)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on April 20, 2022.
(30)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on July 11, 2022.

131


Table of Contents

 

(31)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on July 11, 2022.
(32)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on July 11, 2022.
(33)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on December 12, 2022.

132


Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized on March 16, 2023.

 

 

 

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

 

By:

 

/s/ Earl Hunt

Name:

 

Earl Hunt

Title:

 

Chairperson, Chief Executive Officer and Trustee

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant in the capacities and on the dates indicated on March 16, 2023.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Signature

 

Title

 

Date

 

 

 

/s/ Earl Hunt

Earl Hunt

 

Chairperson, Chief Executive Officer and Trustee

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Amit Joshi

Amit Joshi

 

Chief Financial Officer

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Kristin Hester

Kristin Hester

 

Chief Legal Officer and Secretary

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Meredith Coffey

Meredith Coffey

 

Trustee

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Christine Gallagher

Christine Gallagher

 

Trustee

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Michael Porter

Michael Porter

 

Trustee

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

 

/s/ Carl J. Rickertsen

Carl J. Rickertsen

 

Trustee

 

March 16, 2023

 

 

133


Exhibit 10.4

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

AMENDED AND RESTATED DISTRIBUTION AND SERVICING PLAN

Adopted: July 22, 2021

Amended and Restated: November 14, 2022

This Distribution and Servicing Plan (the “Plan”) has been adopted on a voluntary basis in conformity with Rule 12b-1 (the “Rule”) under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”), by Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, a Delaware statutory trust (the “Fund”), with respect to its classes of shares of beneficial interest (each, a “Class”) listed on Appendix A, as amended from time to time, subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein.

1.
Distribution Fee and Shareholder Servicing Fee
a.
The Fund may pay to Apollo Global Securities, LLC (the “Distributor”), in its capacity as principal underwriter of the Fund’s shares of beneficial interest, with respect to and at the expense of each Class listed on Appendix A, a fee for (i) distribution and sales support services (the “Distribution Fee”), as applicable, and/or (ii) shareholder services (the “Servicing Fee”), and each as more fully described below (together, the “Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee”), such fee to be paid at the rate per annum of the aggregate NAV as of the beginning of the first calendar day of each applicable month of the Class specified with respect to such Class under the column “Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee” on Appendix A. The Distribution Fee under the Plan will be used primarily to compensate the Distributor for such services provided in connection with the offering and sale of shares of the applicable Class, and to reimburse the Distributor for related expenses incurred, including payments by the Distributor to compensate or reimburse brokers, other financial institutions or other industry professionals (collectively, “Selling Agents”), for distribution services and sales support services provided and related expenses incurred by such Selling Agents. Payments of the Distribution Fee on behalf of a particular Class must be in consideration of services rendered for or on behalf of such Class. However, joint distribution or sales support financing with respect to the shares of the Class (which financing may also involve other investment portfolios or companies that are affiliated persons of such a person, or affiliated persons of the Distributor) are permitted in accordance with applicable law. Payments of the Servicing Fee will be used to compensate the Distributor for personal services and/or the maintenance of shareholder accounts services provided to shareholders in the related Class and to reimburse the Distributor for related expenses incurred, including payments by the Distributor to compensate or reimburse brokers, dealers, other financial institutions or other industry professionals. Payments of the Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee may be made without regard to expenses actually incurred.
2.
Calculation and Payment of Fees

The amount of the Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee payable with respect to each Class listed on Appendix A will be calculated at the rate per annum of the aggregate NAV as of the beginning of the first calendar day of each applicable month, payable monthly in arrears, at the applicable annual rates indicated on Appendix A. The Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee will be calculated and paid separately for each Class.

3.
Approval of Plan

The Plan will become effective, as to any Class (including any Class not currently listed on Appendix A), the later of (a) its approval by (i) a majority of the Board of Trustees, including a majority of the Trustees who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund and who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the Plan or in any agreements related to the Plan (“Qualified Trustees”), pursuant to a vote cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on the approval of the Plan, and (ii) with respect to Section 1 of the Plan only, if the Plan is adopted for a Class after any public offering of shares of the Class or the sale of shares of the Class to persons who are not affiliated persons of the Fund, affiliated persons of such persons, promoters of the Fund, or affiliated persons of such promoters, a majority of the outstanding voting securities (as defined in the 1940 Act) of such Class, and (b) the Fund's initial registration statement on Form N-2 being declared effective by the Securities and Exchange Commission.

4.
Continuance of the Plan

The Plan will continue in effect with respect to a Class for one year from the effective date, and from year to year thereafter indefinitely so long as such continuance is specifically approved at least annually by the Fund’s Board of Trustees in the manner described in Section 3(a) above.

 


5.
Implementation

All agreements with any person relating to implementation of this Plan with respect to any Class shall be in writing, and any agreement related to this Plan with respect to any Class shall provide: (a) that such agreement may be terminated at any time, without payment of any penalty, by vote of a majority of the Qualified Trustees or by a majority vote of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant Class, on not more than 60 days’ written notice to any other party to the agreement; and (b) that such agreement shall terminate automatically in the event of its assignment.

For the purposes of this Agreement, the “affirmative vote of a majority of the outstanding shares” of a Fund means the affirmative vote, at a duly called and held meeting of shareholders of the Fund, (a) of the holders of 67% or more of the shares of the Fund present (in person or by proxy) and entitled to vote at the meeting, if the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding shares of the Fund entitled to vote at the meeting are present in person or by proxy or (b) of the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding shares of the Fund entitled to vote at the meeting, whichever is less. For the purposes of this Agreement, the terms “interested person” and “assignment” have their respective meanings defined in the 1940 Act, subject, however, to the Rules and Regulations under the 1940 Act and any applicable guidance or interpretation of the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff; and the term “approve at least annually” will be construed in a manner consistent with the 1940 Act and the Rules and Regulations under the 1940 Act and any applicable guidance or interpretation of the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff.

6.
Termination

This Plan may be terminated at any time with respect to the shares of any Class by vote of a majority of the Qualified Trustees, or by a majority vote of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant Class.

7.
Amendments

The Plan may not be amended with respect to any Class so as to increase materially the amount of the Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee described in Section 1 above with respect to such Class without approval in the manner described in Section 3(b) above, and all material amendments to this Plan shall be approved in the manner provided for approval of this Plan in Section 3(a) above.

8.
Selection of Certain Trustees

While the Plan is in effect, the selection and nomination of the Fund’s Trustees who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund will be at the discretion of the Trustees then in office who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund.

9.
Written Reports

While the Plan is in effect, the Fund’s Board of Trustees will receive, and the Trustees will review, at least quarterly, written reports complying with the requirements of the Rule, which set out the amounts expended under the Plan and the purposes for which those expenditures were made.

10.
Preservation of Materials

The Fund will preserve copies of the Plan, any agreement relating to the Plan and any report made pursuant to Section 9 above, for a period of not less than six years (the first two years in an easily accessible place) from the date of the Plan, agreement or report.

11.
Delaware Statutory Trust

A copy of the Certificate of Trust of the Fund is on file with the Secretary of the State of Delaware, and notice is hereby given that this instrument is executed on behalf of the Trustees of the Fund as Trustees and this Agreement has not been executed by such Trustee in his individual capacity and that the obligations of or arising out of this Plan are not binding upon any of the Trustees, officers or shareholders of the Fund individually but are binding only upon the Fund and the assets and property of the Fund, or upon the assets belonging to the series or attributable to the class of the Fund, for the benefit of which the Trustees have caused this Plan to be executed.

 


 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Fund has executed this Plan as of the date first above written on behalf of each Class listed on Appendix A.

 

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

By: /s/ Kristin Hester

Name: Kristin Hester

Title: Chief Legal Officer and Secretary

 

 


 

APPENDIX A TO DISTRIBUTION AND SERVICING PLAN

APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

Class of Shares of Beneficial Interest

Shareholder Servicing and/or Distribution Fee

Class I Shares

N/A

Class S Shares

0.85%

Class D Shares

0.25%

 

 

Agreed to and accepted as of November 14, 2022.

 

By: /s/ Kristin Hester

Name: Kristin Hester

Title: Chief Legal Officer and Secretary

 


Exhibit 21.1

 

SUBSIDIARIES OF APOLLO DEBT SOLUTIONS BDC

 

Name

Jurisdiction

CARDINAL FUNDING LLC

DELAWARE

MALLARD FUNDING LLC

DELAWARE

GROUSE FUNDING LLC

DELAWARE

ADS ALPINE SPV LLC

DELAWARE

ADS JEWEL SPV LLC

DELAWARE

ADS WW SPV LLC

DELAWARE

ADS ZORRO SPV LLC

DELAWARE

 


 

Exhibit 31.1

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO

RULES 13a-14(a) AND 15d-14(a) UNDER THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

I, Earl Hunt, Chief Executive Officer of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, certify that:

 

1.
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “registrant”);

 

2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) for the registrant and have:

 

(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(c)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of trustees (or persons performing the equivalent function):
(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Dated: March 16, 2023

By:

/s/ Earl Hunt

 

Earl Hunt

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 


 

Exhibit 31.2

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO

RULES 13a-14(a) AND 15d-14(a) UNDER THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

I, Amit Joshi, Chief Financial Officer of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC, certify that:

 

1.
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “registrant”);

 

2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) for the registrant and have:

 

(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(c)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of trustees (or persons performing the equivalent function):
(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Dated: March 16, 2023

 

By:

/s/ Amit Joshi

 

Amit Joshi

 

Chief Financial Officer

 

 


 

Exhibit 32.1

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO

18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350, AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO

SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

Pursuant to Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned, as Chief Executive Officer of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “Company”), does hereby certify that to the undersigned’s knowledge:

 

1.
the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2.
the information contained in the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

Dated: March 16, 2023

By:

/s/ Earl Hunt

 

Earl Hunt

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 


 

Exhibit 32.2

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO

18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350, AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO

SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

Pursuant to Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned, as Chief Financial Officer of Apollo Debt Solutions BDC (the “Company”), does hereby certify that to the undersigned’s knowledge:

 

1.
the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2.
the information contained in the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

Dated: March 16, 2023

By:

/s/ Amit Joshi

 

Amit Joshi

 

Chief Financial Officer